FSI - Kirundi Basic Course
FSI - Kirundi Basic Course
FSI - Kirundi Basic Course
S E R V I C E
I N
ST
I T
U T
KI R U N D I
B ASIC
CO U RSE
K IRU N D I
B ASI C COU RSK
This work was compiled and published with the support of the OHice of Education, Deportment of Health, Educotion and Welfare, United States of America.
Based on K i r u ndi
R AYMOND S E T U K U R U ,
Terence Nsanze and Daniel Nicimpaye Organized and edited by:
E ARL W .
S TE Y I C K
KIRUNDI
FO R E I G N B ASI C
S E R V IC E I N S TI T UTE C O U R S E S E RI E S B . SW I F T
LLOY D
Acting Editor
Washtngton, D C
20 4 02 Puce $2 75
B ASIC C O U R S E
P RE F A C E
Kirundi, together with its companion language, Kinyarwanda, is one o f the most important of Bantu languages. T hi s h ook is in t ended to g ive t h e s t u d ent a start in K i r u ndi, providing him with di alogues that r e late to some o f the first s i t uations in which he is l i k ely to use the Language, as well as with systematic practice in all major points o f grammar.
The present volume isone of a series o f shortBasic Courses in selected A frican languages, prepared by the Foreign Service Institute, under an agreement ivith the O ffice of Education, Department o f Health, Education and Welfare, under provisions o f the National De fense Education A ct. The analysis on ivhich this course is based is contained in A. E. Meeussen's Essai de Grammaire Rundi. Di c tionaries by F. M. R o degem and Elizabeth E. C ox were also o f great v alue. P ar t of the manuscript was checked at Michigan State University by Charles Kra ft, David McClure and D. Kamatari. T h e contributions o f these scholars are grate fully acknowLedged. Kirundi Basic Course is the work o f many colaborators. Raymond Setukuru, Terence Nsanze and Daniel Nicimpaye provided the dialogues and other texts, as weLL as the exercise material. Setukuru also provided data for use in the construction of notes on sounds and grammar, checked theentire manuscript, and voicedthe tape recordings which accompany the course. The manuscript was also checked by Gregoire Ndinze. General organizing, editing and the preparation o f notes were the responsibility o f Earl W. Stevick. T h e t a pe recordings were prepared in the Language Laboratory o f the Foreign Service Institute, under the direction o f Gabriel Cordova.
Howard E. Sollenberger, Dean School o f Language and Area Studies Foreign Service Institute Department of State
KIRUNDI
U ni t
5
1O
<tone>.. . . , . .
6. 7 8.
9.
Absolut;e p e r s o na l
g/
p ro n o uns . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
20
/ n i / . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
Vocabulary supplement: 1. Names for members of various ethnic groups.... 27 2. Places wh er e p eopl e w o r k . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 0
U nit ;
D ial o g u e : Notes :
L ookin g
f o r w o rk . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
33
pro nouns , 3 6
2. ObJect; prefixes................
3. T h e t o n e s of c e r tain nouns borrowed from
37 38
BASIC C O U R S E
1 nfinitives............... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5. The verb forms that; cont;ain t;he root / -z i / . . 6 The grammatical dimension of >linkage>,.....
39
42
Vocabulary supplement;:
43 46 48
Days o f
t h e w e e k .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . , . . . . , . . . .
Unit; 3 D ialogue: W h ere do people live and work?.............. Notes : l . The alternat;ion of nasal consonant;s.........
2.
52
54 55
Substan t i v e
p h r a s e s .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
The alternat;e forms of concordial prefixes w ith various adjective stems.............. The locative enclitic 60 62 62
/-"-he/..
. ... . . . . . . . . . .
5.
T he subsecutive prefix......................
75
1. The use of tone in the Kirundi verb........ . 2. The non-tonal features of negative
indicat;ive forms.............. 3. T h e t o ne s of im m ediate indicative verb s ,
77
78
78
80
80
KIHUNDl
86
88
89 89
91
>heavy, 92
U nit
6 101
104
j 05
3. 4. A
C o m p a r i s ons of in equality .
. ... . . . . . . . . . .
106
10 7 '
U nit
'7
F a m i l y r e l a t ionships...................... . 118
Dialogue :
120 122
BASIC C O U R SE
an d ,
U nit ;
136
137
V o w e l l en g t h i n t h e co ns t r u ct i on wi t h
/na/
138
p lus a
n u m er a l . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
3. Possessives used without; nouns............ 139 The tone of the copular / ni/ and / si% .. 14O
V ocabulary supplemen t : S ome useful adjectives . .
141
U nit ;
Dialogue : N ote s : 1.
152
affirmative...................... ......
155
Uni t
10 Review .
.
162
KIRUNDI
U nit; 1 1
D ia l o g u e :
1ocati o n s . .
3.
. . . . . . .. . . . . . .
. . .
T h e n e g a t ive imperative . .
179
Uni t
12
Dialogue: M ore street directions ............. . . . . . . Notes : l. Relative verb forms............ ......... 2. Re l a t i v e pr o n o u n s . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
186
191 192
U nit
13 20 0
204
215
2]7
B ASIC CO U R SE
U nit
15
Dialogue: B uying clothing. ... . ..... ............. 232 Vocabulary supplement: Legal
2. N ot e s :
t e n d e r . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . , . . . . . . 234
1.
T h e h o d i e r n a l t ens e . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 236
U nit ;
16
.
. .. .
245
zatings
o 265
. .. .
. . . . . . . 267
U nit; 1 8 .
Dialogue : W o r k i n th e kit;chen.........
....
278
Notes:
1. Th e su b j u n c t i v e . . . .. . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . 281
U nit
19
2.
T h e d e fe c t i v e v e rb / - r i / . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 299
. . . . . . . . . . . . 302
KIRUNDI
U nit
20 313
R evie; . . . . . . , . . . . , . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Uni t
324
/.. . .
3 27
327
/ r V a/
T he use o f / - r i i n d a / a phr a s e . a s t h e f i r s t v er b i n
328
329 332
Uni t
. ... . . . . . . . . . . . .
Uni t
23
D ial o g ue :
N ote s : 1. 2. 3.
S e a s o na l c r o p s . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
357
360 361 362
. .. . . . .
. ... . . . . . . . .
365 365
B ASIC C O U R SE
. ..
379 383
384
386 3 87
2.
0 rm
3.
4. 5.
387 387
U nit ;
25 A v i s i t t o a f r i e n d's home ..
Dialogue :
397
Vocabulary supplement:
A rticles found in the hou s e . . . . .......... . N ote s : 400
1. 2.
3.
T h e c o n s t r u c ti on / n i S e n t e nceswi t h /-ri
- ba/ . . . . . . . . . . . . .
401
na.. . / . . . . . . . . . .
402
402
U nit ;
D ia l o g u e : Not;es : l. A
/ - -an-/ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2. 3. A Th e v o ca t i v e u s e of n ou n s . . .
4 16
417
. ... . . . . . . . .
/ -ka-/ . . . .
419
KZRUNDI
4.
T h e e xt e n s i o n s i n t h e s t em / - k i r i z a / . . . . . .
419
420
U nit
27
T h e g o v e r nm ent of Burun di......... . 430
Basic sentences :
Notes :
1. M e t h o d of p luralizing unassimilated Frenc h nouns. . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . .
435
36
2. 3.
437
438 439
A use of
/ na /
t o En g l i s h
U nit
28 443
B asic dialogue: M i scellaneous topics................ Notes: l . A use of the concord for Class 17......... 2. A us e o f / - t i /
448
452 454 4 55
/ ni /
U nit
29 d i a l o g ues..
S hort
458
U nit
30. 476
lossary..
498
BASIC COURSE
SYNOPSIS
Kirundi is
I t s h a res a
h igh degree of mu t ual in t elligibility with Kinyarwanda, the lan g uage of Rwan da . C o n s i d e red together, the cluster Kirundi -
Kinyarwanda ranks third among Bantu languages, after Swahili and Lingala, with respect to number of speakers. T h ere are however two important differences between Swahili and Lingala on the one hand and Kirundi-Kinyarwanda on the other: (1) Swahili and Lingala are spoken over very wide areas, and a high proportion of their speakers have some other Bantu language as the mother tongue; Kirundi-Kinyarwanda is spoken in a relatively small area, as the fi.rst language. (2) Swahili and Lingala are relatively free of troublesome complexities for the learner; Kirundi and Kinyarwanda are full of them. Th e two books in this series which are concerned with Swahili and Lingala set out the grammar of those languages in the form of a s e r ies of individual not es, distributed
throughout the units of the course. The present volume presents the details of Kirundi grammar in the same way. I n addition, however, this synopsis has been prepared, first of all to provide
o rientation for th ose who p lan to use the en t ire bo ok , and s e c o ndarily for the s tu d ent whose desire is to l e arn as much as p o s s ible about the language in the sh ortest time . O n l y the most
i mportant features of the grammar are me n tioned at a ll , and th e v ocabulary used in th e ex amp les has in tentionally been kept sm a l l . T he exercises, with an sw ers given in square bra ckets at the r i g h t , are not intended to m ake this synopsis into an au t o -instructional
SYNOPSIS
KIRUNDI
The analysis on which this synopsis is based is found in Essai de Grammaire Rundi, ( Tervu r e n : M u s e e R o y al , 195 9 ) by A . E .
aspects of pronunciation, but without consideration for the grammatical function or the dictionary meaning of what is pronounced. ~Morphology> is a description of the meaningful units of the language (prefixes, roots, stems, etc. ) and of the ways in which they combine with one another within single <words<. c onti n u e s c al l e d >Syntax > t h i s des c r i p t i on u p t o t h e l ev e l s of wh a t a r e usu a l l y
This synopsis concentrates on two of the most complex parts of Kirundi structure: (1) the morphology of the verb, and (2)
t he pronunciation of the vow els and consonants . 1. P R I N C I PAL FEATURES OF KIRUNDI GRAMMAR The
h owever, at wh ich the s tudent should look fir st, both be caus e
xiv
B ASIC C O U R SE
SYNOPSlS
t h e v er b h av e b e en
n amed is the or der in wh ich they occur wi thin a w o r d . c entral of the th ree is the ro o t : t uduug a . . . t ugeend a . . . These > we c l i m b
The most
<we go
c lose to the di ff erence between English <climb > differ in form by th e d i ff erence between
and <go> .
The y
T he f o r m s /- duug-/
approximately the same meanings as those for which >climb> and >go> a re used in En g li sh .
in either of these forms; they are therefore what the linguist calls HOOTS. E v ery language has a large stock of roots.
W hat; is the root in each of th ese verb form s : t ub o n a . . . !we s e e . . rwe b u y . ~we i r o n . I . . t .. . l
[-bon- ] [ -gur - ]
[ -g o r o o r - ]
t ugur a . . .
t ug o r o o r a . . .
E ach Kirundi verb form has one and only one ro ot . may have any of s e v eral shap es, some of whic h ar e :
A root
- C-
( s i ng l e c o n s o n a n t) a n d c o n s o n a n t) vo wel) v o wel ) wh i ch n o t be
- duug - an d i k -
> to g o f r o m >
<to st udy , l e ar n ' do ~
- VC- ( v o we l -CVC-
( one s h or t
- CVlVl C-
( one l o n g
<to w r i
t e>
a l i k e , s ep a r a t ed
c o n s o n an t )
xv
SYNOPSIS
KIRUNDI
W hat i s
t h e r oot i n ea c h o f t he s e f or m s ? w e go f r o m . . . t hey g o f r o m . . .
t he y t he y t he y go. . . l i ve . . . do. . .
t uva . . . b ava. . .
b aZa . . . b aba . . . b akor a . . . b aand i k a . . .
[-v-] [-v-]
[ -b- ] E-kor- ]
[ -an d i k - ]
t he y w r i t e . . .
I n e a c h g r o u p of
t h r e e wor d s ,
-CVC-,
- VC-, e t c .
):
[ -goroor - ] [-mesuur- ]
[-v- ]
and
By far the most common shapes for roots are -CVC- CVl V l C - .
I n Kirundi, a verb root is always fo llowed by on e or m o r e s uf f i x es : -som-som- a - som- y e -som- e <to read <
c e r t a i n ot h e r v e r b f or m s)
xvi
BASIC CO U R SE
smoPSxs
-som-eesh-geend-geend- e esh -
(a non-final suffix with causative (meaning) to cause to read ) > to g o > >to c a us e to g o>
< we ir o n > > they b u y > <that they may buy< > that w e ma y g o >
The second of each of these pairs of verb froms contains one non-final suffix. W hat is it;? babona
b abonan a
[-an-]
t uri ma
turimiisha
[- i i s h .- ]
Except in the simplest imperative forms, the root is preceded by one or more prefixes of various kinds:
som-a b a- s o m - a n t i - ba - so m - a
/
t read ) )
exped i e n t
t o use, i n
T h e S T E1'4 of a
xvi i
SYNOPSIS
KIRUNDI
The BASE of a Kirundi verb is defined as the root plus all suffixes except the final suffix.
Most kinds of Kirundi verb forms must con tain, in ad d i tion t o t h e s t em, a su b j e c t p r ef i x : < I speak >
m-vuga
u -v u g a
of person
(singular, plural
):
1.
2. 3.
tumuba-
<we>
>you (pl)>
>they<
[ <you ( pl . )
/basoma/ ? [ >they
r e ad>]
read>j
/nsoma/?
If
[>I r e a d <]
[ngeenda]
go>
BASIC CO U R SE
SYNOPSIS
Different;iation. of person and number are familiar from t;he study of non-Bantu languages. But these six prefixes are used
only when the sub ject; is personal . F o r n o n p e r sonal t;hird person
s ubj e c t s
prefixes .
( and f o r
t he n o u n t h a t
inyama ziraziimvye
< bread i s
e xpensive <
For this reason, it will be necessary in this discussion of verb forms, to glance briefly at the nouns of t;he language.
I n s o me , b u t ; n o t ; a l l
c as es ,
t h e s t u d e nt
wi l l
so o n l e ar n t o
perceive an alliterative relat;ionship between the subject prefix of a verb and the pr efix t'hat begins t;he noun subject of
t 'hat v e r b . After each of the words in the list, write either /iraziimvyye / or /uraziimvye/ or /biraziimvye /:
Umukaa t;e Imikaat;e I bi i n t u I mi d u g a I bi t abo Umuduga
/ /
<Bread
i s e xp en s i v e . <
[uraziimvye]
a r e ex p e n s i v e . >
expensi v e . <
i s ex p e n s i v e . > [ ur az i i m v y e ]
Generally, about half of the pr efixes are used wit;h singular m eaning, and most; of t;he rest; are used with plural meaning . Most n o u n s t ; e ms , t ; h e n , o c c ur
Xix
wi t h a t
l ea s t
t wo p r e f i x e s
one
SYNOPSIS
KIRUNDI
>orange<
<oranges<
t thi n g t > thing s I <name t
>names <
etc .
In general,non-personal noun stems that have /umu-/ in the s ing u l a r h a v e /imi-/ in the plural, stems that have / i k i - /
in
t he s i n g u l a r
a re s ome e x c e p t i o n s .
W hat is the plural form that corresponds to each of t h e f ollowing singular noun s :
[ i k i i nt u ] [umushuumba] [umukaraani]
BASIC CO U R SE
SYNOPSIS
i bi r a a t o
i mi n w e i mi p a k a
[ iki r a a t o ]
[umunwe]
[umupakaj
Matching of the sub ject prefix of the verb w ith the pr e f ix o f the noun sub j ect is ca lled CONCORD .
tclasses< in Kirundi.
In the following pairs of sentences, the concordial prefixes have been underlined. S tate whether the two nouns ( doubl e under l i n i ng ) are in the same class, or in di fferent class es : c aa n j e caanje kirX h e ?
k ir sh e ?
Ikiraato
I ~ki c or i
[ same c l a s s j
Ikiraato I gi t ab o
c aanj e k
ir ih e ?
my shoe?> my book?>
[ same c l a s s j
caanj e
k i r Xhe ?
Ikiraato I kii n a ~
caaw e za a w e ~
kir xh e ? r i r Xh e '?
<Where i s
arche?
Umudu a ~
/
different
wa awe
u rXh e ?
clas s e s ]
Impuuzu Zm uuzu ~
/
gaanj e zaanje
irxhe?
>Where i
s my c l o t h ? <
different
z ir X h e ?
cl as s e s)
SYNOPSIS
KIRUNDI
, i s n e v e r r eThe
object prefix reflects the class of the object of the verb, just
a s the subject prefix reflects the class of the su b j e ct . Por
most classes, the subject and ob ject prefixes are id en tical in s hape. T h e o b j e c t pr efix follows the subject prefix and s tan d s b ef o r e t h e s t em : >tha t w e sh o u l d r e c ei v e t h em>
i mmedi a t e l y
t ubi r o o n k e
(e.g.
b abir o o n k e
b aki r o o n k e b azi r o o n k e
<that they should receive them< <that they should receive it< ( e.g. / i k i i n t u/ ~the thing~ )
> that they should receive th em >
( e.g .
/ i m p u u zu / > c lo t h e s <)
b e u se d wh e t h e r o r n o t
t his respect the ob ject prefix of a B antu verb is sim ilar to th e o bject pronouns of many Eur opean languages . A l i s t of subject
and object prefixes is found below. The numbers are those which
are customarily a s s i gned to t h e se classes in t he s t u dy of Ba n t u u sed throughout this cour s e .
1 sg
1 pl . 2 sg 2 pl .
BASIC CO U R SE
SYNOPSIS
C lass 1 C lass 2 3 4
-mu-ba-wu-
-ya- ki -
7 8
- bi - yi -
10
Z1.
-Z1.
-ru12
13 14 15 16 18
tu-
'tu-
mu-
Choose the correct object prefix for t;he second sentence in each pair . in par e n t;heses . T h e c l a s s n umber for the noun ob j ect; is given
Ba
Ba
guri i s ha .
>They s e l l t h em. > g u r i i sh a . gu r i i sh a . gu r i i s h a . g u r i i sh a .
(4)
Ba Ba Ba
E-yi- ] [ -z i - ]
[-ya-]
x xi i i
SYNOPSIS
KIRUNDI
[object prefix] [ subj e c t [st em] [non-final suffix] [subject prefix] [object prefix] [final suffix] p r ef i x ]
T uyik e n e y e . B azig o r o o r a .
B abi ~ u r i i sh a .
[base]
Pick out the part of each word that is named by the grammatica l t er m:
The subject prefix in / bagura/ . >they s e l l < The object prefix in /t u b i b ona /. < we see t h e m < T he s t e m i n /tuyarimiisha /. iwe cause them to cultivate< T he bas e i n /tuyarimiisha /. The non-final suffix in /tuyarimiisha /. The r oo t i n /tuyarimiisha /.
[bagura]
[ tu b i b o n a ] [ tuyar i m i i s h a ] [tuyarimiisha] [tuyarimiisha] [tuyarimiisha]
T he separate verb forms which may be c o n structed on a s i n g l e verb base in Kirundi number in the thousands . P o r t u n a t e ly , th e
s ystem by wh ich they are fo rmed is not so comp licated as th i s m ight suggest. Many of them differ from one an o ther only in t h e i dentity of the su b ject and/or object prefixes which they con ta in . In -eneral, the choice of one of th ese prefixes r a t h e r t h an a n o t h e r
x xi v
BASIC CO U R SE
SYNOPSIS
does not; have any effect on the meaning of the r ema ining part of
the verb form, or the grammat;ical structures in which it; may be used. For this reason, it is possible t;o make a preliminary
d ivision of th e th ousands of forms into about 60 <s e t s< . A SET
of forms is defined for purposes of t'his discussion as in c luding all verb forms which differ from one ano ther only wit;h respect to their bases and th eir subject and ob ject; prefixes.
Which two in each of t;hese groups of three verbs are in the same <set>? b azootaangur a
b azoo k o r a
( The bas e o f
e a c h v e r b h a s b e e n u n d e r l i ne d . ) [ bazoot;aangur a ] [ bazookor a ]
wil l do >
bakora
~they ( will )
>I>m l o o k i n g
do~
f or > [ ndoonder a ]
ndoondera
n dor a n zoo .e e n d a
[ndora]
<I w i l l go t
nt;ibamesuura ndaba
/
[ntibamesuura]
n t i t u ~vu a
> we don<t
speak>
[ nt i d u v u g a ]
b ageen d a
/
[bageende] [mutaangure]
There are 21 sub ject prefixes and 21 ob j ect; prefixes, plus t;he possibility of the absence of an object prefix, so that; for any
21 or
441.
SYNOPSIS
KIRUNDI
c o n t r a s t i n g se t s i n wh i ch t h ey
A l l 6 0 s e t s ar e c o m -
T h a t i s , i t is p o s s ible to say d e f in -
on e :
see>
>
< they h a v i n g
>they not < we wor k > <we don > t
Dimension 2 :
M o o d . T h i s is a f o u r - way contras t .
T he o v e r t
r epresentation of th ree of the four ca tegories is found in t h e t ones; the fourth is chara cterized by a v o wel before the su b j e c t p refix . A l l 6 0 s e t s a r e c ommit t e d o n t h i s d i men s i o n . Th e f o u r
categories differ with respect to the syn tactic positions in which they are us ed : i n d i c a t ive forms are used in main clauses,
xxvi
BASIC CO U R SE
SYNOPSIS
relative forms as modifiers of substantives, autonomous forms as substantives, and participial forms in other dependent verb positions.
Most; typically, the relative form has a t one on th e sy l lable a fter the beginning of the ro o t .
Choose the better rough translation for each verb, and say w hether it is IN D ICATIVE, or RELATIVE : babona
[ >who s e e< :
REL. ]
babona
t they s e e >
w ho s e c t
[ >they
see>: I N D. ]
ageenda
t he g o e s > w ho g o e s t
[ th e g o e s t . . I N D . ]
ageenda
> he g o e s t w ho g o e s t
[t . . .
wh o g oes<: R EL.]
bamesuura
[t . . .
w h o l aun d e r t :
RE L . ]
b ataangur a
t they
begi n >
[ t t h e y b e g i n t : I ND . ]
ziziimvye
t they
z izi i m v y e
t they
x xv i i
SYNOPSIS
/
KIRUNDI
biziimbuutse
[ >which a r e c h e a p > ]
P articipial forms have a tone on the first vowel af ter th e first consonant . C h o o s e th e b e t ter rough translation for ea ch
babona
[>they
s e e i n g < : PART. ]
amesuura
[ <he l a u n d e r s > : I N D . ]
amesuura
u shob o r a
[ >you ar e
u shob o r a
[>you b e i n g
a b l e > : P ART
m ushobo r a
C hoose the nearest translation, and say wh e ther each v e r b f orm is INDICATIVE, RELATIVE, or PART ICIPIAL : babona
[<they
seeing<:PART.]
babona
[>.. .
w h o s e e > : R EL . ]
x xvi i i
BASIC COURSE
SYNOPSIS
babona
[ >they s e e > : I N D . ]
i zii mbuut se
> it i >it
[ <i t
b e in g c heap>:
PART. ]
bashobora
[ .. .
w h o a r e ab l e < : REL.]
The aut;onomous mood has an extra vowel before the s ubj e c t prefix. C h oose the better t;ranslation, and state whether each
f orm is RELATIVE, or AUTONOMOUS :
babona
[<.. .
w h o s e e > : R EL . ]
ababona
z izi i m v y e
[ <.. .
iziziimvye
[ >ones t h a t AUT.]
a r e ex p e n s i v e
a baroonder a
[ <ones who
s e e k > : AUT. ]
b agoroor a
who i r
on >
[ >.. .
w h o i r on < : R E L . ]
SYNOPSIS
KIRUNDI
( Dimensio n
/
1 ) or a s
/
bageenda,
b ageen da , b ageen da ,
/
b a t a g e e n da
nt i bag e enda bag eenda
[MOOD]
[MOOD]
zitaziimvye, zitaziimvye
D imen s i o n
3:
T i me r e l a t i on s .
the members of the c on trast are pr efixes made up of v o w els an d consonants except that the hodiernal-hesternal distinction depends
on tone. T h ese prefixes stand just before the object prefix or before the stem if there is no object prefix. All 60 sets are committed
on thi s d i me n s i o n . Th e mea n i n g s h a v e t o d o wi t h ma t t er s s om e o f
> tense>,
as our
<mood> (in a sense different from that in which we have named < Dimension 2 > ). T h e
t e n ses have to do w ith the p l acement of K i r u n d i d i s tinguishes four of
The a s p e c t u a l
the persistive, which calls attention to the fact that an a c t ion i s still going on .
The form with modal meaning that is in cluded in Dim ension 3 is the conditional, which is roughly equivalent to En g lish verb
BASIC CO U R SE
SYNOPSIS
phrases with
wo u ld or m i g h t .
All seven of th ese forms are classed together wit;hin a s ingl e d i me n s i o n b e ca u s e t h e y a r e m u t u a l l y ex c l u s i v e wi t ; h o n e A l s o , a s ha s a l r eady been point;ed out, they are a l l i n 0h e c a s e o f t h e i mm e d i a t ; e t e n s e , i n t;h e v e r b s t r u c t; u r e .
a nother .
r epr e s e n t e d b y p r e f i x es ( or ,
The tense t'hat; refers t;o past act;ions within t;he present
d ay ( t h e
t e n s e) i s
c h a r a c t e r i z e d b y a n /- a- /
i m me-
>I d i d .
. . . (sometime today )
M ost; subject prefixes have a s l ightly different form when th e y s t an d b e f o r e a v owe l : a soma . . .
<he/she r e a d s . . <he/she
..>
we g o . . . . T
< we went . .
~you (pl . )
g o .. . . ~
).>
( s o me t i m e t o d a y ) . >
Choose the better approximate translation, and state wh e ther t he verb is IMMEDIATE t;ense, or HODIERNAL ten s e :
Nataanguye . . .
Nkor a kaz i .
[ hodi e r n a l ] [ immedia t e ]
KIRUNDI
[ hodiern a l ]
[ hodi e r n a l j [ immedia t e ] [ hodi e r n a l j
B aasomye. . . .
B asomye. . . .
[ immedia t e ]
today). <
The hesternal or <yesterday<, tense differs from t;he hodiernal in having a t;one on the subject; prefix.
Choose the appropriate time expression, and st;ate whet;her each of t;he following verb forms is HESTERNAL or HODIERNAL:
Baaboony e i ki ?
/
Baaboonye i k i ?
r
Plwaariiye iki?
> What di d
y o u (pl. )
e a t ( t ; o day)
( bef or e
t o d a y)
?l
HODIERNAL]
[HESTERNAL]
Baavuuyehe?
< Where di d
t ; h e y c o me
el
from {t;oday)
( bef or e t oday
)~
The immediate tense may be u sed in t;alking about; the immediate fut;ure, but verbs that refer t;o more remot;e future
S tat e
w h e t h e r ea ch o f
x xxi i
B ASIC C O U R SE
SYNOPSIS
i mmediat e ) bageenda
FUTURE:
[IMM. ] [FUT.]
[FUT. ]
b azoo g e e n d a t uzoosh i k a
found at; t;he very end of the verb form: e ach imperfect;ive ends in some consonant plus /-a/, while the corresponding perfective e nds i n /-e/; t'his /-e/ is preceded either by a consonant; dif-
/y/.
i consi d e r e d
c o mp l e t e < i n Ki r un d i .
t h e s et s t hat
I n a l l , 44 s et; s
ar e not, a r e t h e h av e t h e c on-
c o m m i t t e d on t ;h i s d i me n s i o n ;
3 ), whic h
S tat;e whet'her each of these verbs is PERFECTIVE , or I MPERFECTIVE : n dahag e z e u raken ey e u zoo t a a n g u r a >I<v e a r r i v ed h e r e >
ndoondera
m looking for~
x xx i i i
SYNOPSIS b arar i m a
s inuumvi i s e
/
KIRUNDI
[IXPEm. ] [PERF ]
Dimension 5 :
To n e C l a ss .
two is found in th e p r e s ence of a h igh tone in c e r tain forms of one verb, and the ab s ence of high tone in the co rresponding forms o f other verbs . O n l y 1 3 s e t s are committed with respect to th i s
G iven below are th ree forms of a h igh ve rb , and the c o rr e s ponding forms of a low v e rb . St a t e w h ich verb is in th e H I GH
t on e c l a s s , a n d wh i ch i s i n t h e L OW t o ne cl a s s . n aboon y e
kubona babona
/
[HIGH]
nari mye
k ur i m a b ar i m a
/
[r,ow]
Do t h e
t h e t wo v er b s / - t a a n g u r a <thos e w h o b eg i n >
/ and / - g o r o o r a / :
< we ir o n e d
(today) <
( toda y ) <
b azoogoro o r a
BASIC COURSE
SYNOPSIS
I s t h e s t e m /-taangura/ in t;he HIGH class, or t;he LOW? I s t h e s t e m /- goroor a / in t;he HIGH class, or the LOW?
[HIGH] [LOW]
D imensio n 6 :
e. Lanka
1ts
Only ten sets are committed with re spect; to t;his dimension . signif'cance of the d i stinction is grammat;ical: t he c o n j u n c t
must be followed by some kind of ob j ect or other word to w h ich it, is closely tied . T h e d i s j u nct; may be used without a f o l lowing
object', or with a following object; where t;here is no c los e c o n nect'ion between verb and object.
Place a period after each disjunct form , to c an be i-.he last word in a s e n tence .
signify that; it
P lace t h r e e d o t s ( . . . )
aft er
t ;he conjunct forms, to signify that; it must be followed by s o m e thing furt;her. n avuz e
/
< I sp o k e > I sp o k e
( bef or e ( bef or e
today)< t oday)<
naravuz e t ur i i y e
/
i'ur a r i
i ye
The i n t er s e c ' c i o n o f
t h e s e s i x d i men si o n s wi t h o n e an o t h er
accounts for over 90 per c ent of the forms of any K i r undi. verb. There are how ever a few set;s of forms which lie out;side this framework . M o s t i m p ort;ant are the subjunct;ive, i;he infinit;ive, T h e s e ar e d i fferentiated for Dim ension 1
xxxv
SYNOPSIS
KIRUNDI
The discussion of subject and object prefixes showed one important role which concordial agreement plays in the operation of the Kirundi language. A list of concordial
c lasses was given on p . x , t o g e t her with a l ist of the p r e -
f ixes which represent those classes where the sub j ects of ve rb s a re concerned.
l anguage :
C lass 8 : I b i r i i bwa mu f ise ni ibi k i ?
( <Foods t h a t - y o u - h a v e a re w h i c h ? > )
C lass 10 :
I m p u u z u m u f ise ni in k i ?
C lass 8 : C lass 1 0 :
are. <
Z ana i mpuuzu .
Ngi i z i .
[ a r t i cl es o f ) c l ot hi ng . <
t he y ar e . <
C lass 3 :
Clas s 12 :
Um u d u g a w aawe n i
m wii z a . Ak a z i k a aw e n i k eeza .
Compare these two sh ort dialogues, which are id en tical e xcept for the fir s t n oun and the concords that depend upon i t .
/ /
Barafise impuuzu?
Eego, Baf i s e Oya, Ni b a raz i f i s e . ~n i i n s h i ? b a f i se n k e .
/ /
>[Do]
< Yes, t h e y
z i i n ga a h e ? gu s a .
( <[They ]
Zi t a a n u
> Five o n l y .
x xxv i
BASIC CO U R SE
SYNOPSIS
Barafise ibit;abo?
/
>Do t;hey h av e
b o o k s ?>
Eego, b a r a b i f
B af i s e O ya,
/
i se .
~ v i i n sh i ? ba f i s e bak e .
b ii n gaahe ? Bit a an u g us a .
( >[They ]
< Five o n l y .
c onver s a t i o n :
/
Baf ise
/
Eego bar a y a f i
Baf i s e
meenshi ?
[ m-]
[ma-j
[aa-]
T hi s
c o nc l u d e s t; h e p or t i on of
t h e s y n op s i s wh i ch i s d e v o t ; e d
t;o grammar.
x xx v i i
SYNOPSIS
KIRUNDI
( 1) t h e pres-
ordinary writing, ( 2)
t h e a b s e n c e of tone marking, ( 3) t h e
The tones
e, i,
o , and u . A n y o n e
of these may occur either single length or double length: /guhaga/ >to force, fill with airI with a short vowel, where /kuhaaga/ <to e at e n o u gh < ha s a l o n g v owel .
n ot
occur
in
/
t he p h r a s e s p e l l e d /ni Umuruundi /
/
The w o r d
w h i ch stem
c onsists of the pr efix whose usual form is /ba-/ and th e whose usual form is
x xx v i i i
BASIC CO U R SE
SYNOPSIS
Which of the following words, taken from a number of other Bantu languages as well as Kirundi, conform to the Kirundi pattern of vowel use?
k ut a u r a
neeza
kiongozi
[neeza]
[nyama] [idya]
[eego]
g a nt u u
( a f o r m o f a d d r e s s)
[ntuu]
af ter a combi-
nation of a consonant followed by /w/ or /y/. They are also usually, but, not always, long before a nasal consonant (/m/, < semivowel s <
/w/ and /y/. T his does not apply to vowels at the beginning or
How would each of th ese Kirundi words be r e spelled to v owel length, according to the above general rul es ?
show
SYNOPSIS
KIRUNDI
kugenda g utangur a
umwaka
[kugeenda] [gutaangura]
[umwaaka]
kimwe
imyak a u mudanda z a u mwubat s i
[kimwe]
[imyaaka ] [umudaandaza] [umwuubatsi] [amasaangaanzira] [ i n d wi ]
a masaangaanzi r a
in d wi
The phonetic values of these vowels are roughly the same as the values usually assigned to the Engli s h le t t ers in most other languages.
w o r d s c o n t a i n i n g t h e c l os e s t E n g li sh a p p r o x i m a t i o n s t o
read, red, rod ( Ameri c a n
T he consonants of Kirun d i . K irundi, like most Bantu languages, is a language in wh i c h consonants occur only at the b eginning of a s y l l ab le, never a t
the end. A syllable may begin with something very simple (e.g.
/ f/ ) ,
( e.g. / mfw/ ) .
D ivide the following Kirundi words into syllables : k uger a umuunt u i nzi r a >to ar r i v e <
a masaangaanzi r a
<intersection<
B ASIC C O U R SE
SYNOPSIS
i t a a n dukaan i r o ibaanki
[i-taa-ndu-kaa-ni-ro] [ i-baa-nki ]
The more complex consonantal combinations conform to a p attern which may be of i n t erest to students of the langua g e :
(iy)
( shy) s h
f pf
s
'ts
(cy)
( Those e n c l o s e d
(2) Corresponding to the three columns of obstruents, there are three NASAL consonants, spelled m ( Col. 1 ) , n ( C o l . 2 ), an d
n ~
( C ol . 3 ) .
, s h, n y /
p r e c edes
ceded by the nasal from the same column, but wh en a n obstruent, it is sp elled n .
W hich of these words, taken from Kirundi and o ther Ban tu languages, conform t o t h e K i r u ndi rules for combinations of
SYNOPSIS
KIRUNDI
impuuzu mtoto n ti b a b a
in g o ma w amshi n d a mgeni mugeenz i inka
[ >cloth >]
[ >the y d o n < t r es i d e < ]
['drum'J
)]
[ >catt l e > ]
(3) A third group of consonants consists of the two SEMIVOWELS, /w/ and /y/. M ost nasals, obstruents, and combinations of nasals plus obstruents, also occur followed by / w/ a n d
/y/
( 4) T h e s o u nds / r / a n d /h/ may be followed by semivowels,
[ >admini s t r a t i o n > ]
[<we have<]
[ <here t h e y a r e > ]
isa
u mucher i iceenda
[ >ni n e > ]
xii i
BASIC CO U R SE
SYNOPSIS
of Kirundi will be d e s cribed wit;h reference t;o four sets of physical characterist;ics: l. O n e s e t of p h y s i cal charact;erist;ics has to do with th e
part;s of t;he t;ongue and mouth that are involved in forma tion of each sound . P h o n e t i c symbo ls, based as closely as po s s ible on
the Kirundi spelling system, are given in square brackets. a. B ilabial (i.e. both lips) . Kir u nd i b. c.
T h e b i l a b ial soun ds of
Lab i o d e n t ;al ( i . e . Ap i co d e n t a l ( ti p
[ s] ,
d.
[ z] , etc .
Pal a t a l ( middl e o f t ong u e a t ha r d pa l at e ) : [ c ] , [sh j ,
[jj. (NB The symbol sh is to be regarded as a unit;, and not as representing s plus h.
b een c h o s e n i n or d er This compound symbol ha s
t ;o av o i d c on f l i c t ; wi t h t h e est a b l i sh e d
spelling of Kirundi. )
e.
( D o r s o)vel ar s
P revel a r s :
( b a c k o f t on g u e a t t h e s of t ; p a l a t e ) : [ k ] ,
[gl.
(like the velars, but' a lit;tie farther
forward in the m ou th
) : [k'] ,
[ g' ] .
2. A
t he kind of closure which the sound requires . a. S o m e h a v e m om en tary but; complete stoppage of the a i r T h e s e ar e c a l led STO PS . Some of the stops of
s tream.
Kirundi
a r e s y mbol i z e d b y [ p ] , [ b ] , [ t ] , [ d ] , [ k j , f k ' ] ,
[ g],
[g']
x li i i
SYNOPSIS
KIRUNDI
b. S ome have audible friction, but without complete stoppage, at some point. They are called PRICATIVES.
Some fri c a t i v e s
a r e : [ f j , [ v ] , [ s] , [ z j . [ sh ] .
3. A
strength of ar ticulation .
a.
[p ] , [ X'], [ t ] , [ s] , [ k] , [k ' ] ,
[sh], with aspiration (i.e. a strong puff of air ) f o l lowing the strongly articulated stops. WEAK ( ~leni s > ) ar t i c u l a t i o n :
[ b ] , [ v ] p [ d ] , [ z ] , [ g ] p[ g ] p [ / ] .
4. The last pair of physical characteristics are presence and absence of voice vibration during the production of the sound.
a.
[ g], [ j ] .
[g], [ z ] ,
[i] .
The relationships among these four sets of physical characteristics, in the language as it is actually spoken, may be shown most clearly by a series of diagrams.
t
e4
s
etc.
Dia g r a m xli v
l a.
BASIC CO U R SE
SYNOPSIS
In Diagram la, the area within the upper circle stands for all stops, and the lower circle for all fricatives. T hat is to say, any sound that requires stoppage should be shown within
t he upper circle, and any that requires friction within th e l owe r o n e . Th e c i r cl e s a re s h o w n a s ov e r l ap p i n g b e c a u s e of
As the next step in developing a visual representation of i-,he relationships among Kirundi obstruents, we may remove the circles, leaving a single straight-line axis: STOPS: p , t, b , etc .
AFFRICATES'
pf ,
t s , bv , et c .
F RICATI V ES :
f , s , v , et c .
vs .
c ombined on a s i n gle ax i s :
p pf sh etc .
bv etc ~ ei -.c
D ia g r a m
2.
xlv
SYNOPSIS
KIRUNDI
A third axis shows points of articulation, from the ones farthest forward in the mouth to those that are farthest back:
k etc .
c
f etc .
etc. ~ d en t a l ~ pal at al
etc .
~ p r e v e l ar
v el ar
etc .
~ ~
etc .
~
l abio de n t a l
b ila b i a l
Diagram 3 These three dimensions may be combined as in Diagram 4. In Diagram 4, solid lines connect points that stand for sounds
t hat actually occur in Kirun di . the viewer see the diagram in D a s h e d l i nes are a d ded to h e lp perspective . T h e d i s t i n c tion
b etween narrow and heavy so lid lines stands for a k ind of i n f o r mati o n w h i ch h a s n o t b een m e n ti on e d u p t o t h i s p o i n t .
from one another by comparatively small physical differences, may be treated as di stinct from one anoth er . J u s t w h i c h g r o ups of So for
example, in EnElieh we eay that ~z 'ingin a n d ~ri ~i~n ar e d i f f e ren t w ords, and we ar e v ery cl early aware of the diff erence be tween th e c onsonant sounds in the m i d dle of th em . I n J a p a n e se , the same tw o
s ounds are treated as in terchangeable, they never distinguish wor d s from one another, and a n a t ive speaker of Japan ese normally does n ot notice the difference between th em . s ol i d l i n e s c on n e c t s ou n d s t h a t I n D i a g ra m 4 , t h e n , h e a v y
a r e , wi t h i n t h e e c on o m y o f K i r u n d i ,
( In l i n -
BASIC CO UR SE
SYNOPSIS
velar
I
[g]
p reve l a r
[a'
J
I
[g'
/ /
/
I I
I I
I
/
/
I
I
[
/
'[d)
[dg
/
/
/ /
/
/
/
/
/
/ J
[s ]
/
' ~ pal a t a l
/
/
/
/ J
/
/
/
J
/
[es]
[dz]
[dz
/ /
/
/
/ /
[s]
[z]
/
/
[z]
/
/
dent;al
/
/
[p
a/
I
/
/
I
I
I
J
/
/
/ /
/ /
I
[pf
I
L
/
I
/
/
[f
I I I /
[v [4
[v
~
.~
l abi odenbal
IJ
bi l a bial D iagram 4 .
x lvi i
SYNOPSIS
KIRUNDI
guistic terminology, they are >allophones> of a single <phoneme>. Thus, the voiced fricative [z ], the voiceless [z], the voiced and
voiceless affricates [dz], [dz] are all members of a single Kirundi phoneme, usually written / z/ . Not e t h e pa r al l el r el a t i on s h i p s
among / g/ ( [ j ] , [ j ] , [ dj ] , [ dj ] ) , a nd /v/
bilabial fricative [b] .
( [ v j , [v ] , [ b v j , [b v ] ) .
The phoneme /b/ includes the voiced stop [b], but also the voiced The ph o n e me/ d/ i n c l u d e s [ d ] , wh i c h l i k e
[b] is a voiced stop, but the other allophone of /d/ is an unvoiced, w eakly articulated stop [d], rather than a voiced fricative. T h e diagram thus summarizes in graphic form not only the symmetries but also the violations of symmetry which are to be found in the
r elationships among the ob struent consonants of Kirund i .
/p/
[~h]
Af t er m
i mpuuz u
o f air, usually but not always preceded by very brief complete stoppage of the air at the lips,
and a l s o a t t h e en t r an c e t o t h e
w it h
[p"]
B ASIC C O U R SE
SYNOPSIS
[' h] Aft;er n
to the
n a sal p a s sages.
[Tech-
nically, a voiceless heavily aspirated apicodent;al stop, alt;ernat;ing freely wit'h a strong [h]-like sound.
/
< to b e g i n >
13E
complete st;oppage of the air stream by the tongue t;ip at the upper teeth, followed by a noticeable puff of air. [Technically, a voiceless fortis aspirated apicodent;al
a ges.
The s t o p p a g e i n t ; h e
b ack o f
t he t; o n gu e a n d a n xli x
SYNOPSIS
KIRUNDI
a rea n ea r
t h e b o u n d ar y o f
and o t h e r
kuroonka
<to r e c e i v e >
ate.
[Technically, a
ated ( dors o ) v e l a r
st op ,
alternating freely with a strong [h]-like sound. ) [kx'] B efore i , e after n and n o t gukenera <what< < to n e e d >
: m om e n t ary
[Technically, a voicel es s p r ev e l a r g r o ov e
affricate.]
B ASIC CO U R SE
SYNOPSIS
[k~]
umukaate guk or a
t bread s
t to dot
[b]
Af t er m
: C o m p l et;e stop-
imboga igit;aambara
<veget a b l
es >
at the
e n t r a n c e t o t; h e n a Voi ce v i br a-
s al p a s s a g es .
t;ion continues throughout the stoppage. [ Technically, a voiced bilabial stop.] < to wor k wood<
kubaaza
b ash i t s e
[b], a s above , o r a s ou n d
in which audible friction
kuraaba
]
ndoondera abaandi
>I l o o k f or >
[d]
Af t;e r
n :
Co m plet;e b e t ;ween
stoppage b o t h
>other
( people ) >
SYNOPSIS
KIRUNDI
t he s t o p p a g e .
[ Techni a Pi c o -
c ally, a voiced l e n i s
dental stop.]
/
[dj 0
umuduga daata
>automobile<
gamy fathert
/g/
and
e : Co mplete
t he t o n g u e a n d a n a r e a near t h e b o u n d ar y o f t he
/ i/ , / e / :
Stoppage
B ASIC C O U R SE
SYNOPSIS
a s fo r
[ g ] (a b o v e ), fo l l o wed
(below). [Technically, a
v oi ce d p r e v e l a r gr o o v e affricate. ] umug5re kugaruk a >woman, wi f e <to r e t u r n I <
[g]
O t herwise after n ,
and
between the back of the t;ongue and the soft; palate. [ Technically, a voiced velar stop.j
[ g] , [ g I ' ]
+1
N ot; a f t e r / n y / :
c ount;erpar t
When
/g/
/ny/, it is
u nl i k e
is symbolized by placing a
SYNOPSIS
KIRUNDI
small
c i r c l e be n e a t h t he [Technically, a
l ett e r .
v oiceless lenis stop o r affricate. ] [ f] Audible friction produced b y constriction of the air
flow between the lower lip
gu fa s h a im f u r a
and uppe r
t ee t h .
Voi c e
/s/
[ s]
Ve ry m u c h l i k e E n g li s h s in see, but perhaps a bit farther forward toward the tip of the tongue and the back of the upper teeth. [Technically: a voiceless fortis apicodental s lit fricative . j
gusa
ns orna
/sh/
ubushaza
n shob o r a
liv
BASIC COURSE
SYNOPSIS
/v/
[v]
Af t er m
li s h
v i n ev e r .
[ v], [ b v ] [ bv], [ v ]
Elsewhere :
l i k e [ v] ,
ex cept
kuvuga kuva
t ;hat; t;he f r i c t; i o n ma y b e p r e ceded by moment;ary st;oppage a8 the lips [bv], and the sound may be voiceless but weakly articulat'ed [ v],
[bv].
inzoka <snake>
/z/
[z]
After n
: V e r y much like
English z in ~laze, hut perhaps farther forward t;oward the tongue tip and the back of t h e u p p e r t ; e e t ;h . [Tech-
[z ] , [ d z ] [ z] , [ d z ]
E l s ew h e r e :
L ik e
[ z ] , ex c e p t
[dz].
nje >that I go <
z
[j]
Af t ; er
Somewh a t ; l i k e
c o n s o n ant ; i n ~u e .
lv
SYNOPSIS
KIR UNDI
[g] , [ d j ]
0 O D
El s ew h e r e :
[J], [dj] that the friction may be preceded by momentary stoppage [dJ], and the sound may be
voiceless but weakly artic-
u lated [ j ] , f d g ] . [ pf ] L i k e K i r u n d i [ p ] ( wit h o u t
the puff of air ) p l u s K i r u n d i [f]. [Technically, a voiceless fortis labial affricate.] gupf a > to d i e ~
/pf/
/t s/
[ ts ]
L i k e K i r u n d i [ t ] ( wit h o u t
the puff of air ) p l u s K i r u n d i [ s] . [ Tec h n i c a l l y , a v oi c e-
g uts i i n d a A batuut s i
/c/
[c]
Li k e Ki r un d i [ sh ] p r ec e d e d by momentary stoppage at
t he same position .
gucura umuceri
[Tech-
/m/
[ m]
V e r y m u c h l i k e E n g li s h m .
[Technically, a bilabial
B ASIC C O U R S E
SYNOPSIS
/n/
[n] Like English n except that stoppage in the mouth is made farther forward tow ard the tip of the ton -
ub u m a nuko
>south >
gue an d
the back of t he
]
. Li k e
/ny/
[g ]
B e f ore k
nkora g utaangur a
tI
do >
> to b e g i n <
St o ppage
i n t h e m o u t h i s at t he
soft palate.
[ Techni -
[ny]
El s e w h e r e :
Nu ch l i k e t he ~ n i n Fr en c h
inyoni k uny w a
s ounds s p e l l e d
~ a ner , o r n i n Spa n i s h caPion. Stoppage in the mouth is at the hard palate. (Note
t ha t t h e l e t t e r s ~ n , a s us e d
h ere b o t h
b e t ween //
and be-
/y/ .
T hi s
s y mbol
h as been a d o p t e d i n or de r
to minimize conflict with lvi i
SYNOPSIS
[ T ech-
nically, a palatal nasal continuant.] A flap, or tap of the tongue tip against the gum ridge. k uroonder e r a < to l o o k f or , f or someone>
/ h/ [h j
[R]
Something like English h in how, except that voicing may continue throughout the
aha heehe
>here> <where'?~
durati o n o f
t h e s o un d ( [ 5 ] ) .
Pronounced umwaana
/
> chil d > > clot h i n g > <man>s s ist e r < s c hi l d < < accord i n g to >
icaambarwa
/sw/ often sounds like [skw], umwiishwa /mw/ usually sounds like [my], /rw/ may sound like [rgw],
with or without a short vowell ike s o u n d b e t w ee n t h e [ r j [ gj . kubwa
and t h e
B ASIC C O U R SE
guage who c a n
s e r v e a s t u t or .
u ne p e r s o n n e
p ar l e l a
tape recordings which most students will find useful. This course is quite frankly short, and covers only the fundamentals of the language. A n yone who completes it should be able to do three things: l. He should be able t;o use fluently and wit;h good pronunciati o n a f ew o f t h e mos t ; c o m mon
1 >etudiant .
D e p l us, il
/
e xist e
u n e s e r i e de b a n d e s
f ranchi se , abrege e t
/ /
c e c o u r s e s t un n e c o u v r e q u e l es
understand easily, and employ readily, the fundamental grammati cal devices of the langua g e ,
q uelque s p h r a s e s e t que l q u e s
mots di susagecour a n t
Kiru n d i . 2. I l
en
d o i t p o u v o ir
3.
H e s h o u l d b e a c c u s t o m ed
comprendre fa cilement et employer aisement les tournures grammaticales e lementaires telles que le s
to taking increasing amounts of' responsibility in the pr o c ess of learning more of t;he language, w ith the help of Ba r u ndi who a r e
KIRUNDI
T hese ar e o f the
0 h e t hr e e g o a l s
en plus de responsabilites
/
r echer c h an t
qui n e
/ /
s e r a i e n t p as
necessairement professeurs de
meti e r .
tongue without conscious effort, and without noticeable mispronunc ia t i o n s . ( Inacc u r a t e pr onun-
que 1<etudiant doit avoir presents a i<esprit pour determiner 1<usage du livre et des bandes magnetiques: l. Il doit repeter les p hrases d e s d i al o g u e s g u s q u < a
/
ciation, particularly of the tones, reduces intelligibility much more seriously in Kirundi than in many other African tone
ce qu>il puisse les debiter sans effort et sans erreur marquante de prononciation. (Vne mauvaise prononciation, par t i c u l i er e m en t d a n s l e s t on s ,
diminue beaucoup plu s serieusement 1 >intelligibilite e n K i r un d i qu e d a n s b ea u c o u p
languages.
once o r
t w i ce.
s h o u l d us e i n i t ia tive ,
3. H e
d <autr e s
> langues a
t o n s > .)
2. I l
d o i t t r a v a i ller
3. Il doit user lx
B ASIC C O U R SE
d>initiative, d>imagination
et d<ingeniosite pour trouver d es moyens d >augmenter sa par t de responsabilite dans 1>utilisation des ex er cices p ratiques . A i n s i , pa r ex emp l e ,
il ne se contentera pas de
/ /
difficulte a repeter apres le modele, il devra essayer d<anticiper la phrase suivante, que ce soit dans un dialogue ou dans u n
/
Specific suggestions for use of these materials will be given in Unit 1 and at other points throughout the course.
exercice; et, pl us
/
t ar d e s s a y e r d > a d a p t e r l es
textes ecrits ou en r e gistres
afin de pouvoir transposer les phrases apprises et les employer dans la situation
ou il s e t r ouv e .
On trouvera a l>Unite
I et tout le long du c o u r s , des suggestions par ticulieres p our 1>emploi de ces t ex t e s .
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 1
1.
a t; t ;h e
or
t;ender
d e s s ons semblables a
/ /
th e s o u n d s f o r
ceux r e p r e s e n t ;es pa r
c e s m e mes
lett;res en anglais ou dans une aut;re langue europeene. S > il attend d<avoir appris a prononcer la phrase en kirundi, il aura 1 < o c c a s i o n
/
d > e n t e n dr e l es
/
2.
2.
L i s t en i n
t; o t h e s e n t en c e s .
The tutor should begin by r eading t;he ent;ire list of bas i c sent;ences aloud t'wo or t'hree t i mes . Th e s t u d e nt sh o u l d l i s -
ten carefully, wit;hout trying to repeat;. Th e tu tor sh ou ld speak at all t;imes at; a normal c onve r s a t i on al s pee d . He
essayer
de r epet er.
L >i ns t r uc -
UNIT l
KIRUNDI slowly or more distinctly than he would ever speak with other persons for whom Kirundi is the
m other tongue . T h e s t udent<s
3.
Learnin to re eat the sentences after the i nst r u c t o r . The tutor should say the first sentence at normal speed, and l e t t h e s t u d e n t s i m i t a t e hi m. If their imitation is. completely c orr e c t , he sh o u l d t h e n g o o n
L >ins t r u c t e u r
premiere phrase a vitesse normale, et laisser les cleves 1<imiter. S i leur imitation est tout a fait correcte, il doit passer immediatement a la phrase suivante. L e livre des cleves est touJours ferme. a) Si la phrase semble trop longue, l~instructeur ne d oit e n p r o n o n c e r q u > un e p e -
to the next sentence. Th e student<s book is still closed. a) If the sentence seems to be too long, the tutor should pronounce one small part of it, then a slightly longer part,
a nd finally the entire sen ten c e .
tite partie, puis une plus longue, et finalement la phrase entiere. Par exemple, la phrase / Nkor a k u u b a a n k i y a Rwaanda Uruun di / decouper ainsi : peu t se
B ASIC C O U R S E
UNIT 1
U ruun d i .
N kora k u u
b a a nk i y a R w a a nda U r u u n d i . b) If a student still makes a mistake in pronunciation, the t;utor should correct him by repeating correctly the word t;hat the student has mispron ounced . So , f or ex a m p l e :
prononce. A insi, par exemple: T utor : S tudent : Tut;or: S tudent : T utor : S tudent : Trait;er ainsi toutes les
p hr a s e s d u di a l ogue .
( a mist a k e
4.
M a n i e r e d > a r en d r e l e s ens de s hr as e s .
4.
t endance a
l e u r do n n e r u n e
int;onat;ion anglaise .
t;ion s
o n t h e s en t e n c e s .
UNIT 1
KIRUNDI
M ainten an t
/
1>instructeur
Now the tutor should say the first sentence, and have the students repeat it after
h im. T h e n h e s h o uld g ive th e
phrase e n
k i r un d i .
Si
l es
E ach se n t e n c e s h o u l d b e t reated i n t hi s wa y , u nt i l t he
5.
Lectur e
a h a u t e v oi x .
N ow for the first tim e ,
s tudent s
s houl d o p e n t h e i r
boo k s a n d
h aute voix apres 1 >instructeur . Quand ils peuvent fa ire cela facilement ils peuv ent alors
e asi l y ,
q u e l e mo d e l e l eu r
so i t
donne.
Dans c e co u r s n ou s u t i l i so n s In the English equivalents f or Kirundi expressions in th i s
] et (
phrases
) et ( >
> ) dans l e s
BASIC C O U R S E
/
UNIT 1
],
) , and ( >
[
> ).
S quare
] renferment des
b rackets
words
] encl os e Engl i s h
w h i c h h a v e n o c ou n t e r p a r t
t r a n s l a t i o n s i n t o i d i oma t i c
E ngli s h .
Pa r en t h e s e s
( )
r enf e r ment d e s m o t s q u i s on t
/
les equivalents anglais de mots qui, en kirundi, sont necessaires a la phrase mais qui seraient inutiles dans la phrase anglaise. On se sert de parentheses avec guillemets <simples< pour indiquer une traduction litterale.
counterparts of something in the Kirundi sentence, but which would not ordinarily be used in the English equivalent. Parentheses with single quotes are used to indicate a literal English version of a sentence
Dial o
ue 1 .
[ ~
1A
~
iza
Bwaak e e y e .
neeza
well
[
2B
B waakeeye n e e z a .
i zina (5 , 6 )
/izina/)
aanje
ni
i s,
are
UNIT 1
KIRUNDI
]
3A Izi n a ryaanjye n i
[
Y ohaani .
o r: N i i twa Yohaani.
(>I am
-ri
to be
U munyaameeri k a
(1, 2)
]
4A Nd Umuny a a meer i k a .
/ - kora ( - k o z e )4
/
ku-
ibaanki
( 9, 6 o r
10)
/i b aanki
/.)
a genitival particle
--]
5B N di A a nd er e y a , nkora I<m Andre. I work at the b ank o f R u a n d a - U r u n d i .
]
kuu baank i y a R w a a nda
]
U ruun d i .
Jeewe
mu(ri )
in
[~
6A
-]
And I work at the Am e r i can
J eew e , nk o r a m u r i
BASIC COURSE
UNIT l
- ra -ha-
( a verb p r e f i x
is a
p l a c e)
- gera ( - g e z e )
vub6,
/
t o ar r i v e r ecen t l y
]
7A Ndaha g e z e v u b a .
nico I >ve just recently arrived he r e .
igi t u ma n taar i
(7, 8)
verb
bwaakubone
-bona (-boonye)
to see
[
8B A. [ ~
-]
A hJ T h a t > s t h e r ea s o n [ w h y ] I h a v e n ' t s e e n y o u [ bef o r e ] .
b waakub o n e .
9B
Ni neeza.
It<s
g o o d ( >well < )
[ t o s ee y o u] .
UNIT 1 Dial o ue 2.
KIRUNDI
1 0C
Nd . U m u n y aameeri k a .
i
I~m an American.
[1 1C W ew
l
Are ~o u an Am e r i c an ?
ur . U m u n y a a m e erika ? e i
[
12D Oya . Nd
]
U munya a f i r i k a . N o, I<m an African .
Dial o
ue 3 .
[
1 3E
i
w
Oy a . Nd
]
A re yo u a M u r u n d i ? Umu n y a r w a anda . No, I > m a M u ny ar wanda .
Ur . Um u r u u n d i ?
[
10F
Dial o
ue 4.
[
15G
3
U k o r a muri <consulat Do you work at; the American Consula t e ' ?
[
16H
a meric a i n < ?
]
- ]
Yes, I do . I wor'k. < (>It is there that
Eeg o .
Ni h o nk o r a .
[
179
Ug ez e h an o v u b a ?
]
Did y o u ar r i v e h er e v e r y r ecent ; l y ?
[~
1 8H Eego .
Y es , I di d .
B ASIC CO U R SE
UNIT
2. Numbers in parentheses after a noun indicate the sets of prefixes which are used with that noun and in w o rds wh ich ag ree wi th it. T h e n u m b e r b e f ore the comma ref ers to the singular, th e
3. The hyphen placed before a stem in the buildups indicates that the stem takes inflection for person-number and for tense. Such stems are called VERBS.
4.
T h e f i rst of the
is
s t ems w i l l
5.
Every Kirundi word ends with a vowel. M any Kirundi words begin
W h e n a w o r d t ha t b egins with a vo wel fo llows an o th er
with vowels .
word in the same phr a se, the final vowel of the word that pr e c ed es is usually omitted, or > elided.< I n o r d e r to r e m ind th e s t u d en t
o f this fact, the el ided vowel is dropped a bit b e low the l e v e l o f the line . I n connected speech, these elisions seem to be o b l i gatory . A t the same time, however, the student, should remember that if h e b reaks the chain of sp e ech by pau sing be tween wor ds , the fi n a l v owel of the word b e fore the pause must be pr onounced .
UNIT l
reading through Dialogues 2 and Q both with and without pauses between the words. For purposes of memorization, the elided form should be used exclusively.
6. E ach sentence in a dialogue is preceded by a number and a letter. The numbers run serially through all the dialogues of a single unit, and may be used for referring to individual sentences. The letters indicate the speaker. A f ter the dialogue has been learned, the instructor and individual students may thus take turns assuming >Role A,< >Role B> , et c.
l.
In order to understand many of the notes in this c ourse , i s n e c e s s ar y t o di s t i ngu i s h c l ea r l y b et w e e n < p i t c h < a nd < t o n e >
The word PITCH, as used here, will refer to the fundamental frequency of vibration of the vocal cords-to placement on a musical scale. The indication of absolute pitch would be useless; RELATIVE PITCH is shown graphically within square brackets.
l able boundaries are represented as breaks in th e l i n e .
Syl-
Vowel
i nzi r a
[ [ [
7 ]
pat h t o c l i mb o th e r s
~ ~
] ]
i t>s n i c e
10
BASIC COURSE
UNIT
>Pitch<, then, refers to a physical phenomenon measurable in the l abor a t o r y . Pitch fluctuations are of course found in all languages. In many languages, however, the student can get by with ignoring
t hem, using instead the p itch pa tterns of his own n a t ive langua g e . The r e s u l t may s ou nd s t r an g e , bu t i t wi l l st i l l be i nt el l i g i bl e .
In Kirundi however, as in most African languages, pitch h as functions which it does not have in English. T h u s ,
Pitch, then, may be the only audible difference between two words of entirely different meanings. T o say the same thing in technical terms, Kirundi has LEXICALLY SIGNIFICANT distinctions of p it c h . But even more important than the lexical function of Rundi pitch is its place in the grammatical system of the language. Compare the following six forms, all of which have first person plural subjects, and contain the same stem /-kubuura/ >to sweepa. The differences among them are of a grammatical nature:
twaakubuuye
>we swept [ t od a y ] ~ ( c a n n o t b e t he
l ast word in th e
s enten c e twaakubuuye
[~
tence ) twaakubuuye
t waak u b u u y e
UNIT 1
KIRUNDI
twaakubuuye twaakubuuye
[~
( cannot b e t h e l as t w o r d )
t uzookubuur a
] <we will sweep [not immediately]< ] <we going to sweep [ not immediatelyj~ ] <which we will sweep [not immediately]<
t uzookubuur a t uzookubuur a
/
[~~~ [- ~
The foregoing are examples of the GRAMMATICAL SIGNIFICANCE of p i t ch . Because of the important lexical and grammatical functions of pitch in Kirundi, the writer of a textbook in the language must record them in some way; whoever teaches Kirundi must be careful
t hat his students get 0he p i t ches right, as well as the v o w e l s
and consonants; and the student must make these matters the obj ect of much pa t i ent effor t .
There are reasons, however, why the direct graphic representation of pitch
([ ~
j, [ ~
] , etc.
visually cumbersome and typographically expensive. M ore important is the fact that such a system actually presents too many details.
It i.s suitable to the b e g inner because it does provide him wi th a n immediately usable picture of p i tch re lationships . It does
BASIC COURSE
U NIT l
description of the physical phenomena of pitch, and more especially for discussion of the contrasts among various pit;ch patterns. Each tone has one or more physical realizations in terms of p1tches. In Kirundi, as in many other Bant'u languages, the pitch
phenomena are best de scribed in t;erms of two ton es, called LOW
HIGH. Low tone is quite simple: its t'ypical realization is as a level, relatively low pitch:
guhaga guhaaga
As its name implies, high tone ordinarily involves the use of a relatively high pitch, but this pit;ch is not level. It; most commonly consists of a rise followed immediately by a f al l :
gufash a
[,
>
~ to h e l p ~
<mora<. A MORA is a
unit of vowel length. V owels in Kirundi may consist of eit;her one or two moras, and no more. A two-mora vowel is indicated in writing by doubling the vowel letter:
k ubaz a
kubaaza
[ [
13
] ]
UNIT l
KIRUNDI
The second concept having to do with the location of the peak of a high tone on the time axis is <pitch point;.< The high tone may be attached to a vowel ( whether l o n g o r
of two PITCH POINTS .
s h o r t ) a t e i t he r
somewhat as follows:
One-mora vowel
Two-mora vowel
I
I
(1) There is never more than one high tone per moray that is to say, it is impossible to have high tones on both the
BASIC COURSE
U NIT
first and the second pitch point of a short vowel at the same
time.
[-~
abaana
abaandi
but
n ot :
or:
15
UNIT l
KIRUNDI High tone may occur on both the pitch points of the same
long vowel. T his DOUBLE HIGH TONE is realized as high level with a shor t dr o p a t t h e v e ry end .
a baantu b o o s e
> all
people>
Instead, a high tone which occurs on the first pitch point of a vowel will be called an ANTICIPATED HIGH TONE. A h igh tone that occurs on the second pitch point, and which therefore does not spill over onto the preceding syllable, will be called an UNANTICIPATED HIGH TONE. On long vowels, anticipated and unanticipated high tones are w r i t t en /-aa-/ and /-aa/ respectively. On a short vowel, they are written /-a-/ and /-5-/. D o u ble high tone is written
/-aa-/.
2.
[
Ur U muruundi .
U muruun d i ?
]
]
Y ou ar e a N u r u n d i.
Are y o u a Nu r u n d i ?
[
Ur
in the yes-no question is much sharper than in the statement. The foregoing example has only one high pitch in each
s entence . T h e f o l l o w ing s en tences have more than on e :
[
Ur
Ur
~ ~
]
Y ou ar e
Are
U m u nyeekoongo .
a Congolese.
x w
]
y o u a Con g o l e s e ?
U m u ny eekoongo? i6
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 1
These two sentences illustrate the fact that; the exaggeration of pitch in yes-no questions applies to all the highs in the sent ence , n o t J u s t t o C h e l as t ; . Some sentences contain no highs at all. For example:
U munyar wa a n d a .
Y ou ar e
a M u n y a r w an da . a N u n y a r w anda ?
Umunyarwaanda?
A re yo u
In this pair of sentences, the yes-no question may differ from the statement in that it has a high pitch on the first syllable, or in ending on a lower pitch than the statement, or in both of t hese r e s p e c t s .
INTONATION. I t will not be written with any special symbols in 0he writing system used in this book. Its presence can be inferred whenever a question mark follows a sentence that does not contain some interrogative word such as /iki/ >what?> /ryaari/ >when'?>.
[For practice in employing the yes-no intonation side by
A n ote o n a n t i c i a ted hi
tone i n f i n a l
osit i o n .
[ - ~
Ni neeza.
]
It<s fine.
UNIT 1
KIRUNDI
[Ni neeza? Is it fine? I n bot h t he The second of these sentences is a yes-no question.
statement and the question, the pitch of /-za/ is low, even though it is written with high tone. T his same word does have
h ig h p i t ch wh e n i t i s not at t h e en d o f t h e se n t en c e :
~
N i n e ez a
-]
caane. It is very nice. sy l -
The r e l a t i o n s h i p b e t w e e n t h e p i t ch e s o f t he f i nal
lables of these two sentences is an example of' a general principle which may be stated as follows: W hen a short syllable which in the middle of a sentence has high tone occurs at the end of a sentence, then the pitch of that syllable itself is low. If its high tone is of the >anticipated< variety, however, the anticipatory rise in the preced1ng syllable is unaffected by the declarative intonation. 4.. A not e on t he us e o f sub ec t Compare these two forms: n kora . u kora . I w ork. r ef i x e s .
y ou (s g. )
work.
subJect and second person singular subJect is matched by the difference between /n-/ (1 sg.) and /u-/ (2 sg.) These two elements are called SUBJECT PREFIXES. E x cept for imperatives, infinitives, and a few less important forms, every R u n di verb c onta i n s a su b J e c t p r ef i x .
18
BASIC COURSE
UNIT 1
The prefixes which stand for personal subjects are given h ere f o r r ef er e n c e : S ingul a r F ir s t pe r s o n nu-
or m or w-
S econd p e r s o n Thir d p e r so n
m u- o r
a-
or y -
ba-
or b-
T he ch o i c e
depends on the sound that follows this prefix. Th e choice among the variant; forms of the other prefixes is governed by principles which will be discussed in Unit 2 , Not;e 4. [For pract;ice in contrasting the prefixes /n-/ and /u-/, see ~vocabulary Supplement;s 1 and 2. ]
5.
A n ote on the immediate tense. Unless t;hey are labelled ot;herwise, all verbs in the
first; few units of t;his course are in the same t;ense, which is called the IMMEDIATE TENSE. The immediate tense may be used when speaking about matters which are generally t;rue: N kora k u ki vuko. I work at; the port.
N dahageze v u b a .
19
UNIT 1
KIRUNDI
Since no other verb forms have been introduced which are in contrast with the immediate tense ( except f o r
/ntaar i / a nd
/bwaakubone /,
t hi s
6.
/jeewe/:
/
J eewe nkora muri <consulat americain < . < I work at the American Consulate . <
T he s e n t e n c e :
/
is also correct, complete, and approximately the same in meaning as the first sentence. The word /jeewe / is a first person singular pronoun,
but it is used much less frequently than its English counterpart
>I<.
f unction . m ore
p ro n o un s
a r e g i v en h er e f or S ing u l a r
r e f er en c e : P lu r a l tweebwe
F irs t
p e r s on
jeewe
wewe weewe
I
<we<
S econd p e r s o n T hir d p e r so n
mweebwe boobo
<he, sh e <
BASiC CO U R SE
UNIT j
7.
s ent ences:
N kora mu r u g a a n d a .
I w o r k i n a sh o p .
N kora mw i i s 5 k o .
I work at the market;. The locative prefix which appears in all of th ese sentences is
/,
i s us e d .
If a noun begins with /i/ followed by the stem ( i . e . 9 , 10 ), then the locative prefix usually has the form
/mu-/.
What; has been said about /mu-/, /muri-/ and /mw-/ also applies to another locative prefix which has t;he forms / ku-/ , / kuri-/ and /kw-/. B oth prefixes have to do with location. T h e p ref i x /mu-j is more specific, and is <requently translated <in,
T h e p r e f i x /ku-/ is much less definite, and may be used
w ithin. ~
21
UNIT 1
KIRUNDI
takes no prefixes of any kind. I t is thus, from the point of view of its form, a particle and not a verb. The pa r t i c l e / ni/ has ant;icipated high tone on its
s ent e n c e a n d d o es n o t
will be termed PROVISIONAL HIGH TONE, symbolized by wr iting an acute accent before the syllable which has this characterist;ic. No exercises are given for pr a cticing the provisional high
t one ,
a nd h i g h
lus
Are
m ost c ommon f o r m i s /- r i /
<be ~ .
W h e n t ; h i s m o r p h eme ( or a n y
other
/,
a n d n o t ; +/nr/ .
The
combination + /nr/ does not occur at; all in Kirundi. [For practice in this alternation between /r/ and /d/, see Vocabulary Supplement 1.]
22
BASIC C O U R S E
UNIT 1
r o c e d u r e f o r u s e w i t h s ub stitution drills.
1.
L <i ns t r u c t e u r d i t chaq u e
1.
T h e t u t or sa y s e a c h s e n -
tence. The students repeat it after him until they are able
t o do so easily and corr e ctly .
2.
T h e s t u d e nts go th rough th e
I l f au t s ~as -
s ame sent e n ce s
again .
Be s ur e
q ue c h a c u n c o m p r e n d l a
3. The tutor says the first sentence, and the word from the column of <cue words<, opposite the second senten ce . of the students should reply On e
w ith the second sentence. T h e tutor then gives the cue word 23
UNIT 1
KIRUNDI
alor s
l e ~mot-clef~ de la
er c i c e .
I n s t r u c t eu r : C las s e : I nstructeur : E tu d i a n t A:
Ur . i Ur
U m u n y a a me e r i k a ? U m u r u u n d i?
/
U muruun d i .
Um u n y a r w a an d a .
Ur. Umunyarwaanda?
i Um u b o . Ur.
1
I nstructeur : E tu d i a n t B:
Umubo?
Instructeur: U m u m6so.
/
E tu d i a n t
C:
Ur . Umumi5s o?
i
I n s t r u c t eu r :
/
Umunyamugaamba. Ur U m u nyamugaamba?
/ /
E tu d i a n t etc.
D>
c olumn o f
>cues>.
B ASIC CO U R SE
UNIT
student, may make use of an opaque card with a notch cut out o f one corner:
/
un des coins a
U munyaameeri k a
U muruund i
U r. Umunyaameeri k a ?
t o pr o duce
th e s e nt ence whi ch
c ard .
W h e nh e h a s d o n e s o , t o d o s o , h e t hen
or a t t e m p t e d
U munyaameeri k a
Umur uund i
U r. Umunyaameeri k a ?
1
U r.
Umuruund i ?
Umunyarwaanda
25
UNIT 1
KIRUNDI H aving d o n e s o , h e r e ce i v e s immediate confirmation or correction of his own r e sp onse an d is simultaneously pr esented with the next; cue.
mediate { ou l a
de sa
c o r r e c t i o n)
pr o pr e r e p onse e t l e
m ot-clef suivant .
that; the notch is on the right hand side, the second column of s entences may b e s econd se t used as a
des p h ra s e s d e l a
o f cu es .
Comment ut;iliser les exercices de transformation. C e group e d > e x e r c i c e s s e c ompose de trois colonnes. L a colonne 1 comprend les motsq3.efs, l a co l onn e 2 co n t ' i e n t ; d e p h r a s es, e t l a
r o c e d u r e f o r us e w i t h t;ransformation drills.
The second group of material for systematic practice cons ists of three columns. C o l u mn 1 c o n s i s t s of cu e s , C o l u m n
une s e r i e
2 contains one series of sentences, and Column 3 contains a different series of sent;ences.
(voir les directives donnees plus haut pour les exercices de subst;itution ). Ensuit e l es
).
1 and 3 s houl d b e
UNIT 1
3.
I n t h i s wa y , s en t e n c e s
c olonne 2 ,
et un au t r e r ep o n d
f r o m t h e s u b s t i t u t i on d r i l l s
p ar u n e p h r a s e d e l a c ol on n e 3 . De cette fanon, les phrases des exercices de substitution sont combinees en une serie de petites conversations de deux lignes. Vocabular s u
r
l e m ent 1
Names for members of various ethnic rou s. > Are you a n Ameri c a n ? ~
r
U munyaameeri k a > American ' Ur
U m unyaameeri k a ?
AUmuruundi
< Murund i > Ur U m u r u u n d i?
f=
Umunyarwaanda ~Munyarwanda~ Ur
j
U m uny ar waanda?
I:Umubo
Ur
j j
Umubo?
Umum5s o
Ur U mum5s o?
27
UNIT l
KIRUNDI
[
Umunyamugaamba Ur
U m unyamugaamba?
w +
Umutuutsi >Mutut s i
Ur >
U m u t u u ts i ?
]
Umuhutu > Muhutu > Ur U m u h u t u?
]
Umutwa
i Mutwa > Ur Umutwa?
Umuzuungu >European>
Ur U m uzuungu ?
]
Umubirigi < Belgi a n ~ Ur Umubirigi?
Ameri c a n ? >
<I<m a n
A m e r i ca n . >
[
Ur
[
Nd
~
U m u n y a a me e r ik a .
U munyaameeri k a ~ American ~
/
U m unyaameeri k a ?
[
Ur i U muruun d i ? Nd
~
Umuruundi .
U muruun d i ~ Murund i ~
[U munyar w a a n d a Ur
[
Nd Umunyarwaanda.
U munyarwaanda?
~Munyarwanda'
]
Umubo U r . Umub o ? i U r. i
/
Nd
Umubo.
Pers on s f r om v ar i o u s p a r t s of Bur un d i .
Umumoso
U mum5so ?
Nd
U m u mo s o .
Umunyamugaamba
Ur . i
U m u n y a mugaamba?
28
BASIC COURSE
UNITl
Ur
U m u t;uut;si ?
Nd. Umutuu t s i
1
7
Umuhutu > Muhutu > Ur U m u h u t u? Nd U m u h u t u.
Umut;wa ~Mutwa~
Ur
U m u t ; wa ?
Nd
Umutwa.
Umuzuungu >European<
Ur
U m u zuungu ?
[
Nd U muzuungu.
Ur Umubirigi'?
Nd Umubirigi.
Ur Umunyaafirika?
Nd Umunyaafirika.
7
Umuhi.indi Ox'. U muhiin d i
I Indi a n >
7
Nd
Ur Umuhlindi?
Umuhlindf.
[
Umwaarabu <Arab< Ur U mwaarabu '? N d Umwaarabu .
7
Umunyeekoongo ~ Congoles e ~ Ur U m u ny eekoongo? Ndi Umunyeekoongo .
r ecor d i n g
o f t h e w o r d /Umuhut'u /.
UNIT 1
P laces where e o le work, T h e locative r e fixes >I work at the American con s u l a t e . <
]
<consulat americain~ N k ora murf >consulat U kora mur 5 >consul at
a meric a i n > .
a meric a i n ~ ?
] ] ]
[- - [-
Nkora mw iivuuriro.
Ukora m w iivuuriro?
i s5ko (9, 6 )
<market >
N kora mw i i s 5 k o .
Ukora mw iislko?
]
muhXra >home> N kora mu u h X r a .
U kora mu u h X r a '?
i bi r o
(9, 8)
Nkora mu b i r o .
Ukora mu
bi r o?
u rugaanda ( 11 , 9 )
~ fact o r y , shop>
N kora mu r u g a a n d a .
U kora mu r u g a a n d a ?
work-
[
iki vuko <port >
]
Ukor a k u k i v uk o ?
(7, 8)
Nkora
ku k i v uk o .
N kora mu g i s a g a r a .
[
U kora mu g i s a g a r a ?
[ NB G r a p h i c C one in d i cations are not wr i tten over bo rrowed wor d s t hat are shown in th eir or iginal spellings between quo ta tion ma r k s . T his does not mean that th ese words are exempt from the K i r u n d i t onal system, howev er . ]
30
BASIC COURSE
UNIT 1
Vocabular s u
l e m ent 3.
>this
i s my
t hi n g >
ig i t u u n g wa
]
]
i gi t a b o icaambarwa
] ] ] ]
caange.
urubaangaangwe Nirwo r u b a a n gaangwe
J J
[ -~ ~ ~
~ bicy c l e >
rwaange. o r: i k i f n g a
i pi k i p i k i Th
~ motorbi k e ~
i bi i nt u
N ivyo b i t u u n gwa v y a a n g e . N ivyo b i t a b o v y a a n J e . N ivyo v y a ambarwa v y a a n g e . N izo mbaangaangwe zaange . Niyo makifnga yaange. Niyo mapikipiki yaanJe.
N.B. The differences between /ikiintu/and/kiintu/ on t h e o n e h a n d , and/nico/and/nirwo/on the other, should not concern the student at
t hi s t i me .
The wor d
BASIC CO U R SE
UNIT
UNIT 2
D ialo ue l ,
[1 sg. subject prefix]
[ tdi s j unc t < pr ef i x ]
- gir a
( - gi z e )
t;o d o
[
1A
Nd a g i z e bwa a k e e y e .
( 'I h av e
[
2B
~ ]
Bw a a k e ey e n e e z a .
]
( Reply t o
1. )
3B
N . am a k i?
H ow are y o u ?
[
4A
I <m f i n e .
to go
t o cause t o go t o be c au s e d t o go
[
5B
- roonder a akazi
~
U g e e nzwa n a l k i ?
] )
(-r o o n d ey e
( 12, 1 3 )
- - - ]
6A Nd o o n d e r
zj
ak az i .
7B
U zi g u k o r
aka z i n y a b a ki ?
Wha t k i n d o f w or k do you k n ow
[ how] t o
d o?
33
UNIT 2
KIRUNDI
-andika
( -andi t s e
)
10)
t o wr i t e to cause to write
m achi n e
( 9, 6 o r
8A
Ndaa zi k w a a n d i k iish
[-
]
9B Ni v y i i za . That's finef
t o be i n n e ed o f
-kenera (-keneye)
umukaraani [ 1 0B
(1, 2)
I
c le r i c a l
worker
n e e d a cl e r k .
(-shobotse
t o be
to
able
(-taanguye)
begi n
now
[
1 1A Nsh o b o r a gu t a a n g u r
u bu ?
Can I
b e g i n n ow ?
oya
- zo o -
- garuk a
( -garut s e )
t o r et u r n y es t e r d a y , t o mo r r ow
e go ( o r : e g o )
BASIC COURSE
UNIT2
[
1 2B Oy a ge e n d uz oo g a r u k a a ejo .
N o, go [ a nd ]
( y o u w i l l ) come
b ack t o mo r r o w .
]
Good bye !
1 3A
Nd i i k eb a a n u y e .
Dial o
u e 2.
[ -- 1 4C
-mu-
- -> r
Ur ak e n e y um u k a r a a n i ' ? e
Do you n e e d
a c l er k ?
[~~
15D
- - - - - ]
Y es, I n e e d o n e . ( >Yes, I him.>
) domestic servant
need
16C
Ur ak e n e y -ba-
abas h u umba?
[
1 7D Eeg o n d a b a k e n e y e .
]
Y es, I ne e d s o m e . ( <Yes, I nee d
them.>)
Dial o ue 3.
[-W
18E Ur aaz i k w a a n d i ki ish i mas h i i n i ?
Do yo u
know how t o t yp e ?
35
UNIT 2
KIRUNDI
L
lgF
- ~
- j
Y es, I k no w (it) very well.
Ee g o ndabiizi neeza.
20E
- ]
U zoo t a angur a F in e J W i l l you begin tomorrow?
N i v y i iza .
ego?
uwaamber e Monday
]
2 1F O y a nz o o t a a n g u r a
N o, I < 1 1 b eg i n on Mo n d a y .
k u w a a mbe r e .
N B T h e w o r d /ego/ in Lines 12 and 20, like other words that end with anticipated high tone, sometimes is pronounced with high tone on the next to last syllable (i.e. /5go/or /ego/) when it s tands a t t he e n d o f a s en t e n c e .
l. A
umushuumba
abashuumba
s ervant s
The difference in meaning between singular and plural is m atch e d by the contrast between /umu-/ and /aba-/. The stem is /-shuumba/. M ost, though by no m e ans al l , b egi n nouns that refer to p e r s ons t o be
members of CLASS 1 .
with
t he n o t a t i o n <
umushuumba
( 1, 2 )
BASIC COURSE
UNIT
means t;ha t
2. A
n o t e o n o b ec t
re f i x e s .
C ompare t h e
words:
I I I need. . . n e e d h i m. n e e d t h em .
T he f o r m s /-mu-/ in the second sentence and /-ba-/ in the third are OBJECT PREFIXES. An object prefix in Kirundi is in many ways like an object pronoun in English, except that, the Kirundi object
prefix is included wit;hin the verb itself . I t s t a n d s i m m e d i a tely
befor e
s tands .
Thus , /-mu-/ is used where the object is third person >her>. The corresponding plural prefix is / -ba-/ . For reference purposes, the personal object prefixes
a re
F ir st '
p e r so n
-n- o r - m - <me>
-ku-muor or -gu-
<us<
S econd p e r s o n Thir d p e r s on
>you (p l . )
>them>
>
~ you (sg . ) ~
- mw- >h i m ,
x xi i
37
person plural are governed by the same principles as those set f or t h ( Unit 2 , Not e 4
) for the infinitive prefix .
3.
>bank<
( French o r E ngli s h )
Yohaani imashiini
/ /
]
]
]
~John~ <machine>
(German)
( French o r E ngli s h )
[ ~ ~
u mushofeer i umukaraani
/
(French)
(Swahili, from A rabi c ) ( Engl i s h t hr o ugh F r e n c h ?)
>~
] ]
umubooyi
>houseboy<
The
t;h e s e n ou n s
( 1)
/ f ee/ i n / u m ushofeer i / ) .
(2) If there is, wit h i n t h e s t ; e m , a sy l l a b l e wh i ch
precedes the penultimate syllable, it has an anticipated high
38
B ASIC CO U R SE
UNIT p
except;ions. Thus, t;he word motorcar has come into Kirundi as /umuduga/, and not as +/umuduuga /. (Another version of this same ' Roan word i s / i modokaar i /.)
4. A n o t e o n i n f i n i tive s.
I:
k ur i m a
<to cultivate<
[
gusoma
< to r e a d <
guteeka
> to c o o k >
f .- ~
g utaangur a
]
< to be g i n >
gusoma
g us o m a gu s o m a
-shaaka g u s oma
etc.
< want t o
r ea d >
39
UNIT 2
KIHUNDI
Second, the infinitives of the various Kirundi verbs may be divided into two groups. I n one group the infinitives have no high tones, while in the other each infinitive has one high tone.
T his same difference is found in c er tain other forms of th e s e s ame two groups of v e r bs . O n c e t h e s t u d ent has learned to u s e
t he infinitive form of a v erb w ith its pr oper tone, he will ha v e l ess trouble in r emembering which tonal pa t tern to use in t h e o ther forms of 0he same ve r b . When the infinitiv e r e f i x ha s th e for m u
has t h e c , k, of the
t,
f , s , sh , h , pf , t s /. l an g u a g e .
a prefix before voiceless and voiced consonants, r espec t i v e l y , i n t h e f ol l ow i n g s yl l ab l e, i s som e t i m e s c a l l e d < D a h l < s L a w . >
W hen the infinitiv e r e f i x ha s th e for m kw -
T he roots of most verbs begin with consonan ts : - mesuu r s om-teek< laun d e r >
>read>
>cook>
40
BASIC CO U R SE
U NIT 2
When the infinit- ve prefix stands before a root ( or a s ee s y n o p si s p . x x i i ) that begins with a vowel, it has
pref i x ,
kwaandik a
kwuubak a
5. A
-zi
C ompare t h e s e p h r a s e s :
Uzi g u k o r a ak a zi
/
n y ab a k i ?
y ou k no w [ h o w j t o
do?
I k n o w [ howj t o type .
T he r o o t
/ z i / , w hich o c c u r s i n t; h e v e r b s o f bot ; h t h e s e s e n t e n c e s ,
-mesuur-
F urthermore, the final consonant of one of th ese roots is a lw ay s f ollowed by some vowel or o th er . I n b o t h t h es e r e sp ects ,
/ - zi /
is atypical.
T his root; is also unusual in that the vowel wh ich im mediately precedes it is always long, unless t;hat vowel is th e f irst sound in the wo r d : ndagez e ndaazi I I h a v e a r r i v ed . know.
UNIT 2
KIRUNDI
The root / - zi /
that' many kinds of forms which are found wit;h almost all other v erbs a r e l a ck i n g f or /-zi/. The infinitive itself is an example: Ndamesuura.
k umesuur a b ut : N daaz i . I to know. know I l aunder.
t ;o l a u n d e r
(kumenya)
g u kor
d o?
I k n o w ho w t o t y p e .
I n the
a n d t ;he s t e m. This
extr a
prefix has the form /da/ aft;er /n/, but its most unusual form is /ra/. (cf. Unit 1, Note 7, for the change of
This prefix has no clearly definable dictionary meaning. Its function in the verb is grammat;ical; the difference between verb forms wit'h and without it is t;otally alien t;o Indo-European languages, and even to many Bantu languages. F orms which contain this /ra/
prefix are called DISJUNCT; the forms which are like di sgunct
BASIC COURSE
UNIT 2
tive word or enclitic. (3) The combination of conjunct verb plus an object (or other complement ) is likely to express a natural or routine relationship, while the semantic relationship between a disjunct verb and its object (or other complement; ) is likely to be more c asual . Examples of conjunct verbs are found in Unit, 1, Sentences
(p.23 )
for learning the new words. Use Columns 2 and 3 as a transformation drill (p.26 ) for practice in swit;ching between 1 sg.
and 2 sg, subj ect prefixes, and bet;ween declarative and y e s -no intonations .
[ ~
- andi k i i
<to
]
a
Uraazi kwaandikiish
sh a ( -and i k i i
cause t;o w ri t e I
43
UNIT 2
KIRUNDI
[ ~
-mesuura
<to
- -
]
U raazi
]
k u m esuu r a ?
(-mesuuye }
N daazi k u mesuur a .
l au n d e r >
- andi k a
>to w r i
( -and i t s e
t e<
)
f
-]
Ndaazi k w a a n d ik a .
[ -<
Uraaz i
-]
]
k wa a n d i k a ?
N daazi
gus oma.
U raaz i
gus oma?
f~
Ndaaz i k u r i ma .
[~~
Uraaz i k u r i ma ?
- rima
]
-rimiisha (-rimiishige) >to cause to cultivate' isuka (9,6) shoe~ Ndaazi kurimiish a
[ w
Uraazi kurimiish
]
a
[- ~
i suka .
f->
i suk a ?
>I know how t o c u l tivate with a hoe. < ( >. . . c a u s e a hoe to cultivate~ ) -geendesha (-geendeshej e ' t o cause t o g o >
f~
N daazi k u g e e n dees h a
] f- ~
Ur aazi k uge e n d e e s h a
u muduga (3, 4 )
< automobile <
]
umuduga.
-~
umuduga?
]
- gor o r a
<to
]
U raazi kugoror a
(-goroye)
Ndaazi
k ugo r o r
i r on <
impuuzu
(9,10)
~
i mpuu z u .
I
i mpuu z u ?
]
-ubaka
>to
( -uba t s e )
N daazi
kwuubaka.
U raaz i
kwuubaka?
bui l d <
44
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 2
-teeka ( -t e e t s e
o cook <
[~
N daazi g u t e e k a .
[ x
U raazi
gut eeka?
E xercice 2 .
O n p e u t f a ir e c e t
Exer c i s e
2.
Th i s ex er ci s e may
exercice de plusieurs f
/
alcons:
c haque s e c t i o n
/
d e 1 < exerci c e .
/
nes 2 et 3, lignes 1 et 4 de
c haqu e s e c t i on d e 1 <ex e r ci c e .
/
s ect i o n .
/ J
Pour etudier les prefixes sujets utiliser les colonnes 1 et 2 de 1 >exercice entier . Pour
/
e t u d i er
/
1 <a c c o r d d e s
prefixes complements avec les mots contenus dans les phra ses precedentes, utiliser 1 <exercice
UNIT 2
KIHUNDI
S ecti o n
A.
/umukaraani / ( 1 ,
~Do you n ee d
2)
<cl er i cal
a c l er k ? <
/
umukaraani
u mukaraani ? ne e d a c l er k ?<
/
( pl . )
(mweebwe)
abakaraani
M urakeney U rakeney e
aba k a r a a n i ?
(wewe)
aba k a r a a n i ?
S ecti o n
/
B.
/
/umushofeeri / Urakeney
e
u m u s h o f e e r i?
T urabakeneye . Ndabakeneye.
(wewe)
S ecti o n
C.
/umushuumba /
U rak e ne y e e
(1 , 2 ) < s ervant<.
u mu s h u u m b a ? u mu s h u u m b a ? N damukene y e .
umushuumba
(mweebwe ) abashuumba
M urak e ne y
Turamukeneye. Turabakeneye
N dabak e n e y e .
Murakeney Urakeney
e
(wewe)
B ASIC CO U R SE
U NIT 2
S ecti o n umurezi
D.
/umurezi w a
w a a b a ana
U rakeney
u m u r e z i w a a b a a na ?
/
N d a mukeneye .
(mweebe)
a bar e z i wa a b a a n a
/
a b a r e zi
b a a b a an a ?
Tu r ab ak e n e y e .
(wewe)
U rakeney
aba r e z i b a a b a a n a ? Nd a b a k e n e y e .
S ecti o n
E.
/umuvoomyi /
U rakeney
(1 , 2)
e
umuvoomyi
u m u v oomyi ?
(mweebwe)
abavoomyi
(wewe)
S ecti o n F . u muteet s i
/umuteetsi /
(1, 2 )
(mweebwe)
a bate e t s i
(wewe)
a b a t ; e e t si ?
S ect;ion umubooyi
G.
/umubooyi / or : / u m ubooyi / ( 1 , 2 )
U rakeney e u m ubooyi ? e e e u m ubooyi ?
ababoo yi ?
>houseboy>
N damukene y e ,
(mweebwe)
a babooy i
M urakeney
Murak e ne y
(wewe)
U rakeney
aba b o o y i ?
UNIT 2
KIRUNDI
3.
Day s of
U zooga r u k a
k u wa a m b e r e ?
>Tuesday<
>Will you return on Tu esday< ? <I will return on W ednesd a y . ~ Uzooga r u k a k u wak a b i r i ? Nzooga r u k a k u wa g a t a t u .
(second)
/
u waga t a t u
( four t h
r
( fi f t h
U zoogaruka k u
wagataanu?
N zoogaruk a k u ndatu .
wagataa
Sunday. >
N zoogar u k a k u wa m u u n g u .
r
<Sunday>
Monday. <
U zooga r u k a k u w a muungu?
( r God>st)
N zoogaruk a k u w a amber e .
N.B.
The sy l l abl e / ku /
r e p r e s e n t s t h e g e n e r a l l ocat i v e ; t he
> 2-6>,
for
>G o d < , a nd f o r
>fi r s t
< (mbere
).
48
BASIC CO U R SE
UNIT 2
L es ex e r c i s e s
q ui su i v e nt
de c onversat io n
l e s ex er ci s e s s y s -
t ematiques ont pour bu t d>offrir une pr a tique guidee de conversation, sous forme
d e cou r t s
di al og u e s b a s e s s u r
/ w /
/
co n t i e n t
1.
L <el ev e c ou v r e l a p a g e d e
1.
d onne une expression kirundi qui a Kirundi expression which carr i e s e xpr i m e en s t y l e di r ec t
/
l es
UNIT 2
KIRUNDI
repond alors avec la ligne suivante de la troisieme colonne de la conversation. L >etudiant ecoute et comprend la phrase
e t repond suivant les di r e c-
E nglish instruction .
2 . R e commencer e n de la
/
p r o c edant,
2.
T h e a b ov e p r o c e dur e s h o u l d
m eme f an on j u s q u > a c e pu i ss e p r e n dr e l e
be repeated until the student can take the first side of the dialogue without hesitation and without mistakes.
que 1 > e l e v e
/
3. L >instructeur doit ensuite prendre le premier role et 1<eleve doit prendre le role tenu auparavant par 1>instruct eur ,
3. Then the tutor should take the first role, and the student should take the role f'ormerly gi v e n to the tutor.
4.
4.
B oth ro l e s i n th e d i a l ogue
p ar d e s
cl eves.
a re t a k e n b y s t u d e n t s .
Practice Conversation l. Y ou as k a n o t h e r p e r s o n
what k i n d of ' wo r k h e
U kor
ak a z i ny a b a k i ?
Nd
umukaraani.
d oes. Yo u a s k w h e t h e r h e knows ho w t o t y pe .
Uraazi kwaandikiish
imashiini?
a
/
Eego,
ndabi i zi .
50
BASIC COURSE
UNIT 2
51
UNIT 3
KIRUNDI
t her e i s , t h e r e ar e
umuuntu ke
(1, 2)
person few
[
1A Mb o n a h i B u j uumbura a a
1
h ar aba a n t u b a k e . n ow, t h e n other where? (enclitic ) ( expl e t i v e ) noone
ndi
V' --he
[
2A No o n e a b a a n di B ar u u n d i
Now wher e
d o t h e o t h er
Ru n d i
p eopl e w o r k ?
1
bakorKhe?
iinshi
many, much
- kor e r a
(-koreye)
t o work for, at , e t c .
farm
thei r
nabo 52
a nd t h e y
( Cl.
2)
BASIC CO U R SE
UNIT 3
[ -~
3B
-]
Many work on th eir farms,' and o thers work in o ther tow n s .
Ab e e n s h i
b a k or er
i ngo
z aabo ~ a b a a n d i
nabo
]
bagakora mu biindi
]
b isaga r a .
Lki
/
what?
]
4A Muu n g w i w a a b o b ako r
0
ik i ?
W hat ; do they do on th e ir
farms?
) )
na
nka
/
l ike,
as
[
5B B a r a r i ma , a b a a n d i
"]
b akabaaza, bagacura,
-
They farm, [and] some work in wood or metal, and so forth ( >and o t h e r [ t hi ng s ] l i k e
those. <
[
n
~
a
iiv y o .
ibii n d i n k
53
UNIT 3
KIRUNDI
Dial o
ue 2. aawe
y our ( s g . )
[
6C
>
]
D oes you r c l er k kn ow [ h ow]
to ty p e '?
Um u k a r a an i w a a w ar aa z i e
k waandikiish i m a shiinl?
7D
~
0
~
neez a .
]
Y es, h e k n o w s ( it )
Eeg
ar abi i zi -turuka
well .
( turuts e )
t o c ome f r o m
[
8C
]
Where does he come from?
At ur uk K h e ' ?
[ 9D At ur uk a
]
i Ngooz i . He comes from Ngozi.
l.
A n ote on the alternation of nasal consonants. Compare Sentence 1, Unit 3 with Sentence 6, Unit 2, and
Sentences g
The sound
( / b/ )
with the tip of th e tongue in con tact with the upper t e eth or
gum ridge. The same is true of the consonant sound (/d/) which
BASIC COURSE
UNIT 3
follows it'. The nasal phoneme which begins the word /nkora/ is also
(/k/) ,
w hich follows it ,
T h i s t h ir d n a s a l
s ound i s
vowels. W hen it does stand before a vowel, it is pronounced with the middle of t;he tongue against the hard palate. It; is thus similar to Spanish n and French ~n. This same alternation of /m/ before /b, p, f/, /n/ before
/t, d, s, z/ and /ny/ before /c, g, sh, k, g/ will be found elsewhere in the language. C onsonant sequences like + /mt, nb, mk/ do not occur in Kirundi.
2.
A n ote on substantive h r a ses. The following subst;antive phrases have occurred in the
units and sentences indicated by the numbers in parentheses: izina r y a ange my name American
U munyaameeri k a
[person]
ibaanki ya Rwaanda Uruundi b ank of' RuandaUrund i gituma
( l.
5)
[people]
abeenshi
many [people]
55
UNIT 3
KIRUNDI
i ngo
zaabo
their farms
abaandi
i bi i ndi
o t'hers [ p e opl e ]
o t;hers [ t hi ng s ]
/
(3 3) (3 5) (3. 6)
u mukaraani
w a a we
y our c l e r i c al employee
example ( / g i t u m a/ )
( 2)
f r om U n i t ' 1 , S e n t ; ence 8 .
I n t hos e s u b s t a n t i v e e x p r e s s i o n s w h i c h c o n t a i n t wo
or more words, the second word does not begin wit;h a vowel.
Thus , t h e wo r d f o r
o r / B a r u u n d i /. I t has one of these forms in some positions in the sentence, and the other in other positions. I t has t' he form /Baruun di / if it is not; the first; word in the substantive expression. It may also have this form, even as first; word in the subs t;antive expression, if the wh ole phrase occurs in cer tain gram -
( U n i t 1 , Sen t e n c e 8 )
s eems t o
p r e c ede t h e wor d .
the NOUN PREFIX, and the /a/ which precedes it will be cal l e d
A UGMENT .
t he
[For pract;ice on t;his point, see Exercise 1.] )At this point;,
the student should refer to t;he definition of <concord < and
<class> on p
BASIC COURSE
UNIT 3
The first crit;erion for classification of substantives has to do with the freedom with which their stems combine with class p ref i x e s .
Cl . 1 2 mwi i za beez a m wii z a l goodl l good l l goo d l 1 good l l goodl lgoodl l good l l goo d l l good l l goo d l iki i n t; u l t;hing l i g i t uma l reason l l reaso ns l umuunt u a baant u l pers on l l peo p l e l
m yii z a
5
6 7 8 9
r yi i z a meeza
c ii z a
v yi i za n zi i z a
i bi i n t u
l t;hings l i b i t u m a
1 0 n z i i za
etc .
A ste m l i k e /"iza/, which combines indifferently with prefixes of all classes, is an ADJECTIVE STEM. A substantive stem like /-ntu/ or like /-tuma/, which is restrict;ed in its combination with class prefixes, is a NOUN STEM. Noun st;ems may be divided into two categories according to whether t;hey take an initial vowel (/abaantu/, /ingo/,
/m/.
Adjectives encount;ered so far which usually follow the
n oun ar e :
UNIT 3
KIRUNDI
Strong adjectives
i n Cl .
ke
1 , 3, 4, 6 )
iza
{/m/
>good<
/
/-a/
C l. 1
e .g. /
waabo baabo waabo yaabo ryaabo yaabo caabo vyaabo yaabo zaabo rwaabo kaabo t;waabo
bwaabo
/
a a bo/
<few<
/(m)u-/
mwiiza
bake
beeza
m uke ( r a r e mike
m wii z a m yi i z a
r ik e
make
(rare)
r yi i z a meeza
/
6 /(m)a-/
7 /ki - / 8 /bi - /
g ike ( r a r e
bike
c ii z a v yi i z a
n z i i za n zi i za
J
9 /i- /
1 O /zi - / 11 /ru-/ 1 2 /ka - /
n ke (r a r e )
nke
rwa '
ka twa
bwa
r uke ( r a r e ) g ake (r a r e )
duke buke
r wi i z a keeza t wi i z a
b wi i z a
/
13 /tu- /
14 /bu-/ 1 5 /ku - / 1 6 /ha- /
kwa
ha
kwaabo
haabo
guke { r a r e ) hake
kwi i za heeza
[For practice with the concordial prefixes used with these adject;ives, see Exercises 1, 2, 3, 4.]
58
BASIC COURSE
UNIT 3
~ this ,
t he s e <
t th at ,
t hos e <
uwy'uyo
abo uwo
3
4
iyi
iyo
iro
5 6
ay aand i i ki i n d i
aya
iki
ibi
8 9
10
ibii n d i i yi i n d i
i zii n d i
iyi
11 12
13
ur uu n d i ak aa n d i
ut uundi
Uru
14 15 16
ubuu n d i uk uu n d i ah aa n d i .
aha
t For practice with the concordial prefixes used with these adjectives, see Exercise 5.]
59
UNIT 3
KIRUNDI
3. A note on the alternate forms of concordial r e fixes with various ad ective stems. Compare the Class 2 forms of these three adjectives:
bake b eensh i
/
few
many good
beeza
/ ba - / ,
w h ic h
i s t h e f o r m t h a t oc c u r s w i t h t h e adj ec t i v e / ke/ and with all adjectives whose stems begin with a consonant. The most typical form of the stems for <many> a nd >good < are r e s p e c t i v e l y / On the
i i n s hi /
a n d / i i za/ . or
make
meenshi meeza
( /ma-/ pl u s / - k e / )
(/ma-/ plus /-iinshi/)
The preceding part of this note applies to the ex p e c ted v owel s eq u e n c e +/-ai-/. The remainder applies to the expected
s equence o f
C ompare the Class 4 forms of the same th ree ad j e ctives : mike myiinshi m yi i z a
/
6o
BASIC C O U R SE
UNiT 3
which i s
/my-/.
c ount e r p a r t
of
/i/ .
/mwiiza/ / u/ . Th e
which is the non-syllabic counterpart of
c onta i n s
/w/,
basic form of the Class 1 or Class 3 prefix is of course /mu-/. In general, then, the expected sequence of / i /
or / u/
plus another vowel is actually pronounced as /y/ or /w/ plus that same vowel. I n such cases, the vowel itself is almost always long :
/ umu-/ Cl .
With the prefixes for Classes f and 8, the substitution of /y/ for /i/ would result in sequences which do not occur in
Kiru n d i :
In place of an expected + / ky -/ ,
c ii z a
K i r u ndi u ses / c - / :
<good<
( Cl. 7 )
( Cl. 8 )
[ For practice in th ese prefix alternations, use as cue and r e sponse any two p a rts of Ex er cise 3 or of E x e r c ise 4..j
UNIT 3
KIRUNDI
4. A note on the locative enclitic - - h e Compare the tones of /-turuka/ in: a turu k a i Rwa a n d a he comes f r o m Ruanda
where d o e s h e co m e f r om?
atur u k Khe
The pa r t i
Such a particle is an ENCLITIC. W hen an enclitic is c ited by it s elf, it will be wr i tten after double hyphens, as in th e a b o v e
example. Tonally, this particular enclitic is generally preceded by an >unanticipated> (see Unit l, Note 1 ) h i g h t o n e .
5.
r elim i n a r
not e o n t he s u b s e c utive r e f i x .
Compare Sen t e n ce s . . . b a ko r a i ki ?
. . . a b a and i
nabo b a g a k o r a
and ot h e r s w o r k i n o ther t o w n s
the alternate form /-ga-/ before stems that begin wi.th an unvoi ce d c o n s o n an t (cf. Unit 2 , Note 4
).
]
[The contrast between subsecutive and no n -subsecutive form s w ill not be m ade th e su b j ect of drill at this ti m e .
62
BASIC COURSE
UNIT 3
Vocabulary i
Aturuka
A turuk a A tu r u k a A tur u k a A tu r u k a A tu r u k a A tu r u k a A tu r u k a
i Gi t e g a .
i Mura a m v y a . i Muyiinga . i Bur u r i . i K i r u u nd o .
i B u b aanza.
Mbo.
[ [ [ [ [ -
] ] ] ]
i Ma t a n a . i Ki ga l i . i S h aangugu. i Vy uum b a .
i Bukavu .
i K o ongo ,
i Buruundi .
]
[ ~ ]
A turuk a A turuk a
A tur u k a Atu r u k a
i Rwaanda. i B u gaanae .
As t r i d a .
Por the meanings of th ese terms, see the map on p. 6Q N.B. T h e w o r d As t r i da d o es not t ake the l oc ative i.
It i s
63
KlRUNDI
oo 4I
t'c'j., j,".'A
' -: t: -
g 'tt I vHCNVI
K
l
IAC
4
xj
~l
r~
., t.
K
t
VU
lAC ~ ItIOHASI
IAC IHESIA
)
K
KIGAU
outee
* 'tt
c
Qltarsma
LAC
HVOESER~A
IAC NASHO
C WERV RWEHIEAHA
t' tt
Kibungu
/''
: ;t t ,
A
saba
LAC
sa
i.AC SAKE
sns
Astride
ISKOHIIKA
. Ot- ' * : - ~
/
' OWo ~< '
t: '
P4. / V. +shing w~ Jg
B ubo no s g
)'( 8?
J
~R,
Mura myys ~
uo "on
U
~duo
l
D
C-
SUM BURk
'I
'V
t
l
'
/ g ..
'M /
Rucana
RWANDA
A'ND
" A 'c
B URUND I
.
'g t of IItc NI
Source
Iabmoamui bmaaaro
Tonllscy aosadaIT Kaaoaol cayitai T eu ton' caalhl Kaaraad Oriscisac maa Seoosaory Iooa tialor ohport
lii
+
0
P ~A':" O A@X
tt '
. ll
BASIC COURSE
UNIT 3
Exercise 1. L ike many of the exercises in this book, this is a composite of two simpler exercises. The two simpler exercises should be mastered before the student attempts to combine them. A. P ossessive concords with the stem / aabo/ >their<.
Use C o l u mn s 1 a nd 2 o n l y .
2 , a nd 3 . thei r e e e
e
car . >
a n o t h e r c ar . >
e e
N dakeney N dakeney
N dakeney
u m u d uga waabo . i mi d u g a y a a b o .
i k i i ntu caabo.
u w u undi mu duga.
e e
isuka
/
i su k a y a a b o . a m a s uk a y a a b o .
r
N dakeney
Ndakene y
e
e
ay a a n d i m a s u k a .
i y i i ndi mpuuzu. i z i i ndi mpuuzu. ak aand i ka z i .
i mpu u z u y aa b o .
N d a k e ne y e i mp u u z u y a a b o . N dakeney
N dakene y e e
e e e
ak a z i k aa b o .
u mu s h u u m b a .
u wu u n d i mu -
shuumba.
N dakeney
ab a a n d i
bashuumba .
65
UNIT 3
KIRUNDI
Exercise 2, 3 and 4. T h ese exercises violate the principle that al l r es p o n s e s i n an ex e r c i s e s h o u l d b e c o m p l e t e s e n t e n c e s . The concordial relationships which are the subject of these exercises are however of such great importance in the structure of the
l anguage, that it has been th ought important to throw them in t o t he sharpest focus and to dr ill them as ea rly as p o s s ib le . In each section, use the nouns themselves as cu es , and the en t ir e
s ubst a n t i v e
p h r a s e s a s r es p o n s e s .
the
a.
/ aan j e / > m y ~
P lura l 2. ab a s h u umba b a a n j e
4. imiduga yaanje 6. a m a s uk a y a a n j e
7. i k iintu caanje 9. i mp u u z u y a a n j e
I
1 2. a k a z i
ka anj e
b.
/ aa w e / > y ou r ( s g . ) >
P lur a l 2. 4. 6.
8.
66
B ASIC CO U R SK
UNIT 3
/
9.
impuuzu y a a we 11.
1 2.
akazi
k a aw e
/ a a bo j > th e i r
/
( per s o n a l ) <
t h ei r t h ei r t h ei r t h ei r s er v an t co o k d r i v er d r i v er s
waabo
umuduga
i mi d u g a isuka
/
izina
/
a mazi n a
yaabo
yaabo
t hei r
t hei r
n a mes
h o es
amasuka
amapikipiki i ki i n t u i bi i n t u i b i t a bo i g i t a bo igi t uu n gwa
caabo
67
UNIT 3 ib i t u u n g wa
/
KIRUNDI
vyaabo
/
t hei r t hei r
d o mesti c a n i m a l s c l ot hs
ivyaambarwa
i c a a mbar w a
their piece of cloth, clothing their piece of clo th, clothing their motorbike their machine their farm
impuuzu
i pi k i p i k i i mas h i i n i
urugo ingo
their farms
their articles of clothing their bicycle
impuuzu
zaabo
/
urubaangaangwe
/
rwaabo
/
urugaanda akazi
utuzi
C,plural of above]
E xerc i s e 3 . >Strong> adjectives. (Adjectives which have in the prefixes for Classes 1, 3, 0, 6. )
/m/
a.
/ k e/
<f e w <
f ew s e r v a n t s f ew car s few hoes f ew t h i n g s f ew c l o t h (e)s f ew j o b s
amasuka make
i bi i n t u bi k e i mpuuz u u tuz i nke
du k e
68
BASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 3
b.
/
i n sh i /
> much, m a n y < m any se r v a n t s m any car s many hoes m any t h i n g s m any cl o t h e s much work m any j o b s
abashuumba beenshi
/
meenshi
i b i i n t u vy i i n s h i i mpuuz u n y i i n s h i
/ /
a kazi u tuz i
k e enshi t wi i ns h i
c.
/ i za/
/
~g o o d ~
abashuumba beeza imiduga myiiza amasuka meeza
i b i i n t u vy i i z a
impuuzu nziiza
/
69
UNIT 3
KIRUNDI
E xerc i s e 0 . > Strong > an d > w eak > a d j e c t i v e s . Each line in this exercise may be used in four ways<
/
S tudent B :
2.
Te a c h e r:
Umudu g a .
3.
Te a c h e r<
Umudu g a .
/ /
4.
T e a c h e r:
Your good ca r .
Student A: Umuduga waawe mwiiza. [The tape recordings illustrate only the first of these ways.] a.
/
~your
/
g oo d
y our g o o d
car
B ASIC CO U R SE
UNIT 3
y our g o o d g o b
b.
>my few m y few c a r s m y few s e r v a n t s my few things m y few h o e s my few clothes m y few b o o k s my few motorbikes my few bits of work
c.
< thei r
b a abo b e enshi
/
yaabo meenshi
UNIT 3
KIRUNDI
Exercise 5. Pr e osed modifiers of nouns. In using this exercise, the teacher may give an ent;ire phrase from eit;her t;he first; or the second column. The st;udent responds with t' he corresponding phrase from the other column.
uyu m u s h u u mba u wuund i
/
m u s h u u mb a
aba bashuumba uwu muduga iyi miduga iri kiinga aya masuka
iki kiintu ibi biintu
/
abaandi
UWUUndi
i yi i n d i
i ri i ndi
ayaandi i ki i n d i i bi i n d i i yi i n d i i zi i n d i
/
masuka k ii n t u
biin t;u
iyi izi
mpuuzu mpuuzu
mpuuzu
mpUuzu
/ /
uru r u b a a n gaangwe a ka k a z i
uruundi a kaandi
rubaangwe kazi
Exercise 6. Us e of the au ment; vowel with ad ect'ives which are u sed a s n o u n s . fProceed as in Exercise g.]
' many a. s e r v a nt s I Imany> a beensh i
a ba s hu u m b a b e e n s h i
i myi i n s h i ameenshi
72
BASIC COURSE
UNIT
b.
abas h u u mba b e e n shi abashuumba bak e abashuumba beeza umushuumba mwiiza umuduga mwiiza imiduga myiiza imiduga myiinshi
C.
i vyi i z a i bik e
NB
T h e s p e c ia l tonal pa ttern in Column 2 for th ose ad j e ctives which in Column l hav e the leng th-pitch pa ttern VV CV . An
UNIT 3
KIRUNDI
Exercise '7. The effect of declarative intonation on a final hi h tone. Us e a form from one column as the c ue, a n d t h e c o r r e s ponding form from the other as the response. ( The t e a c h e r s h o u l d be especially strict about the tones in this exercise.)
a. Abaant u bak e . f i n a l vs . n o n -final Abaant u b a k e ca a n e .
I bi s a g ar a I bi i n t u
bi ke'?
v y i i za ?
Practice conversation.
l. A s k a p e r son what his work i s , where h e w o rk s , an d wh et h e r h e
BASIC C O U R S E
UNIT 4
UNIT 4
Di al o ue 1
-kuunda
(-kuunze)
- duuga ( - d u u z e ) umusozi
(3, 4)
1A
Ur akuu n d a k u d u u g
[
imisozi?
-uumva ( -uumvii s e )
ico
/
t o underst a nd ,
hear
(Cl. 7')
/
that
(pronoun)
say
- vuga ( - v u z e )
t o s p e ak ,
[
2B
"
]
I d o n < t u n d e r s t a n d ( <I h a v e n ' t u nders t o o d > ) what y o u j us t s aid . (negative prefix )
Sinu u m v iis i c u v u z e . e o
n ti -
- subi r a -oo--mwo
( -subiy e )
to repeat (conditional prefix ) (locative enclitic ) P lease r e p e a t . r epeat ? > ) ( ~Wouldn>t you
3B
Nt i wo o s u b i r k nw o ?
( -babari y e
( -ibagi y e )
t o f or g i v e t o f or g et
UNIT 4
KIRUNDI
[
4B Mbab a r ira, niibagiye Excuse me. I ive forgott;en the k uduu a . word ~
] ]
i k i '?
What d o e s to k uduu a ~ go mean?
[
5B >Kuduuga< b i v u g a
- ja
(- giiye )
amahera h eeju r u
t owar d
above
[
6A
>Kuj
]
a
a m a h er a h e e j u r u . I tegeera > To go upwar d . > t o underst a n d
( t'egereye)
[
7A
] ~ ]
Ur at ege e r e y e ?
( >Have y o u
[
8B
O y a ' si n t e g e e r e y e .
do n > t ( under s t a n d
).
[
9B Nti w o o subirlmwo?
b uhor o
]
1 0B Vu g a b uh o r o b u h o r o . Speak s l ow l y .
[
11A >Kuduuga i b i v uga k u j
K uduuga means t o
g o u p wards.
[-
a maher a
/
h e e j ur u .
nooneho
now
1 2B
Nda v y u u m v i i s e
n o on eh o .
N ow I u n d e r s t a n d
( it ) l
76
BASIC COURSE
UNIT 0
]
1 3B Ur ak o z e c a a n e j T hank yo u v e r y m u c h / done much) < ) ( <You hav e
1.
of these
languages are subject to endless variation. The same is true of the degrees of complexity which characterize the tonal systems.
The student has already discovered that the pro du ction
and differentiation of Kirundi tones is a matter requiring much care and practice. T hat is to say, Kirundi tones are fairly complicated on the phonological level. By this point in the course, however, the student should have begun to feel reasonably at ease in hearing and reproducing the more common sequences of tones. But' Kirundi tones also present t' he student with formidable
d i f f i cu l t i e s o n t h e g r am m a t ; i c a l l ev e l . I n t h i s l a n gu a g e , u n l i k e
some others, one cannot simply learn one tonal pattern for each verb stem, one for each substantive stem, and one for each prefix and suffix. T his is particularly true of verbs. Th e location of the prefix t;one and the stem tone varies according to the t;ense,
m ood, li.nkage and other characterist;ics of verb forms . Not in-
i n U ni t
1 , No t e 1.
of the use of tone in Kirundi. From this point on, however, such mat;ters will occupy a conspicuous place in the notes and exercises
o f almost every un it . I t i s o f c r u c ial importance, therefore ,
77
UNIT 4
KIRUNDI
c ontrasts between Columns 2 and 3 of Exercises 3 and 5. F o r thi.s reason, the dialogue and vocabulary of Unit 4 have been held to a minimum.
2.
S entences 2 ,
/ /
The /-oo-/ in the last of these forms is the marker for the conditional tense, and will not be discussed here. The negative prefix in the same word is /nti-/. T his prefix precedes the subject prefix: n ti b a t e g e e r e y e n tu t e g e e r e y e n t i d u t ;egeer ey e
/
t hey d o n > t y ou ( p l .
we d o n i t
underst and
wh i ch
com b i n e s a s f o l l o w s :
/ nti /
pl u s / a /
(3 s g. )
nt a' nt u -
he doesnl t
u n d e r s t an d
y ou ( s g . )
I
don<t
u nder s t a n d
si n -
3.
BASIC COURSE
UNIT Jj
INMEDIATE INDICATIVE
AFFIRMATI CONJUNCT DISJUNCT N GA TIVE
d usoma... [
ducur a . . . [ -
t ur a soma. . . [ t ur a c u r a . . . [ -
ntidusoma...[
' n t i du c u r a .
~]
]
..[
t ubaaza. . . [
duteek a . . . [
] ]
] -~ ]
t umesuura.. . [
dutegeer a . . . [
]
j
t uramesuur a . . . [ t ur a t e g e e r a . . . [
~
-m . ]
The ROOT SYLLABLE of a verb form is whichever syllable contains the first part of the root of the verb. The root syllable may thus also contain a prefix: in the form twaandika,
t he r o ot i s -andik-,
Th e root
s yllables in the ta ble have been underlined . I f the term >root syllable> is defined in this w ay , th e t ones of the verbs in th e ta ble may be r e du ced to a se t of c o m -
pact formulas:
CONJUNCT A ll tones low . DISJUNCT Anticipated high tone NEGATIVE A nticipated high ton e on the syllable af t er r oot syllable of a l l v er b s .
on root syllable of
s ome v e r b s .
79
UNIT
KIRUNDI In many of their forms, all verbs which are alike in the
n umber and length of their syllables are also alike in tone. T h i s is true, for example, of the conjunct and the negative forms in
t his table . I n o t h e r s of t h eir forms, verbs of a g i ven sy l la bl e
-cur-
an d - t eek -somand
-baaz- will be called LOW VERBS. A l most all Kirundi verbs will fall into one of these two classes.
)Por p ractice in tonal differentiation between high v e r b s
and low verbs s e e Exercise 1, Column 2 of Exercise 3, Column 3 of Exercise 4, Column 2 of Exercise 5 and 6.)
4.
A n ote on the tonal a t t ern of certain reduplications. Compare the tones of the word /buhoro / < s o f t l y , s l owl y >
b uhoro b u h o r o
I n this reduplicative construction, the first member has th e basic tonal pattern of the wo rd, whatever that may be . Th e
second member has an an t i cipated high tone on the f i rst sy llable f ollowed by low t o n es . subject, of drill. j l This construction will not be m ad e th e
5.
A n o t e o n t he c o n c o rd used when t he ant e cedent is quo t e d material. The subject o f Sentences 5 and 11 is a q u o t ed wor d : Kuduuga bi vug ikx? What d o e s ku du u g a m e a n ?
8O
BASIC COURSE
UNIT 4
K uduuga b i v u g a k u j h eeju r u .
ama h e r a
K ~ uduu a m e a n s S o climb.
g u s o ma?
Do yo u
Ndabi i z i
n e e za . se.
Ndavyuumv i i
Exercise l. H igh verbs vs. low verbs~ i n dicative immediate affirmative disjunct vs, conjunct. >Mill John read much?<
~ No, he will read li t t l e . ~
[
gusoma
k ur i m a
/
[
Y ohaani a r a s o ma c a a n e 2 ar a r i ma caaneP a r a v uga caane? ar a k or a c a ane? O ya, as'orna buhvr o . Oya, a rima b u h o r o . O ya, a v ug a b u h o r o . O ya, ak or a buhoro.
kuvuga
/
gukora k umesuura
k ugo r o o r a
UNIT
KIRUNDI
E xerc i s e a.
2.
j
kubaaza
/
N tasoma caane .
/
N tar i m a
caane.
N tamesuura c a a n e . N ti y a a n d i k a caane.
b. kubaaza guteeka
k umesuur a
N tumesuura c a a n e ?
Ntug o r o o r a N tusoma ca an e ?
k ugoroor a
gusoma k waand i k a
N timusoma caane ?
caane? c a an e ?
Ntimwaandfka caane?
Nti w a a n d i k a
C.
1 pl .
vs .
1 sg . ca a n e .
k ubaa z a
/
N ti t u b a a z a
/
S imbaaza c a a n e . S indima c a a n e .
k ur i m a
N titurima caane .
82
BASIC COURSE
UNIT 0
kumesuura
/
S imesuura S ingor o or a
S in t e e k a
/
/
caane. caane.
k ugoro or a
k ut e e k a
caane.
c aa n e . ca a n e .
ca a n e .
gucura
k waand i k a
S incur a
caane. caane.
Ntitwaandika caane.
S inaandik a
w r i t e m u ch?< >No, we w r i t ; e
Oya. O ya.
/
l i t t;l e . <
j
M uraandik a M uracur a caane? Ntitwaandika caane. Nt i duc u r a c a a n e . caane?
Oya. Nt;idusoma caane. Oya. Nt;iduteeka caane. Oya. N titubaaza caane. Oya. Nt;iturima caane. Oya.
/
M uramesuur a
N titumesuura caa n e .
b.
2 sg . a n d 1 s g .
<Do you
( sg. )
wr i t e much?
f.
k waand i k a
/
U raandik a
caane?
Oya.
O ya.
S inaandik a
caane,
gusoma
k ur i m a
U rasoma c a a n e ?
Si n s o m a c a a n e . S in d i m a caane.
U rarim a
caane?
Oya.
UNIT 4
/
/
KIRUNDI
gucura kubaaza
/
U racur a
caane?
Si n c u r a c a a n e . S imbaaza c a a n e .
/
U rabaaza c a a n e ?
/
guteeka kumesuura
U rateek a c a a n e ? U ramesuura c a a n e ?
S int e ek a
caane.
Si m e s u ur a c a a n e .
E xercise 4 . N e g a t i v e im m ed iate vs. infinitive . [ Note t h a t i n this exercise, high verbs are distinguished from low v e rbs in Column 3 , b u t n o t i n Co l u m n 2 . j
>I don> t
c a r v e m u ch . <
S imbaaza c a a n e . S int e ek a
/
caane.
S insoma caane .
S in c u r a
/
ca a n e .
g u cu r a .
S imesuura S inaandik a
caane. caane,
E xerc i s e
<I d o n > t
l i ke t o. >
U rakuunda kuduu g
i m isozi?
Sin d a b i k u u n d a . S imbi k u u n d a .
or :
he
A rakuunda kuduu g
i m i sozi?
N tab i k u u n d a . N titubikuunda .
y ou (p i
N urakuunda kuduu g
i m i sozi?
BASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 4
they kumenya
N tib a b i k u u n d a . Ntibabiizi.
Ntitubiizi . Sindabiizi or : Simbiizi.
a
a
y ou ( p l . ) you (sg,.)
M uraazi kuduu g
/
i m i sozi?
/
U raazi kuduu g
i m i sozi?
A raazi kuduu g
i m isozi?
Ntabiizi.
C onversation
r a c t ice l.
The student should ask the teacher the meanings of the following words. ( Each i s a sy n o n y m o r n e a r s y n o n y m o f s o m e w ord wh i c h h a s a l r ea d y b e e n l e a r n e d . ) i gi s a t a g uhi i n d u k i r a g ushik a
/
igik or wa kubaasha
C onversation
r a c t ice 2.
( Student > s
book c l o s e d .)
Uv5he?
85
UNIT 5
KIRUNDI UNIT 5
mbe
( a quest i o n wor d )
to give difficulty t o l ea r n
-goora { - g o oye)
- gaga {-size
1A
) ]
M be i k i ruundi kiragooye
I s Kirundi hard to l e a r n ?
[ ~
k wii g a ?
1
caane v ery , much
[
2B Nt i k i goo y e c a a n e .
]
-shaaka (-shaatse )
C
gA
]
I want to learn it. to teach
Nas ha a k a k u c i i ga .
- iz a ( - i g i g e )
[
4B
~ ~
U rakoze c a a n e f
a ri k o
]
If you like, I will teach it to you
Thank s v e r y m uc h f but
Us haat s e n z o o k i k w i i z a .
[
5A
[
6A Ar i k o n d i
n a umutw e
-]
ugumye.
parts . ]
86
BASIC COURSE
UNIT 5
Di al o
ue 2.
[
7C Us haa k a g u k o r i k i ? a What do you want to do?
[
8D
Ns haa k a g u t a a n g u r a
- ~
]
I want to begin to study
Kir u n d i .
[~
k wiig
-~
a
- zo o -
]
(non-immediate future p ref i x )
i k i ruundi.
-fasha (-fashije
) ]
to hel p
[- ~
9C Us haat s e n z o o g u f a s h a .
[
1 0D Ur ak o z e c a a n e .
]
Thanks a l ot .
Dial o
ue 3.
mwe
o ne, s a me
[
11E
Ikiruundi n i k inyarwaanda
[
ni
] ]
bi mwe?
[
1 2P Oya ,
si bi m w e .
N o, t h e y < r e
n o t ( th e s a m e ) .
- f i t a ( -f i s c ) i t a a n dukaan i r o
to
to have
(5, 6)
dif f small
er e n c e
[
1 3E Bif is
]
itaa n d u k a a n iro ri to . T h e y a r e a l i t tle different .
87
UNIT 5
KIRUNDI
[
14E Ur a f i s i g i tabo c e a
]
f M
i ki r uu n d i ?
D o you h a v e
a Ki r undi bo ok?
] ]
[~
1 5F E ego . Ndaf i s e c i i z a .
Yes, I
h a v e [ a ] go o d [ on e ] . teacher who?
umwiigiisha (1, 2)
nde
r
[
16E U m w i i giisha waawe n i inde? W h o is your teacher?
/
ntuuze
s o-and- s o
f
17P Ni nt uu z e .
It>s
So-and-so.
l.
A n ote on ob ect r e f ixes. Object prefixes have already been discussed in Units 2
and 4. In the former, a table of personal object prefixes was given. The non-personal object prefixes are listed in the s ynopsi s
(p. xxi i
).
[For practice in using the object prefixes that correspond to inanimate nouns, see Exercises 5 and 6.] In Kirundi, more than one object prefix may be used in the s ame ver b :
n zook i k w i i za
i t (/-k -/ ) )
[ Forms with two ob j ect prefixes will not be made the g oal of i n -
88
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT5
2.
os i t i on s .
Ndafise ciiza.
I h av e a g o o d [ o n e j .
t he wor d of t h e
c onta i n e d
I h av e a g o o d b o o k . I h av e a n o t h e r b o o k .
3.
/-a/, while others end in /-e/. Except for imperat;ive and subjunctive
forms, this distinction in form stands for a difference in ASPECT.
The word ~as ect i s a f,rammarian>s term f' or the shape of ' a n
a c t i on
Kirundi has a two way aspect'ual dist;inct;ion between imperfective and perfective verb forms.
An imperfect;ive form is
one that stands for a c o n t inuing act;ion, while a perf e ctive form s tands for one that, is thought of as being completed . A majority
of the forms of a Kirundi verb, regardless of t;ense, are either imperfect;ive or perfective, and have otherwise synonymous c ount e r parts in the ot;her aspect . I m p e r f e c tive forms e nd i n
/ -a/ ,
per-
fective forms end in /-e/, and the /-e/ is either preceded by /-y-/,
UNIT 5
KIRUNDI
or there is a difference between the final consonant of the imperfective and the perfective form: A verb which has a perfective in /-ye/, with no consonant change, i s /-soma/.
Usom
a e
i ki ? i ki ?
W hat sub j ec t are you reading ? What did you und erstand
Usomy
[ as y o u
r ead j u s t
now]?
A verb which has a difference between the last consonant of corresponding perfective and imperfective forms is P turuka/ : A turu k l h e ? A tur u t s e h e ? W here i s h e f r om ?
An example of strikingly different imperfective and perfective forms is: A geenda kw i i s 5 k o . Agiiye kw iis5ko. He goes t o t he m a r k e t .
The consonant of the perfective form can often be guessed if one knows the consonant of the imperfective, but because there are a nu m ber of ir regular verbs, the student is a d v i s ed t o learn the perf ective stem of each verb separately, at le a s t i n the beginning .
90
B ASIC CO U R SE
UNIT5
A note on the translation e uivalents of man E n lish ad ectives. Kirund1, like many other Bantu languages, has a very small number of words which behave like the adjectives of Indo-European l anguages . Th e s t em /-iza/ <good> with its various concordial
is
of course the disJunct prefix> the /-e/ is a part of the mark of perfective aspect. The 1nfinitive form of this same verb is / kugoora/
>to
at this time try to make phrases that correspond to English adJ ect i v e - n o u n p h r a s e s : <a hard language,> since this requires a special tonal pattern on the verb. Students who are familiar with Swahili will recognize, in the use of the perfective aspect in these forms, a parallel with the use of the / - me- /
> it is spoiled . t
t en s e i n s u c h S w a h i l i f or m s a s /imeharibika /
91
UNIT
KIHUNDI
Exercise 1.
Pe r fective vs. imperfective stems, as exemplified in t;he immediat;e perfective and the infinitive. > John has just; read the letter.He knows how to read well.~
[
gusoma Yohaan Yohaan Y oh a a n
/
]
a somy
~
g u s oma n e e z a .
i k eet e .
k ugoroor a
k umesuur a k waandik a
a goroo y
ame su u y
e e
i mp u u z u . impuuzu.
r
Y ohaa n . y a a n d it s i k e e t e . i a
k ugeendeesha Y o haani
a g e e n d e eshe j um u d u g a . Araazi e
neeza.
/
kuduuga
Y ohaani
a d u u z um u s o z i . e
neeza.
Exer c i s e 2 .
Perfective forms that correspond to English be plus adjective. C oncord between subject; and verb.
I kiruundi kiragooye ? I s Ki r und i har d ?
Igiswaahiri kiragooye'?
I s Swahili hard ?
Iriingara riragooye'?
I s Li ngal a har d ?
I k i n y a r w a a nda kiragooye'?
Ikinyarwaanda kirooroshe?
92
BASIC COURSE
UNIT 5
Igiswaahiri
j ;ri i n g a r a
u rwo r u r i m i
tthat lan/
r ur oo r o s h e ?
I s that language ea sy ?
guage>
i zo ndimi Izo ndimi zirooroshe ?
A re t ' h os e l a n g u a g e s easy'?
E xerc i s e
3.
( Conti n u a t i o n U rwo r u r i m i
/
o f Ex e r c i s e 2 ) r ur oo r o s h e ?
/
i gi t a b o
ibit;abo
A re t h o s e b o o k s e x p ensi v e ?
amapikipiki
umuduga
l ml d u g a
i r a z iimvye?
Are t h o s e c a r s ex p e n sive? I s t h a t ma ch i n e ex -
i mas h i i n i
(sg )
i mash i i n i
I zo mashiini ziraziimvye ?
(pl }
93
KIRUNDI
/
I zo mpuuzu z i r a r e m e er e ye ?
Ar e t hos e c l ot he s
h eavy ?
i bi t abo i g i t ab o ikeet e
Ar e t h o s e b o oks h e a v y ? I s t hat b o ok h e a v y ?
Ar e t hos e c l ot h e s c h e a p ?
Iyo pikipik. iraziimbuutse? I s that motorcycle i cheap? Ayo m a p ikipik a r a z iimbuu- Are those motorcycles cheap?
amapikipiki
imbaangaangwe
Izo mbaangaangwe z ir a z i i m b u u t s e ?
Are
t h os e bi c y c l es
cheap?
BASIC COURSE
UNIT 5
Exercise 4.
Im m ediate dis unct affirmative vs. immediate ne ative. (Special attention should be given to the tonal. patterns of the verbs. )
t It is not hard to l e a r n .
Nticooroshe kwiiga. Ntikigooye kwiiga. Ntikigcoye kwuumva. Nti c o o r o s h e Nti c o o r o s h e k w uumva. g u s o ma.
kwooroha I k iruundi kirooroshe kwuumva? gusoma kugoora Ikiruundi kirooroshe gusoma? Ik i r u undi kiragooye gusoma?
Ntikigooye gusoma.
Exercise 5.
Ob e ct r e f i xes with a hint from the o s s essive concords'. (Cues from Column 1 should be given first as noun plus possessive, later as noun without possessive. )
I Have y o u se e n m y b o o k ? < >I<v e seen i t .
i gi t a b o
(caanje)
(caange)
U raboony
I
i gi t abo c a a n g e ?
r
N dakiboony e .
N daki b o o n y e . N dabi b o o n y e . N dabi b o o n y e .
icaambarwa i bi t a b o
(vyaang e )
ivyaambarwa
{vyaange)
i keet e
U raboony
i k eet e r y aa n g e ' ?
N darfb o o n y e .
95
UNIT 5 impuuzu
KIRUNDI
{yaange )
impuuzu ( zaange )
umwiigiisha (waanje) Uraboonye umwifgiisha waange? abiigiisha (baange) Uraboonye abiigi/sha baange? u mushofeer i ( waange) U r a b o o ny e u mushof e er i
/
w a ange?
Ndamuboonye.
N dawuboon y e . N dabi b o o n y e .
Ur aboon y e i b i r o v y a a nge?
Ur a b o onye ipikipiki yaange? Uraboonye u r u b a a ngaangwe
/
(yaange)
N dayiboony e . N daruboonye .
urubaangaangwe
(rwaanJe) rwaan)e
[ N13 Th e t a p e h a s /umushofeeri / w here t h e Ob e ct r e f i xes. <Do you n ee d a
/
b o o k h a s /umushofeeri /.
Exercise 6.
c l er k ?<
umukaraani abakaraani
abashuumba umushuumba
U rakeney U rakeney
U rak e ne y U rak e ne y
r
e
e e
u mukaraani ? aba k a r a a n i ?
a b a sh u u m b a ? u mu s h u u m b a ?
e e
e e e e
urubaangaangwe
i bir o
Urakeney
Urak e ne y
ur ub a a n g aangwe?
i bi r o ?
N darukeneye .
N dabi k e n e y e , N dazi k e n e y e . N dagi k e n e y e , N dabi k e n e y e .
impuuzu
i ki i nt u i bi t abo
U rakeney
U rakeney Urak e ne y
i m p uuzu?
i k i intu? i bi t abo ?
96
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT g
Exercise 7.
a book?<
Urafis i g itabo?
e e umuduga
/
U rafi s
/
umu d u g a ?
u r u b a an g a a n g w e ? i p i kipiki?
/
/
m wiiza .
r w1 i z a .
/
u ru b a a n g a a n g w e i pi k i p i k i impuuz u
/
U ra f i s U rafis
/
e
e e
U rafis
i m puuzu?
gushaaka
umubooyi abashuumba u ru g o
/
U rashaaka
i mpuuzu?
Nshaaka n z i i
za .
za.
ingwa
n z i i za .
Exercise 8.
/
s e n t e n c e s a s c u e s .)
a a
i k i ruundi.
I want to study Kirun d i . T hey want to study Kirun d i . They don~t want to s tu dy Ki r u n d i . They d o n > t w a n t t o s p e a k Ki r u n d i . I don<t k n o w ho w t o r ead Ki r u n d i . don>t k n o w how t o s peak t ha t l a n g u a g e .
k wiig i k i r u u n d i .
Nt'ibashaaka k wiig i k i r u u n d i .
Nsibashaaka
kuvu
i kizuu n d i .
Hiinzi gusom
u rw o r u r i m i .
S ii n z i
ku z e e n d e s a
u mudu a . a ~
97
KIRUNDI I never (>I don>t know how to~) go to t;he market. He can>t go to the market.
H e doesn>t want to go to t he mar k e t . H e doesn>t want to s tudy Ki run d i I want to study Kirundi .
Nt;ashobora Ntashaaka
k u g e e n da k w i i s ok o . k u g e e nda kw i i s 5k o .
gaaahaaka Nshaaka
~ kwii i
kizu u n d i .
k wi ig i k i r u u n d i .
Exercise 9.
Ra n dom substitutions. I d o n > t u n d e r s t a n d ( or hear ) w hat; you s a i d . I don>t understand what y ou s a i d . f.c 0 uvuze.
/
S inuumviis i c u vuze. e o
e
/
Nshaaka k wuumv
/
I want to understand what y ou s a i d . I want to understand ( or he ar ) t hat l a n g u a g e . They don<t underst'and that language.
E.
T hey d o n< t
Swahi l i .
underst and
b uhoro .
98
BASIC COURSE
UNIT
Practice Conversation 1.
Yohaani
ar i i g
igiswaahiri ?
K eg
a ta a nguye
vuba.
You ask whether his t eache r s peaks Swahili we l l . U m w i i g i i sha wi iw e
aravug h Xri
igi swaa-
neeza? A raki v u g a .
/
i gi t a b o c
caane.
igiswaahiri.
UNIT 5
KIRUNDI
/
U shobora g u t a a n g u r
ubu?
Ubi s h a a t s e .
F ree c o n v e r s a t i o n . 1. A makes arrangements with B for help in learning Kirundi 2. B says something that A does not understand. A r eacts a ccor d i n g l y .
100
B ASIC CG U R SE
UNIT 6 Dial o ue l .
ngaahe h ow many ' ?
]
1A U vug
R
indi m i z i i n g a a h e ?
H ow many l a n g u a ge s d o
s peak '?
you
[
2B Mvu g a i n d im i z i ta tu .
I s p ea k t h r e e ( l a n guages .
w hi c h ' ?
he
[
3A Niiz i i h e ? o r : N i i z i i he ? Wh ich o n e s ar e t h ey '?
igif a r a ansa
[ i
French
~ -]
One is French, another is
%B
R u mwe n
igi f'araansa,
[ ~
uruundi n urwaa g a t a t ; u
~ ]
Kir u n d i
ig i s waahiri;
n.
i
[-
]
i c o ongereza
/
[ -w
5A
i
x
naabi
]
D o you k n o w En g l i s h ?
b adl y
Ur aa z . I coo n g e r e z a ?
[
6B
~
gusa
]
I speak it poorly.
onl y
Nd a k i v u ga n a a b i n a a b i .
101
UNIT 6
KIRUNDI
]
7B Nda g i s o ma , n k a c a a n d i k a I only read and write it.
[ -]
g usa .
8A
U b o n i c o o ngereza kigooye?
D o y o u find ( >see<) [ t h a t ]
E nglish is difficult ?
[
9B
]
E nglish is hard to sp e a k .
I c oon g e r e z a k i r a g o o y e
w
g usuumb i c o o n g e r e z a . a
Dial o
ue 2.
-mara ( - maze)
i gih e
to end, terminate ti me
t o be eq ua l t o
(7)
-ngana ( - n ganye)
L1 1C Umaz
~
e
igi h e k i i n g an
]
a
H ow lon g h a v e y o u s p e n t (you)
s tudying Kirundi ?
i ki wiig
i k i ruundi?
ukweezi
tatu
(1$, 6)
m oon, mont h
t hr e e
102
BASIC COURSE
UNIT 6
[
12D N d aciiz
]
a m e ezi atatu. I studied it three months.
[ - ~
13C W a ciigiiylhe? iwaacu
r
l
W here di d you st udy i t ?
a t t my ]
]
1 4D N a c i i g ii y i w a a c u . e I st udi ed i t i n my h ome
c ount r y .
Dial o
ue 3. umunyeeshuur e
(1, 2)
a st u d e n t
]
1 5E U r umu n y e e s h u u r e ?
A re yo u a s t u d e n t ?
[~ ]
1 6F Eego. Yes.
z.sabha (9, 6)
umuusi
hour day ( 2 4 - h ou r p e r i od }
(3, 4)
17E W ii g
a m a sK h a n g aahe a
H ow many ho ur s s tudy ?
a day d o yo u
k u mu u s i ?
]
18P N ii g a m a sah a t aanu ku a a muusi.
i yii nga
(9, 6 )
week
E
19E W ii g a
- ~
]
H ow many day s s tudy ? 103 a week do y o u
i m i i s i n g aahe
UNIT 6
KIRUNDI
]
mw iiyiinga?
[
2 0F
~
N i i g , i m i i s . itaanu . a i
j
I study five days
2 1Z
Wiiz
igi f a r a an s
igi h e
[
k iingan
i k i '?
umwaaka
( g, 4 )
year
[-~
2 2F U m waa k
]
a
umw e ,
O ne year .
N B Th e
Su lementar U rakene y e
i k ar a a m u ? { g or 9 ,
/ /
6)
(pen)'?
amakar aamu
urupaapur o ir a a n gi
i gitabo c
( 11, 1 0 )
(g, or 9)
u k w a andika
in g wa
(9)
l.
r ef i x e s .
of
The tones of' verb forms depend not only on f a c t or s t he kinds which have already been considered (tense , also on the pr e s ence or ab s ence of an ob j ect, prefix.
e tc. )
Thi s
but
not e
104
BASIC COURSE
UNIT 6
N da~i k u u n d a . Urag o r o o y
i z i mpu u zu ?
N dazi g o r o o y e .
on t;he object prefix, and the verb st;em itself has low tones' l o w v erbs h a v e n o h i g h t ; o n e s .
2.
A n o t e o n t he u se of d i f ferent sets of r ef i x e s w i th t h e
s ame noun s t e m . T he noun s t e m /-ruundi/ appears in the singular-plural pair of forms: Umu-ruundi A ba-ruundi
(1) ( 2)
a Rundi p e r s o n R undi p e o p l e
Iki - r u u ndi
(7)
als o
in : Ubu-ruundi
(14)
These same class prefixes may be ap p l ied with the same me an ings t o many noun st ems denoting ethnic groups :
105
UNIT 6
KIRUNDI
Umu-faraansa (1)
Ubu-bi r i gi
F rench p e r s o n B elgi u m
Engl i s h p eo p l e
Aboongereza i k i z u u n gu
a c t i ng or
3.
A no t e on c o r n a r i s o n s o f i n e u al i t Sentence 10 contains an example of comparison> Ikiruundi kiragooye gusuumb i c oongereza. a i s har d Kirundi is harder than English ('Kirund i s urpas s i n g E n g l i s h ')
A very common way of expressing comparison of inequality in Rundi m akes us e o f t he w o r d /gusuumba/, which is the infinitive of the
v erb t h a t m e a n s Ito surpass>. In the above example, /gusuumba/ f o l l o w s a v e r b (/kiragooye/); it may also be used with adjectives: Special note should be made of the sentences in which the word that follows directly after /-suumba/ is a possessive pronoun. First of all, the tonal patterns on the possessives are unlike the tones found with t hese s ame s t e ms e l s e w h e r e ;
/
aange
aawe iiwe
/
Notice that the singular stems have one tonal pattern, and the plural s tems an o t h e r . With regard to the prefixes used with these possessive stems,
sentences which con tain them must be d iv ided into two gr ou ps . An
106
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 6
" "
"
" ""
-/
a p p ear s a l s o
of the class of the sub ect ex ression. Thus, / rw-/ in the sentence: Akazi k a a w e n i k ee z a g u s u umba r w a ange .
I t / t ; he y N i k e ez a
( C l . 8 ) i s be t t; e r t h a n m 1 n e .
g u s u umb a k a a n J e .
It
( C l . 1 2) i s b e t t e r t ha n m i n e .
In these sentences the possessive after /-suumba/ has the same class prefix as its ant;ecedent. It; also has the augment vowel. Singular stems have high tone on the mora that follows the prefix: ivyaange ivyaawe i vyi i w e
/
34.
6.]
A tern orar note on the verbs in Sent;ences 8 and 11. U bon i c oo n g e r e z a k f g o o y e ? a U maz i g ihe kiingan i k f e a whig i k iruundi? a
D o you find tha t
Engli s h
i s har d ?
In these sentences, the main verbs are respectively /ubona/ and /umaze/. T h ese verbs are in t;he indicative mood and require no c omment h e r e . Th e v er b s /kigooye/ and /wfiga/ however begin with
high tone, and in this respect differ from indicative forms. These forms are in the participial mood, which will be discussed in great;er det;ail beginning with Unit 9 107
UNIT 6
KIRUNDI
Exercise 1. C o rresponding nouns of Classes 2 and 3.4. > Where do t h e B a r u n d i come f r o m'?>
A baru u n d i A baru u n d i b a t u r uk K h e ?
a a
i i
Bu r u u n d i . Rwaa n d a .
A banyarwaanda Abaf'araansa
Ababi r i gi
/
B atur uk a mu B u f a r a a n s a . Baturuka mu Bubirigi. B atur uk a mu B woonger e z a . Baturuka muri Arabiya. B aturu k Baturu k a a i Koon g o . i Bur ay a .
/
Aboongereza Abaarabu
Abanyeekoongo
/
Abazuungu
A bahi i n d i
Abahiindi baturukKhe?
Abahi i ndi
B aturuka mu Bu h iind i .
Exercise 2. C o rresponding nouns of Classes 2 and 7. >What language do the B arundi p e o p l e s p e a k ' ?~
A baru u n d i A baruundi bavu g r uu h e ?
/
/
>They sp eak
Kirundi . '
/
u r urimi
Bavug
i k i r uundi .
A banyarwaanda
A b a n y a r w a anda b a vu g ur ur i m i
B avug
i k i ny a r w a a n d a .
r uu h e ?
/ /
A bafar a a n s a
Bavug
i gi f a r a a n s a.
108
BASIC COURSE
UNIT 6
Abaarabu
A baarabu b a vu g ruuhe?
r r
ur ur i m i
B avug
i c aa r a b u .
Abagaande
A bagaande b a vu g
r uu h e ?
/
ur ur i m i
B avug
i k i gaa n d e .
Aboongereza
A boongereza b a vu g ur u r i m i a
r uu h e ?
B avug
i coo n g e r e z a .
Abazuungu
A bazuungu b a vu g ruuhe'?
/
ur ur i m i
A bahi i n d i
Bavug
i gi h i i ndi .
B avug i coo n g e r e z a . a
Bavug
i k i r uu n d i .
Abahutu Abanyeekoongo
ur ur i m i
B avug
i n d imi nyiinshi.
Abamoso
Bavu g
i k i r uu ndi .
UNIT 6 E xerc i s e 3.
KIRUNDI <Than<. Absolute pronouns and object prefixes. < John sp eak s F r e n c h (as a f o r e i g n I [do]. t
l a n g uage) b e t t e r
t han
jeewe
wewe
weewe
Y ohaani
Araki v u g a
/
tweebwe
mweebwe
k u b a s uumba.
/
abaandi
E xerc i s e
4.
> Than.>
C o n c o r d w i t h po s s e s s i v e s ,
t h an mi n e . <
umuduga
umubooyi
u wa a n j e .
imiduga
Imiduga y a a we
BASIC COURSE
UNIT 6
Ipikipiki yaaw e
amapikipiki
i bir o
imashiini
a mamashii n i
akazi
N i k e ez a g u s u umba ak a an j e . iraangi
/ /
u rupaapur o
i mpaap u r o
ik a r a amu
Exer c i s e g .
S u b j e ct;-verb concord .
Iriingara rirooroshe
gusuumb i g iswaahir5? ikinyarwaanda I k inyarwaanda kirooroshe gusuumb i g iswaahiri? kugoora Ikinyarwaanda kiragooye gusuumb i g iswaahiri'? i coonger ez a I c oonge r e z a k i r a g o o y e gusuumb i g iswaahiri? a Igif a r aansa kiragooye gusuumb i g iswaahir5? kwooroha Igifaraansa kirooroshe gusuumb i g iswaahirT?
Is Ki n y arwanda easier
than Swahili' ?
igifaraansa
I s F r e n c h e a s i e r t han
Swahi l i ?
a a
irii ngara
E xerci s e
IThan' with verbs. Concord with and without change o f n umber . Iziindi nd5mi zirooroshe
g usuumb u r wo .
T he ot h e r
l an g u a g e s a r e
kugoora
Ur wo
more difficult
t hat
i bi t ab o
T he ot h e r
112
UNIT
BASIC C O U R SE
amapikipiki
kuremeera
1 mashil n i
I zi f n d i
m a s h i fn i g u s uumb
The o t h e r
m ac h i n e s a r e
T he o t h e r
machines a r e t h a n t h a t on e .
c heaper
imiduga
T he ot;her
c a r s a r e ch e a p e r
t han t h a t o ne .
k uzi i m b a
T he o t h e r
cars ar e more
a uw 0 .
113
UNIT 6
KIRUNDI
E xercise 7 .
an object prefix.
< Do you like this book ? <
/
Urakuund Urag o r o o y
a e
i k i g i t a bo '? i z i mpu u zu ? e a k a k a zi ?
/ /
Ura t a a n g u y
N dagataanguye .
N dawugeen d e e s h a .
U rageendeesh
Urako z
u w u m u d u ga ?
ak a k az i ?
Urakeney
ur ub a a n g aangwe?
Exercise 8. L o cative prefixes with the names for periods of time. > How many hour s U kora amasKh ukweez~
i yi i nga k wi i g a
/
a
a
a
a n g a a h e k u muu s i ?
/
U kora amasa h
an g a a h e mu k w e e z i ?
Ukora amasah a n gaahe mw iiyiingaP Wiig a m asKh a n g aahe mw iiyiinga'? a a Wiig a m asah a n g aahe ku muusi? a a Wiig a m asah a n g aahe mu kweezi? a a
umuusi ukweezi
/
114
BASIC COURSE
UNIT 6
E xerc i s e
9.
<How many?< Concord with two different ad)ective stems. < How many book s h a v e y o u ? > II h a v e
Mfi s e Mfi s e
m a ny
i bi t ab o i bi i n t u
e
e
v y i i n sh i . v y i i n sh i .
imbaangaangwe
/
Ufis impuuzu ziingaahe? e Ufis a b ateetsi baangaahe? e Ufis a bashofeeri baangaahe? e Ufis i m idug i n g aahe? e a Ufis imyaak i r g aahe? e a Ufis amapikipiki angaahe?
e
M fis e
beenshi .
Mfise myiinshi.
Mfise meenshi.
M fis e m e ens h i .
U fis e
a masu k ang a a h e ? a
E xerci s e
10.
i pi k i p i ki
amapikipiki
Ukuund U kuund
Ukuun d Ukuun d Ukuun d Ukuun d Ukuun d U kuun d
a
a
i y i i he p ik i p i k i
a y a a h e mapikipiki?
u r u u h e r upaapur o ' ? i z i i h e mpaapuro? i b i i h e bir o '? i k i i h e caambarwa'? i b i i h e vyaambarwa?
/
urupaapur o impaapuro
i bir o
a a a a a a
icaambarwa
i v y a a mb a r w a
urubaangaangwe
115
KIRUNDI
/ / /
U kuund
a a k a ahe ka zi ?
U kuund Ukuun d
Pract;ice Conversation 1.
/
Uravug
i r i i ngar a ?
N dari v u g a n a a b i n a a b 5 .
Ndary i i
/
ga k w
i ishuul i ,
M az
uk w eezi k umwe
gusa .
Practice Conversat;ion 2. Y ou go o n b y a s k in g
I riingara riragooye ?
116
BASIC CO U R SE
UNIT 6
N ti r i g o o y e c a a n e . U shaaka k u r y i i ga ' ?
/
Eego.
U m w i i g i i sha
F ree Conv er s a t i o n . l. A needs a clerical worker who speaks some English. B , who has been studying English for a short time, applies for the pos it i on .
2. C is a European who knows a little Kirundi but has had no experience with any other African language. H e asks D, a speaker of Kirundi who also knows some Swahili (or some other African language ) how K i r u ndi and the o ther language compare with on e a nothe r .
117
UNIT 7
KIRUNDI UNIT 7
Dial o
ue 1. umuvuukanyi
(1, 2)
s ibl i n g
[
1A
w
U rafi s
e
~
abav u u k a n y i
]
Do yo u h a v e m a n y b r o t h e r s a nd s i s t e r s '?
[~
b eens h i ?
[
2B
~
bee n s h i ca a n e .
]
No, ( t h e y a r e ) no t v e r y m a n y . to o ne who b e l o n g s
O ya s i
mweene (1, 2)
mweenewaacu
/
m ushikaang e ( 1 , 2 )
bir i
nyene
also
[
3B
~
Mfis e
~~
]
I h av e t w o b r o t h e r s , an d also two sisters.
b e e n ewaacu
[
b abir i na ba s h i k a a n g e
]
]
b abir i ny e n e .
[
4A Bafis i m yaak i n g an e a a
How ol d a r e t hey ?
[ - ]
i ki ?
- rut a
( - r u s e)
t o pass ,
surpass
118
BASIC COURSE
UNIT 7
[~
B eenewaacu b a r a a n d u t a . My brothers are older than I, behind
]
A nd my s i s t e r s a r e y o u n g e r t han Z . ( <are b e h i n d m e <)
[
m uu nyuma za a nj e umuvyeeyi
(1, 2)
parent
[
[
A bavyeeyi
]
b a awe Are your parents still living' ? ( >are t h e y s t i l l t h er e ' ? < )
all
]
8B B arlh o boose.
[~
Beenewaanyu b a bKhe?
W here do y o u r ( m.) b r o t h e r s
- -]
1 0D Mu r umu n a a n j
ab aa n a
- ~
n a
a b a v y e ey i b a a c u .
]
1 1D Af' i s imy a a k a c u m i . e He i s t en y e a r s ol d . s eni o r p er so n
mukuru
(1, 2)
119
UNIT 7
KIRUNDI
[1 2C Na muk u r u w a a we ? A nd th e o l d e r ?
[
1 3D Mu k u r u wa an p e n. My older [brother ] i s s tudent in Kitega .
[
u munyees h uu r i
[G it e g a .
3 j
1 0E Muk u r u w a a w ak o r e a
W hat kind of work does you r
older
[ br o t h e r j do ?
[
a kazi nyabaki ? umubaaji
(1, 2)
c arpent e r
[
1 5F N. umu b a a j i .
i
H e>s a c a r p e n t e r .
-r oonka amahera
(-roonse)
t o receive, money
ge t
(6)
amafaraanga (6q
1 6E
Umub a a g
ar ar oo n k a
[
amahera.
Mweenewaacu n . umubaaji.
i
/
w orker
b ui l d e r
in wood
n g. umwuuba t s i
l.
120
B ASIC CO U R SE
UNIT 7
N weenewaacu
n n.
umukaraani
/
c ler k herdsman
m erch a n t p ol i c e m a n fi sh er man
umwuungere
u mudaand a z a
n
i
u m u poor X s i
/
n . umur o v y i G o thr o u g h
stituting other
words f o r
121
UNlT 7
KIRUNDX
Vocabulary: K i nship terms. The following are words which ego (a man) will use in referring to the individual shown on the c hart .
20.
m ushikaa n j e
m weene w a a c u
(I being
a m a n)
21. 22.
23 24. 25.
6.
7. 8.
26.
27.
umug a b o w a s e e n g e s eeng e
28.
29. 30. 31
9.
1 0. 1 1.
daat a/daawe
m a a ma /maawe m a a r u me (umug5re w a maarume (umugabo
12.
32.
13.
14. 1 5. 1 6. 1 7. 1 8.
w a m a amawaacu )
33. 34.
35.
( umwiigeme) g i rl
122
BASIC COURSE
UNIT 7
o
l5
~
I 'f
o
18
a a O
0
22
<
2)
0 Zf
D0
30
34
33
$9
o z
3$ 56
0
38 3%
IO
<
'4'L
0
9b
II I
123
UNIT 7
KIRUNDI
42.
43.
44. 45
N ote that the list does not in clude the words wh ich ego wou l d u se in addressing those persons, and that it also does not in d i -
cate what those persons would call ego. [The student should check the above kinship terms to be sure that t hey a g r e e w i t h h i s t ut or < s u s a g e , a n d s h o u l d a l s o el i ci t t h e t er m s
< and, w i t h
fo l low/na
.<
ar e
different from the tones of the same words in m ost o ther environ -
ments.
i bi i ndi n
other ( thi n g) s
a nd o t h e r s
( C l. 8)
( the l a n g u a g e )
a ik i n y a r w a anda
i k i ny ar w aanda
I
i b iindi
Kinyar waanda
a nd K i n y a r w a a n d a
T he above examples, which illustrate the simpl est ca s e , show that the f i rst vowel of the word that fo llows / h ig h t on e . A slightly more complex relationship is il lustrated by t he w or d f o r
na/
h as a
> my (m)
b ash i k a a n j e n a bash i k a a n j e
with my sisters
BASIC CO U R SE
UNIT 7
H ere, o n e xpecte d
t h e b a s i s of t h e f i r s t s et of ex a m p l e s , o n e m i g h t ha v e + / nabash i k a a n j e /.
/
s yl l a b l e s . '
beenewaacu
/ /
my siblings of my se.x
/
na beenewaacu
and
II
used with Cl. 9-10, then the/na /form begins with/ ni i ingwa n i i n g wa
/ /
-/ :
[Exercises 1,2 provide an opportunity for practice in alternating these tonal patterns on nouns. ] There are a number of other elements in Kirundi which behave tonally like/nag. T his tonal behavior will be called DEFERRED HIGH TONE, symbolized in citation forms by an acute
a ccent written after the el emen t .
2.
O r d i n a l n ume r a l s .
Thi s
h a s a l r e a dy b e e n
(This is the root for ~three~, but it is never used without a prefix. )
t hi r d , t hr ee
w agatat u
u wagat a t u
/
d ay , <
125
UNIT 7
KIRUNDI
t wo
abavyeeyi r beenewaacu
-
beenewaacu-b ashik a n j e
/ /
i gi t a b o
i k a r a a mu , n ig i t a b o .
ingwa
r
i n gwa n
u musho f e e r i - -
M fis
umuduga
u m u s h o f e eri n M fis
a
a
u m u duga n
i bi t abo /
M fis
impuuzu
i b i t a b o ni mp uu zu .
[NB The tones heard in Line 3, Col. 2 of the recorded version of t hi s e x e r c i s e a r e /na bashikaange/.]
126
BASIC COURSE
UNIT 7
E xerc i s e
/
2.
<We need a carpenter and a builder.< <We need a builder and a carpenter.>
/
-
u mwuubat s i u mubaaj i
u m u baagi.
e
/
u m u b aaji n
/
uu m w u u b a t s i .
u mwuunye r e umushuumba
-
D ukeney e
u m wuun g e r e n
umu sh u u m b a .
Dukene y
umu s n u u mb a n
/ /
umw u u n g e r e .
/
umupoorz.si umudaandaza
-
v
/
T uroonder
um u p o o r Xs i n
/
umu d a a n d a z a .
T uroonder a u mudaandaza n
um u p o o r X s i .
Urarut a
m weenewaanyu?
O y ar a anduta . a S indamurut a .
U rar u t a
m u s h ik a a w e ?
Oy ar a anduta. a
Sindamur u t a .
U rar u t a
b a sh i k a a w e ? . a.
Oya b a r a a n d u t a Sin d a b a r u t
127
KIRUNDI
a a raandu t a .
Sind amu r u t a .
/
U rarut a
daata;
Oy ar a anduta. a S indamurut a .
Daat
ar ar u t a s o?
ar a tu ru t a.
Ntitumuruta .
Exer c i s e 4 .
Co n co r d wi t h /
i i ns h i /, / ngaahe/, / taanu/.
> Andre ha s
a l ot of book s . <
v e. <
/
A nderey
afis
ibi t a b o v y i insh i .
r
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 7
abavuukanyi
umwiigiisha
U mwiigiisha waa c A fi s e
ba a n g a a h e ? A i is e b at a a n u .
/
amakaraamu
impaapuro
Exerc i s e
5.
The v er b /-ba/ in the sense of >to reside<. A n swer should use the most appropriate place expression.
ab a mu g i sa g a r a ? Ab
muh Xr a .
/
E eg
ab a mu g i s a gara .
129
UNIT 7 U mrovy.
i
KIRUNDI ab a mu g i s a gar a ? ku k i vu k o .
ab a mu g i sa g ar a ?
/
O y aba
Umudaanda z
E eg
/
0
/
ab a mu g i s a gara .
E eg
ab a mu g i s a gara .
Ababaa j i baba mu gis agara? Abeenshi bab i muhXra; abaandi baba r e g i s a gar a . a
Exercise 6. The infinitive /gusuumba/ < t o s u r p a s s > c o r r e s p o n d i n g to English <than>. Immediate indicative affirmative vs. negative. <This machine is heavy.< <Is it heavier than the others?<
< It>s not heavier than the othe r s . <
imashiini
Iy i m a s hiini iraremeereye.
/
g u s uumb i z i i ndi . a
i b iindi?
ib i i n d i .
Uru r u r i m i
r ur a g o o y e
/
-goora
R uragooye gusuum b
iz i i n d i ?
N tirugooye gusuum b
iz i i n d i .
130
BASIC COURSE
UNIT
umuduga - zi i m b a
Uyu muduga uraziimvye. Uraziimvye gusuumb i y iindi? a Ntuziimvye gusuumb i y iindi. 7. I mmediate indicative affirmative vs. negative. T o n e o f n ou n a f t e r /ya/ vs. tone without /ya/ .
> A carpenter gets more money than a b u i l d e r . >
E xerc i s e
>A builder doesn>t get more money than a carpent e r . < >The pay of a builder is not equal to that of a carpenter.> u mubaaj i - umwuubatsi Umwuubatsi n t aroonk a m ahera gusuumb u m ubaaji. a a Amahera y uumwuubatsi n t angana na ay u m ubaaJi. u mwuubats i - u mushofeer i
I
/
a
J
umudaandaza- umubaaji
I
u mwuunger e - -
umupoorXsi
Amahera y umushofeeri n t angana na a r ay u u mwuuba ts i . a Umudaandaz a rar oonk amahera gus uumb umubaag i . a / a/ a / r Umubaagi n t aroonk a m ahera gusuumb u m udaandaza. a a r J Amahera y u umubaa)i n t angana na ay u m u daandaza. a a I / UmupoorXsi araroonk a m ahera gusuumba umwuungere. a / / Umwuungere n t aroonka amahera gusuumba umupoorXsi.
V /
/ / I / /
131
UNIT 7
KIRUNDI
Exercise 8, M e ntal addit;ion and subtraction of two with reference t o v a r i o u s n u mber s . >Andre i s s i x y ear s o ld . <
e i gh t y ear s ol d . <
a
V'
afis
imy a a k afis
i taandatu .
/
M ukuruw
e
V'
e
/
imy a a k
a' u munaan i .
/
Murumunaw a fi s i m y aak i n c e e a
Y ~haan. afi s
i m y a a k ind w i .
Mukuruw a fi s i m y aak i c e enda. e e a Murumunaw a fi s i m y aak it;aanu. e e a Mari a fi s i m y aak i t a anu. e a a Mukuruw a fi s i m y aak i n d w i . e e a
/
M urumunaw
afis
imy a a k
ita t u .
Practice conversat;ion 3 . Do y ou r so n s l i v e h er e ?
Abahuungu b aawe ba b
aha ?
n t i b ab
aha .
Ng oo zi .
iki ?
U mwe n . umu d a a n d a z a . i
Uwuundi 132
v n . um u p o o r z s i.
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT
Arab i i
zi
buho r o bu At a a n gu y e
Ny i n ,
i k i '?
/
/
y our y o u n g er
sib l i n g ' ?
Murumunaaw a fi s i m y a ak e a e ingaahe?
A fis
r r
i c umi n
ind w i .
Does h e l i v e wit h y ou r p ar e n t s ?
A baana n
aba v y e e y i
b aany u ?
/
O y aba a
mu g i s a g ar a .
N uumwuub a t s i .
s tuden t ?
133
UNIT T
KIRUNDI Nshaaka ku b um u b a a ) i ,
a mafaraanga .
Fre e
conver s at i on .
l. A asks B about the number and ages of his children, and about what they want to become. 2. A ( a M u r u n d i) asks B (a European) about his family back in
t h ey d o .
t he s t a t e s : w h e r e t h e y l i v e , a nd w ha t
134
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 8
(1, 2)
a dol e s c e n t , b a c h e l o r
[
1A
i ] Ur a c aa r . um u s o r e ?
~
[
2B
]
No, I<m married ( <I h a v e a
Oya n d a fi s u m u g5re.
w ife . >
)
(pl.)
]
3A M uf i s abaa n a b a a n g a n e a
[- ]
i ki ?
H ow many c h i l d r e n d o y o u have?
[
0B Bab i r i :
~
umuh u u n g u w
]
a
T wo: a f our y e a r ol d b o y a n d a two year old girl.
[~ ~
i imyaak
a
i n e', n
]
a
~ ~
umukoobw w i i m y a ak a a a
[- ]
i bi r i .
[5A Ni vy i i za c aa n e .
]
That>s v e r y n i ce!
[ ~
6C
~
>
" ]
e
Xs y ou r b r o t h er ma r r i ed ?
Mwee n e waanyu a r a f i s
umug5re?
135
UNIT 8
KIRUNDI
7D
O y
ar aca ar ngaahe
r
umu s o r e .
]
No, he>s still a bachelor. how many?
[-8C Am az
- ~
miroongo
(0)
]
How ol d i s he? m ult i p l es o f t en ; l i n e s
im y a a k i n g aahe? e a
f
gD
0
1
Mir o o n g i b i r i . Twenty.
-
[1 0C
- - ~
]
Is your wife>s brother a b achelo r a l s o ' ? (>... a b achelo r a n d h e >)
Mur a mwaaw a r a c a a r e
[ - w - ~-]
u musore n a we ?
[
1 1D Oy a n umu ga b o .
]
No, he>s ( a) [ mar r i e d ] ( man).
V ocabul a r y : >John i s
Num b e r s 1 2 0 o n e y e a r ol d >.
ibiri
136
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 8
ic eenda i cumi
/ / /
icumi n uumwe a
i cumi n i cumi n i c umi n i cumi n i ibiri 12
a a a
i i tatu i i ne
/ J
13
i i t ganu
15 16
icumi n i itaandatu a
/
i cum1 n
/
a a a
0
indwi
/
i cumi n
u m u naani
18 19
20
i cumi n
iceenda
miroong i b iri
1.
Th e
always followed by a word that begins wit;h the concordial prefix /i-/. D epending on speaker and on style of speech, t;he final / o/ c it y m a y b e r e t ; a i n e d (/miroongo ibiri/), or may lose its syllabi(/miroongwibiri/,
with no lengthening of the vowel aft;er
Exerci s e s
9-11. ]
137
UNIT 8 2.
/nuumwe/,
and will usually be written in this book /n and will be written /n a /na / plus /ine/ is ordinarily pronounced / ni i n e a
u u mwe/
/,
iine
/.
j us t ' a s
Note 1
).
The high tone that is found on the second syllable of
t he wo r d
accordance with the principle discussed in the same note in connection with /bashikaanj e
/.
When the initial vowel of the numeral is not a concordial prefix, but is a part of the root itself, then the /a/ of /na /
is elided, and the vowel that carries the ~defe r r e d ~ h i gh t o n e
comes to be the first in the word. One can picture the relationship between the unelided and the elided forms in terms of a process, in four separate stages:
l. /na / + /indwi/
2. / na i ndw i /
p l ace ment o f t o n e ) ~
3. 4.
/ ni i b i r i /
l38
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 8
Note that the vowel of /ni ndwi / is short even though most vowels before a nasal plus a stop or fricative are long. It should be remembered that when a long vowel with high
t one on the se cond mora occurs in other than penultimate position ,
] i n s t ea d o f
[ ~
].
ni i t a t u
i s
[ ~
3.
lowed directly by possessives, with no accompanying noun: Abaana baange n i banini gusuumb a b aawe.
.. t han
t heirs . i
A s one wo ul d
e x p e c t ( Unit
3 , No t e 2 ) , t h e p o s s e s s i v e h a s t h e
baange baawe
biiwe
/
139
UNIT 8
KIRUNDI
Note that in the right hand column all the singular possessives have one tone pattern, and all the plurals have another. [For practice on this point, see Exercise 3.]
4. A
ni
and
si
The el e ment
/ ni/ has appeared in a number of sentences in /Ni/ is used where a third person subject
is followed by a noun or adjective with which it is to be equated i n s ome way : Izina ryaanje ni Yohaani. , '~iy name i s John.
It may also be used where no explicit subject is given: Ni vyiiza. The t o n e I t ss f ine.
o f t hi s par t i cl e i s hi gh i f i t i s not i mm e d i a t e ly
an acute accent placed just before the words / n i / . The negative counterpart of / ni/ is / si/. It behaves t onal l y j us t l i k e /
ni/ .
[For practice with <provisional high tone<, see Exercise 1, and also Exer c i s e s 9 -1 1 . ]
140
B ASIC COURS E
UNIT 8
Exercise 1. P r ovisional high tone on the copulas fni/ and /'si/. >Are your children small?> <They>re no t s mall . > v e ry
muto
Abaana baany u
ni
bat o ?
Si b a t
o c aa n e .
>small >
j
m unin i
[
Si b a n i n i ca a n e .
Abaana baany u
ni b ani ni ?
1 [
ni bar ee b a r e ?
A baana baany u
S i b a r e e b ar e
caane.
Abaana baany u
ni bagu f i ?
S i b a g uf i
c aa n e .
mukuru >old<
Abaana baany u
n i baku r u ?
S i b a k ur u
caane.
A baana baany u
ni
beez a ?
S i b e ez a
caane.
representation of p i tch by
UNIT 8 E xerc i s e 2.
jeewe wewe
Yohaani
/
ab a a n a b a a n j e ? ab a a n a b a a we ?
i
abaana b i i w e ?
Exercise 3. S u bstitution in choice of two slots. >My children are bigger than yours.<
/
Abaana baanje n i banini gusuumb a b iiwe. a Abaana baanje n i bakuru gusuumb a b iiwe. a Abaana baanje n i bato gusuumb a b iiwe.
baawe b areebar e
b ani n i
n i b e e n sh i
g u s u umb a b a a w e .
n i b a r e e b ar e
g u s u umb a b a a w e . a
Exer c i s e
4.
Va l u e s of
t h e n ume r a l s .
[ Directions: Do the ex ercise on the fo llowing page at l e a s t t hree times . F i r s t,, use the sentences for imitation . The
second time, use one sentence as the cue , and give as r e sp onse
the sentences that follow it. T hen practice giving response l42
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 8
sentences in which the numbers are 2 greater or 1 less than the n umber i n t he c u e s e n t e n c e . ]
e
e e
i b i t abo bibiri,
Dufis i b itabo cumi. e Dufis i b itabo cumi na kimwe. e Dufis i b itabo cumi na bibiri. e Dufis i b itabo cumi na bitatu. e Dufis i b itabo cumi na bine. e Dufis i b itabo cumi na bitaanu. e Dufis i b itabo cumi na bitaandatu. e
D ufis D ufi s
12
13
15 16
e e
i b i t a b o c umi n i b i t ab o c umi n
a a
ind w i . u m unaani.
18 19
20
143
UNIT 8
KIRUNDI
I h av e t w o b o o k s .
I have two thin g s .
amakeete
Mfis
Mf is
am a k e e t e a b i r i .
e amakeete atatu .
i mbaan g a a n g w e i ki i nga
M fis
i m b a a n g a angwe zitatu .
impuuzu
Mfi s
i mashi i n i
M fis Mfi s
e e e
e
z i n e.
/
M fi s M fi s
imiduga amapikipiki
M fis
i m i dug
ind w i .
i bi i n t u
e e e
e e e
i b i i n t in d w i . u a m a keet
in d w i .
M fis
i m b a a n g a ang w i n d w i . e u
Mfis a bahuung
Mfis M fis
i n dwi.
I h av e s e v e n s o n s .
I h a v e t e n s on s .
I have ten bi cy cl es .
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 8
I h av e t e n c a rs . I h av e t e n t ea c h e r s .
I have ten letters .
[ NB
(7, 8 ) ] .
/na/.
>There are ten children in the school.> <There are five tall [ones] and five short [ o n e s ]. < a baan
/
i cum i
i c umi mw lishuure.
u m u naani mw iishuure.
/ / /
ibitab umunaani
0
Hari ibitab
umunaani mw iishuure.
UNIT 8
E xerc i s e 7.
KIRUNDI Hi gh t one o n / si/. C oncord from one sentence to a noth e r . >Our children are not numerous.> >We have o nl y t w o .> been s h i .
abaana
Abaana baac u
si
Abahuungu b a ac u
si
been s h i .
Mfise babiri gusa. impaapuro Impaapuro zaacu si nyiinshi. Dufise zibiri gusa. amakaraamu
/ /
i bi t abo
i bi t a b o
E xerci s e
8.
[ The t u t o r
s hould give the numbers to be a d d ed, and th e student should give the en tire sentence including
the sum. For home study, the student may use the right-hand column as cues. ] fSome speakers prefer
/kwoongeeza / to /kwoongereza/.]
I cumi kwoongere z
a
i c umi
n i m i r o on g
ib i r i .
1 0+ 10
= 20
ni
20 + 10 30
146
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 8
ni
30+ 10 40
miroon g
Miroong
0
i ne .
/
i n e k w o o n g e re z
0
i c umi
ni
40+ 10 :
50
m iroong M iroong
/
i t aanu.
r
i n e k w o o n g e r eza miroon g
/
ibiri
40+ 20 :
60
ni miroong i t aandatu.
0
50+ 2 0
70
ni miroong i n dwi.
0
/
/ /
n i.
4 o+ 40 = 8 o
miroong u m unaani
0
6 0+ 30 =
90
itatu ni miroong
0
i c eenda.
0
70+ 30 :
100
n. i iguana.
[NB The instructor may prefer to use /guteerana na / in place of /kwoonger eza / i n E x e r c i s e s 8- 1 1 . j
E xercise 9 .
of ten.
/ /
n i icumi.
/
5+5
= 10
1 5+ 5 =
20
ibiri.
147
UNIT 8
KIRUNDI
2 5+5 =
30
i t a tu .
65+ 5 70
g ataanu
0
n i m i r o on g
!
in d w i .
85+ 5 90
gataanu n i miroong
/
0
/
i c eenda. 9 5+ 5 = 100
g ataan u
n i j .~ a n a 1 6+ 4 2 0
26+ 4 3o
kane ni miroong
0
i t a tu .
36+ 4 4o
k ane ni miroong
0
J
ine.
56+ 4 6o
kane ni miroong
i t aandatu.
Exercise 10 .
A d d i t i o n of m i s cellaneous number s
l e ss t h an 10 0 .
2 3+ 7
30
i ndwi Miroong
0
n i m i r o on g
/
it a t u .
i n e n a g a t a anu kw oongereza i n d wi
0
45+ 7
= 52
n i miroong
i t a anu na kabiri.
148
BASIC C O U R SE
U NIT
69+ 6 75
8 3+ 4
= 87
kane ni miroong u m unaani n i n dwi. 0 a Cumi n i c e enda kwoongereza gataandat;u a ni miroong i b iri na gataanu.
0
/
1 9+ 6 25
9 1+ 4
= 95
kane ni miroong
/ /
/
i c eenda na gataanu.
/
16+ 9
= 25
18+ 8 26
73+ 8
= 81
8+ 3 11
n a r i m we .
/
1 8+ 3 2 1
m iroong
/
i b iri na rimwe.
/
1 8+ 4 2 2
m iroong
i b iri na kabiri.
149
UNZT 8
/
KXRUNDI
/
18+ 5
= 23
ni
1 9+ 5 2 4
m iroong
/
0
/
i b iri na kane.
/
i n dwi
ni
1 9+ 7 2 6
Miroong i b iri n
0
/
i c e enda kwoongereza
/
29+ 7 36
69+ 7 76
0
/
i n dwi na gataandatu.
/
Miroong i c eenda n
0
i c eenda kwoongerez a a
99+ 7 106
indwi n
i guana na gataandatu.
Practice conversation.
/
Y ohaan.
i
afi s
abaa n a
baangaahe'?
A fise bataandatu .
Arabaf i s e
k u u n s uumba. e
ifis e
I mfura yiiw
i myaak
1$0
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 8
Y ou as k t h e a g e o f h is y o u n g e s t .
A maz u mwaak u m w e . e a
F ree c o n v e r s a t i o n . Talk about the composition of your own family, and of a number of other real-life families.
151
UNIT 9
KIRUNDI UNIT 9
[- w
~
/
abaana baangaahe?
]
to give birth to
-vyaara (-vyaaye)
2B
] ]
T hey ha v e (finished bearing ) five: three girls and two boys.
Bama z e k u v y a a r a b a t a a n u ~
abiigeme batatu n
-
-]
. when?
abahuungu b a b i r i r yaa r i ?
/
]
3A B u u b a t s e r y a a r i '? When did they get mar r I ed'?
]
4B Hahe z i m y a aka cumi e n i i t aan u .
It
]
-]
H ow ol d a r e t he y ' ? (>How many y ears d o t h e y h a v e ? < ) m y fa t h e r
5A
Bafis
imya a k
ing a a h e ?
daaw
(1) ~ ]
[
6B Daaw
am a z i my a a k a e e
i ne.
My father is 40.
[
mir o o n g
0
152
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 9
imfura
(9)
n
eldest; of a set of s ib l i n g s
[7A
- ~
[ ~ -
I mf ur a y aa n y u
]
]
n.
i
umuhuungu c a a nk e
umukoobwa?
]
daught er , gi r l
umwiigeme (1, 2)
8A
umwi i g e me.
[She] is a girl.
9C
Nama k i ' ?
H ow are y o u ?
]
1 0D Naa m e e za .
Fine .
[
11C I m u h ir a n a h o naameeza? And h o w are things at .home'? t ;o be v i g o r o u s , r ob u s t
-komera ( - k omeye
]
1 2D Bo o s e b ar a k o m e y e . E veryone is in good h e a l th .
-]
11C I m u h ira barakomeye?
/ /
-oroher wa
(-orohewe) 153
UNIT 9
KIRUNDI
[
12 D I m u hi r a bar o o r o h e we .
They~re
f i ne (at home).
< What ( I w h o < ) is the name of the eldest child in your family'?< i mfur a u muherer e z i so nyoko shoobuj a umugeenzi
/
I zin a
/
ry
a a
Izina ry
/
<What is the oldest child in your family called' ?> i mfur a u muherer e z i
/
so
nyoko
S o yiitwa ng i k i ?
0
N yoko yiitwa ng i k i ?
0
0
0
i ki ? i ki ?
[ NB
u sed i n
is pro-
/ s h e ebuga / >h i s ,
lg4
h e r bos s > .
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 9
l.
A n ote on partici i.al verb forms, immediate, affirmative. The verb Porms spelled ~wii a in the following two senten-
H ow many ho ur s
d o yo u
a day
s t u dy ?
i g i h e k i i n ga n
i ki
w ii g
i ki r u u n d i ?
T he ver b
INDICATIVE. P a rticipial counterparts exist for most indicative forms, except that in most tenses there is no distinction between conjunct and disjunct participi.als. The distinction between perfective and imperfective aspects is found in participial as well as indicative forms. The immediate participial form has high tone on the first vowel after the first consonant of the word. The remaining tones are low, both for high verbs and for low verbs. The situations in which one uses a participial and not the corresponding indicative are not susceptible to succinct summation. They should therefore be learned one at a time. For the present, practice with this form will be confined to its use in questions and statements about the duration of various activities. Exerc i s e s 1-6. ]
[See
Exercise 1. F o rmation of participials with subject prefix consist ing of consonant plus vow el . pref i x . V e r b s w ith and w i th out an o b j e c t
s p e n t , [ y o u] s t ud y i n g K i r u n d i ? > a
ik i r u u n d i ?
i g i h e k i i nga n
i k i mw iig
M umaz
i g i h e k i i n ga n
i k i m u ciiga?
gusoma
Mumaz
i g i h e k i i n ga n
i k i m u som
i c o g i t a bo '?
KIRUNDI
Muxmz i g ihe kiingan ikf mugisoma? e a kumesuura Numaz i g ihe kiingan iki mumesuur i z o mpuuzu? e a a
N umaz
i g i h e k i i nga n
a a
i k i m u z i m e suura ?
k wii g a
B amaz
i g i h e k i n ini bii g i k i r u u n d i ?
i g i h e k i n ini baso m
i c o gitabo?
Bamaz i g ihe kinini bagisoma? e kume s uura Bamaz i g ihe kinini bamesuur i zo mpuuzu? e a Bamaz i g ihe kinini bazimesuura? e
kwiiga
Tumaz am asah a b iri twiiga ikiruundi? e a Yohaani amaz a m asah a t atu yiig i k i r u u n d i ? e a a
Exercise 2a. Rormation of participials with subject prefix consisting of a vowel. U e rbs with and without an object; prefix. < How long d i d y o u ( sg.) K ir u n d i ? >
s p e nd , { y o u ) s t u d y i n g
s t u d y i n g i t ?<
i g i h e k i i n ga n i k . w i i g i k i r u u n d i ? a i a
Umaz i g ihe kiingan ik > uciiga? e a gusoma Umaz i g ihe kiingan ik i usom a i c o gitabo? e a Umaz i g ihe kiingan i k i e a
/
u g i s o ma?
I
kumesuura
i g i h e k i i n gan
i ki
u z i me s u u r a ?
156
BASIC CO U R SE
UNIT 9
kuba
Exer c i s e 2 b . k wi i g a
u b a h ano? u h aba.
a m a sah
ata t u y i i g
ik i r u u n d i .
kumes uura
[clothes] for
Have you (pl.) been washing [clothes] f or a n h o u r ? Have you (sg.) been washing [clothes] f or a n h o u r ?
B amaz
i s a h a b a m esuur a .
T hey hav e b e e n w a s h i n g [ cl o t h e s ]
f o r a n h ou r .
A maz i sK h a a m esuur a . e
157
UNIT 9
KIRUNDI
Exercise 4. P articipial forms, immediate affirmative, without object prefix. >I~ve finished a year studying Kirundi.< j eewe
/ / /
{I)
~ {You) s t u d y i n g K ir u n d i ? >
only
M az
u m w a aka niig
i .k i r u u n d i .
i coonger e z a
tweebwe
Mwiig i coongereza
k waandik a
we
Y ii g a
k waandik a g u s a ?
kugeendeesh a umuduga
Yii g a
k u g e e n d eesh
bo
u muduga
iri i n gar a
158
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 9
Exercise 5. P a rticipial forms, immediate affirmative, with and without object prefix. < I>ve s p en t a w e e k (I) studying Kirundi.> a week s t udying i t . < a
i ki r u u n d i .
>Itive s p en t
M az
i y i i nga niig
Maz i yiinga ndaciiga. e Tumaz i y iinga twiig i k iruundi. e a Tumaz iyiinga tuciiga. e Amaz u kweezi yiig i k iruundi. e a
/
/
Umaz i g ihe kiingan ik i wiig i k iruundi? e a a Umaz i g ihe kiingan iki uciiga? e a Umaz i g ihe kiingan ik i usom i z i mpaapuro'? e a a Umaz i g ihe kiingan iki uzisoma'? e a
/
Amaz i sK h a s o m i z i mpaapuro. e a a
/
a m a sah
abi r i t u z i som a .
159
UNIT 9
KIRUNDI
i sh u u r i
e e e
a a
ibi r i b u u b at s
i y o shuQri.
ibi r i n d a m u b oony e . ab i r i
avyaay
/
u m w aana .
H ahez
am eez
ab i r i t u d u u z e .
Practice conversation 1
W here d o y our
Abavyeeyi
b a a w e b a b Khe?
parent s
l i ve? B ab a i Buj uu m b u r a .
What kind of
w ork d o e s y our f a t h e r
do?
akor
ak a zi
ny a b a k i ?
N. umudaandaza.
i How l o n g h a s he been d oin g t h a t w ork ? Amaz e i g i h e k i i ngan a a k or
i ki
ak o k az i ?
I myaak
itatu.
160
BASIC C O U R S E
UNIT 9
( pl. ) h a v e ?
B at a t u . How ol d i s t he e l de s t '? I mfur
a
/
ifis
imy a a k
i ngaahe ? Ai'i s e i c e en d a .
I s [ t he e lde st ] a b oy o r a g irl ?
N . u mu h u u ng u i
/
ca a n k e
um u k o o b w a ?
N. umukoobwa.
i
Practice conversation 3.
Where d o e s sh e go t o s c h oo l ?
Yiig@he?
/
Yiiga kwiishuur
rya
What g r a d e i s she i n ? A ri mu mwaaka
/
>Saint Michel>.
wa kaangaahe?
A ri Does s h e l i ke t o s t u dy ? Araku u n d a
/
mu wakane.
kwi i ga ?
E eg
ar a b i ku un d a .
161
U NlT 1 0
KIRUNDI
UNIT 10 REVIEW Exercise 1. S u bject prefixes for personal sub)ects. < How are y o u ? <
U rakomey e ?
Exercise 2. A ffirmative vs. negative indicative. < Are you i n go o d h e a l t h ? < Urakomeye?
A rakomey e ?
>I>m not
wel l , <
Sinkomeye.
N takomey e .
Murakomeye? Barakomeye?
M urar o o n s
Bararo on s
162
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 10
Uraroons
A raroon s
e e
e e
u r u p a apuro?
ur up a a p u r o ? u r up a a p u r o ? ur up a a p u r o ?
M uraroon s B arar o on s
Exercise 0.
Exercise 5a. O b ject prefix, affirmative, high verb. >Did yo u i bi t a b o i gi t a b o u rupaapur o umusozi
i mi s o z i
/
se e my b o oks? >
Uraboony i b itabo vyaanje? e U raboony U raboony U raboony Uraboony Uraboony Uraboony U raboony Uraboony
/
e e e e e
e e
i gi t abo c a a n g e ?
ur up a a p ur o r w a a n g e ? N daru b o o n y e .
/
umuduga
i mi d u g a
umugeenzi abageenzi
N dayiboony e .
N dazi b o o n y e .
N dabi k e n e y e . N dagi k e n e y e .
i gi t a b o umuduga ik a r a amu
/
/
iraangi
U rakeney
i r aan g i r y aa n j e ?
[After both halves of Exercise 5 have been completed separately, they should be combined. ]
Exercise 6. O b ject prefix Classes 11 and 9, negative verbs. > Have you r e c e i v e d p a p e r ? < U raroon s
Arar o o n s Murar o o n s B ara r o o n s
e
e
ur up a a p u r o ?
u r u p a ap u r o ?
e e
u r u p a ap u r o ? u r u p a ap u r o ?
U raroon s
Arar o o n s Murar o o n s
e e
i ngw a ?
i n gwa ? i n gwa ?
Ntituyiroonse . Nti b a y i r o o n s e .
B ara r o o n s
i n g wa ?
164
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 10
E xerc i s e
'7 .
i bi t ab o
A keney
e
e e
i b i t a b o b i i ngaahe ?
amakaraamu
a baan t u abashuumba
A keney
A kene y A kene y
e e
e
ab a s h u u mb a b a a n g a a h e ?
/ / /
A keneye b a n e .
A keney e Akeney e bane. z i ne .
/
a batee t s i
i mas h i i n i
A keney
A keney
aba t e e t s i ba a n g a a h e ?
/ /
/
i m a s h i in i ziingaahe ?
amapikipiki
i bi i nt; u
Akeney Akeney
e e
an e . bi n e .
zi ne.
/
imbaangaangwe
Akeney e
Exercise 8. N e gative vs. affirmat;ive with no object prefix. >We don>t have three children.< abaana
barumuna a bahuun g u
/
abakoobwa
U NIT l O
KIRUNDI
Exercise 9. A f firmative vs. negative with object prefixes. <Are your siblings older t han y o u ? > k urut a gufasha
kubona
/
gutegeer a k uroonder a
l i k e t h i s boo k ? <
< No, I O ya
d o n >t ( like
i t ).<
Ntukuund ik i gitabo? a
Ntuk u un d
/
s i n d a gi k uunda.
a e
i zi
mpu u zu ?
/
O ya s i nd a z i k u u n d a .
/
N tumesuuy
i zi mpu u z u ?
O ya
s i n d a z i m esuuy e .
Oya sindabimesuuye. O ya O ya
O ya
s i n d a bi k eneye. s i n d ar i keneye.
s i n d a r y a an dit s e .
l66
B ASIC C O U R S E
UNIT 10
Exercise 11. V erb vs. singular agentive noun vs. plural a gent i v e n o u n . I Some peopl e
> They a r e
cook. <
ca l l e d co ok s . <
a b a t eetsi.
u m u t e e t s i m w i iza ?
b a r abaaza.
B iitw
a b abaaji.
/ /
A baandi
baracura.
kugeendeesha
U raaz
/
u m u s h o f e eri mwii za ?
gukora
Boose
barakor a .
/
B iitw
a b akozi.
/ /
U raaz
u m u k ozi mwiiza?
1b
UNIT 10
KIRUNDI
Exercise 12. R eply in the negative, first using a noun object, and then using an object; prefix. <Are these languages very difficult?> ( >Do t h e s e have a great difference?< ) >They aren't very different.> ( <They d o great difference.> ) < They ar e n > t . 3 ( <They d o n< t
I zi ndimi zifi s
l a n g uages
not h a v e a
have i t . 3)
it a a n d u k a aniro rinini ?
N tibaruta Yohaani .
N ti b a t e e k a .
/
Uraroonder u m uteetsi? a
S indoonder
u m u t eetsi.
S indamur o o n d e r a .
168
B ASIC C O U R SE
U NIT 1 0
S hoobug
av u g ur ur i m i r wa a c u ? a
/
N ta r u v u g a .
/ /
/
S hoobuJ' aruum v
ur u r i m i r w a a c u ?
/
/
N tiyuumv
u r u r i m i r w a a cu .
/
Ntarwuumva.
Exercise 13. P r actice with concords. Barafis i m baangaangwe? e Eego ba r a z i f i se. D o the y h a v e b i c y c l e s? Y es, t h e y h a v e (them). D o the y N o, t h e y h av e many? have f e w .
nke.
zi i ngaa h e ?
Z it a an u g u s a . Ni n i n i
Z imwe
i ni ni ?
n i n i n i , i.ziindi n i n t o .
Ndaken ey e B arafis
r u mwe r ut o . i b itabo?
/
Eego b a r a b i Baf i s e
f i se.
Y es, t h e y h a v e (them).
D o they No, the y hav e many ? h a v e f ew .
v y i i n sh i ?
O ya bafise bik e .
169
UNIT 10
N i bi i ngaa h e ?
KIRUNDI
How many ar e F if t e e n .
A re
[ t he r e ] ?
Cumi na bitaanu.
Ni v y i i za ?
t h e y g oo d ?
S ome are g o o d , o t h e r s a re no t v e r y go o d .
i v y i iza bike.
Some are l a r g e , ot h e r s a re s ma l l .
They h a v e a f ew l ar g e
B afise manini ma k e .
ones.
N dakeneye rimwe rinini . I n e e d o n e l a r g e on e .
K ir u nd i 170
n o u ns.]
BASIC COURSE
UNIT 10
/.
m y gran d f a t h e r a n d my grandmother
/
n y o gokuru
/ /
d aata w a a cu
/
n yogokur u n a
d a at a waacu
/
u mugore waa n j e
d aata w a ac u n waange
um u g o r e
maama
my wife and my mother my mother and my sibling of the same sex my sibling of the s ame sex a n d my
mweenewaacu
maama na mweenewaacu
mushikaange
m weenewaacu na mu s h i k a a n g e
sist er man)
muramwaange
/
(I being
mushikaange na muramwaange
bank
t he b an k a nd t h e marke t the market and th e
i bi t a r o
ingo
umurimyi
farmer
171
UNIT 10 umudaanda za
KIRUNDI
/ /
umurimyi n u m udaandaza a
a f r i end
Ki r u n d i
and Ki n y a r w anda are v e r y d i f f er ent . You al s o a sk whet h e r L ingal a a n d Swahili are the same.
Iriingara n i g iswaahXri
ni bi mwe?
Simbiizi. S i inz i ri i n g a r a .
Practice conversation 2.
A sk h o w m a n y Abavye ey i b a a w e b af i s e chi l d r e n y ou r f ri e n d~s par ent s abaana baangaahe? h ave , a n d whethe r t he o the r ch i l dr en a r e o l d er t h a n he is .
/ /
B afi s e 172
bane.
BASIC COURSE
UNIT 10
Practice conversation 3. A sk a f r i e n d w h a t Umuuntu a t eeka yiitwa a per so n wh o d o e s ng i k i ? cookin g i s 0 c al l e d , a n d w hether h e k n o w s a good cook. Yii t w
/
um u t e e t s i .
Practice conversation 4. You ask a f r i en d w hat l a n g u a g e h is e m p l o y e r speaks . Af t er h e rep l i e s, y ou as k w h e t h e r h is e m p l o y e r d oesn>t s p e a k Rundi. Shoobuga avu g ruuhe?
ur ur i m
I k i ruundi?
173
UNIT 10
aracuumva.
P ractice conversation 5 .
You ask
where
a f r i end
hi s
ablhe?
f at he r w o r k s , a nd t h e n w h a t h e does .
Aba mu r u g o r wi i we ,
/
Akor
i ki ? A rari m a .
U mugeenzi w aa w
i ki ?
ak o r
c ity . N
Aba mu g i s a g a r a ?
/
u m udaandaza .
Keg a b
0
i G i t ega.
B ASIC CO U R SE
U NIT
11
UNIT 11
BASIC DIALOGUE
g a nt u u form o f ad d r e s s u s e d
when name doe sntt com e r eadily to tip of t o n gu e
lA 2B
(-zimuruye ( -zimi y e )
r evers e
of
<t o l o s e>
to get lost (persons) Show me the way. I >m lost. to direct oneself toward W here ar e you goi ng?
3A
- ror a ( - r o y e )
4B Ur or a hee h e ? i mi s i y o o n i 5A
(4, 4)
Ndo r a kumisiyooni.
-komeza (-komege)
-t aambuka 6B
(-taambutse
t o step
o v e r , pas s
haanyuma
- gir a
7A
( - g i z e)
r
Haany u ma n g i r e e n t e g - shi k a
( -shi t s e
)
You'l l
t o ar r i ve b e t h er e . ( >You wi l l
8B
Uz oob
ushi t s 5h o .
b e y o u - h a v i n g - a r r i v ed t h e r e . >
175
U NIT 1 1
KIRUND1
9A
Ur ak o z e c a a n e . N a g a saaga. Gee nd a am a h o r o f
Thanks a
l ot j
1 0B
Ee .
1 1C
Ndo r a k u m i s i yooni .
I <m g o i n g
t o t h e mi s si o n .
1 2D
I m i s iyoon i r X he ? u buseruk o
Where is the mission? [to t h e ] eas t, It>s east of the police station.
(14)
1 $C
I r i mu bus e r u k o b w a a Icommissariat>.
1 4D
(14)
1 5C
Bi r i m u b u r e e n g er o b w a
is5ko.
uruhaande ( 11, 1 0 ) i poos i t a 1 6C Bi r s ide , part
(9, 6)
a
i r uhaan d e y
Iarondissementa?
ubumanuko i bi t a r o
(14)
[ to t h e ] s o u t h
h osp i t a l
(8, 8)
176
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 11
Ni mu bumanuko bw i b itaro . a
t h e b a n k ? < <It i s i r Xh e ?
I ri
w e s t of t he r oad w ay . > a
I baank
mu bur ee nger o bw
i bar a b a r a .
/
imisiyooni
Imisiyoon i r Xhe?
Iri
m u b u r e e n g er o b w a i bar a b a r a .
ihoot;eer i
( 9, 6 )
I hoo t ; e e r . i r Xh e ?
Iri
m u b u r e e n g er o b w a i bar a b a r a .
a mahooteer i
A mahooteer i
ar c h e ?
A ri m u b u r e e n g er o b w a i bar a b a r a .
ibi t;aro
Ibitaro birXhe?
B ir i
/
m u b u r e e n g er o b w
i bar a b a r a .
inzu y
i i s aansi
Ku nz u
r.i s a a n s i
g asol i n e s ta t i o n
niche?
~ commissaire >
K u nzu y a
< commissaire ~
p olice c h i e f
niche?
m usit a a n t;eer i
(la)
admi n i s t r a t or
pl. baamusit;aanteeri
niche?
iki baanza
(7, 8)
square
177
U NIT l l
a masaangaanzir a { 6 ) uruseengero
i s eenger o
( 11, 1 0 ) o r 9, 1 0)
U ruseenger o r u r X h e ?
(5
l.
<Continue on [in the direction]. > > Go well . > > Show me th e w ay . >
In the imperative, high and low verbs alike have low tone. The imperative forms are suitable for requests between equals. T hey are also used for perfunctory commands and requests such as the ones cited above. For real requests, however, greater courtesy calls for the use of the negative conditional. form has already been met: Ntiwoosub i r Kmwo? >Please r e p e a t . > ( 3Wouldn>t you One such
repeat?<
1, 6. ]
2.
l o c a tions.
178
B ASIC C O U R SE
U NIT 1 1
p re f i x .
I f t h e subj e c t i s a
3.
Th e ne ative im erative. The dialogues for this unit; contain no examples of the
negative counterparts of imperative forms. S uch forms are: IDon<t ( you s g . ) r et u r n h e re . >
prefix begins wit;h a consonant; (e. g. / nt;imugaruke/) and when it d oes no t (/e. g. / ntuugaruke/). [For practice, see Exercises
3-5.]
Exercise l . R e q u e s ts , u s ing eit;her the imperat;ive or t;he negat;ive c onditional forms . I Begi n t o wo r k . >
r
> Please b e gi n
t o work. >
g utaangur a
k ugeen d a
T aangura g u k o r a .
Geenda k w i i ga .
N tiwoot;aangur a g u k o r a ?
Ntiwoogeenda kwiiga?
kugaruk a
Garuk
ubu .
Ntiwoogaru k
ubu?
179
UNIT 11 g usubi i r a
/
KIRUNDI S ubii r a J a kw
Nfash a
k uvuga. i sok o .
k u r i m a.
kubla
gufasha
k ur o o n d e r a
R oonder
i gi t abo c a a n g e .
i g itabo
caanj e Z
m issi o n ? >
r
/
imisiyooni
k u mi s ' y oo n i
/
i s ok o . a i sok o .
i bi t a r o
ku b i t a r o a mahoot e e r i k u ma h o o t e e r i
/ / / /
i r uh a a n d e y i r uh a a n d e y a
i s ok o . a i s5k o .
i s ok o .
A mahoo teer .
i
/
a rc h e ?
/
i r uh a a n d e y
i r uhaa nde y
K u mahooteeri nihe ?
a a
musitaanteeri
K u nzu y a
t e er i
/
musi t a a n-
i r uh a a n d e y
i s 5k o .
n i h e '? k i r Xh e ? Kir i i r u h a an d e y a i s ok o .
iki baanza
I ki b aanza
Exercise 3. I n finitive vs. negative imperative (p1.). aWe want to return here. <
Dushaak a ku g ar uk a hano .
>Don<t r e t u r n
Nti m u g a r u k e e
h e re . <
h an o .
Ntimug i muhXra.
18O
B ASIC CO U R SE
UNIT1 1
k i b aanza. gukora.
/
Ntimugeenda ku kibaanza.
/
Ntimutaangure gukora.
N timusubire kuvuga . N timutaambuk Ntimwiige.
k uvuga.
8
i bar a b a r a .
i b a rabara.
Exercise 4. I n finitive vs. negative imperative <I want to begin to work.> N shaaka g u t a a n g ur a N shaaka k u g e enda k u N shaaka ku g gukora. k i b aanza. > Don<t b e gi n
(sg. ) .
t o w o rk . > gukora. k i b aanza.
i muh X r a . hano.
/
i muhX r a .
N tuugaruk e h a n o . N tuusubi r e
/
k uvuga. a i bar a b a r a .
k uvuga.
<Don st [you ( s g . ) ] s t u dy f r
Ntiwiige,
N tuusub i r e
/
kuvuga. hano.
/
N tuugar uk e
N tuuj
i muhXra. ku k i baanz a .
i muhfra.
N tuu g e e n d e
N timugeende ku kibaanza .
181
KraUNDI
Ntimutaambuk i b arabara. e Ntimutaangure gukora.
E xercise 6 .
h a v e a r r i v ed
co n t i nu e
t h e mi s s i o n ,
uk o meze.
/
t he b a n k ,
When you (sg.) h av e p a ssed the hotels, continue on. When you (pl. ) h a v e p a s sed t he h o t e l s , con t i n u e o n . When you (pl. ) h av e p a ssed / crossed t h e s t r ee t , cont inue on.
Mutaambuts
ib a rabara mukomeze.
Ataambuts
ib a rabar a k o meze. a e
W hen he ha s p a s s e d /crossed
the street, he should
c onti n u e
Ataambuts ibi t a r o a kom e z e . e
on.
W hen he ha s p a s s e d
the hospital, he should
c onti n u e
D utaambut s i b i t a r o du k om e z e .
on.
BASIC C O U R S E
UNIT 11
Dushitse kw
ii h o o t eeri d ukomeze.
W hen we hav e a r r i v e d a t ; t he c h u r c h , w e a r e t o c onti n u e o n . Dushitse kuu nzu y a is a ansi dukomeze. W hen we hav e a r r i v e d a t the gasoline stat;ion, we a re t o c o n t i n u e o n .
Exercise 7. V o wel length wit;h locat;ive vs. vowel length with p ossess i v e . <I<m going to the b ank. > ibaanki N dora ku u b a a n k i . k w ii baanki .
i hoot e e r i Ndora k u u h o o t e er i . kw iihooteeri. a mahoot e e r i
/ /
i baa n k i .
I nzu yaac
iri mu
b umanuko bw
ii h o o t e e r i .
N dora
k u m a h o ot;eeri . .
i nzu y a a n y u
N dora ku u n z u yaanyu.
183
UNIT 11 i bi t a r o Ndora k u
i bir o y aan j e
Ndora k u
b i r o ya a n j e.
I nzu y aac
i ri bw
mu i bi r o
bumanuko
N dora k u
k i b a anza.
i s eenger o
N dora k w i i s e e n g e r o .
i s ee n g e r o .
uruseenger o
N dora k u
r u s e engero.
ur u s e e n g e r o .
i poos i t a
Ndora ku u
poosi t a .
ii p o o s i t a .
N babari r a .
P l e a s e Naa z i m i y e . Ntiwoonzimurura?
I >m lost . o ut .
straighten me
U ror a heehe?
/ /
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 11
T aambuk
ama b a r a b a r
a tat'u.
Then w h a t I do? do
Haanyuma ng i r e e
n t e?
us h X t s 5 h o .
a g a saaga. E e. G e e n d am a h o r o . a
/
185
UNIT 12
KIRUNDI UNIT 12
B uj u u mb u r a . 2A Nd o o n d er
u wo om f a s h a .
to do
how?
gute?
to be accustomed to
-menyeera
(-menyereye
4A Si ndaa m enyee r i a Bu j uumbura. 5B 6A Uk en e y i k i e noon e ?
)
I don > tknow Usumbura ye t.
T hen what
do you need?
Nk en e y i b i i ntu e v yi i n s h i .
7B
( - t ab a a y e )
/
( -eret s e )
(9, 10)
8A
Nt abaa r a , u n y e r e k e
inzir
/
ij a ku
/
mahoot e e r i
186
B ASIC C O U R S E
UNIT 12
9B
-shoboka (-shobotse
1 0A Vu b a , b i sh o b o t s e .
- fat a
11B
( - f as h e )
Take a
t o ta ke , t ax i . t;o t u r n ,
Fata i t;agisi.
- ca ( - c i i y e ) -mara ( - maze
i
12B
cu t ,
b u r y o o r : i bur y o a
to the right; When you get to the big avenue, go t;o the right;.
Um az e g u s h i k i ir
ibarabara rinini, uc e i
/
bur y o .
-reengaana
- h i i n d u ki r a
(-reengaanye)
to pass to turn
( -h i i n d u k i y e
-i b u b a amfu e
/
)
to t;he left
13B
Ur en g a a n y i nzu
zitaandatu, uhiindukirir i b u b aamfu .
/
W hen you h a v e
e
p a ssed by s i x
-ba ( - b aaye)
1 4B I b a an k b ury o i z o ob a i r b waawe.
to
be be on y our
The b a n k w i l l ri g h t ;
-saanga (-saanze)
to f ind, wat;ch
187
UNIT 12
KIRUNDI
1. 2.
k u r adi o Ho t e l Ta n g a n i k a
5. 4.
k u k i v uk o Sa v on n e r i e
3. 6.
i bi t ar o
7. 8.
9.
k u k i y ag a Paguidas
Pl a t a r u n d i
Luv i nc o
[A map of a p art
188
B ASIC C O U R S E
U NIT1 2
Su plementar d i alo ues. In order to acquaint the student with a wide range of possible replies to his requ ests for street directions, this Unit c ontains a larger number of supplementary dialogues than th e preceding Units, but has no s eparate section for Supplementary V ocab u l a r y .
- kur i k i r a ( -kur i k i y e
-gana ( - g anye
u buraar u u k o
(10)
Utaambutse
r o r y a', u c ubon a a
i nzu y a a n d i t s e k o >Radio<.
kur i
i b u b aamfu
r
Ni k u r i
i u r u r u h a an d e r w
bu b aamfu .
Point X to Point, 2
/
N tiwoonyerek Tangani k
a h o H o teeri
ir k?
189
UNIT 12 haakury a Ni iy
0
KIRUNDI on th e a o t h e r s i de
ub o n a h a a k u r y a y
It<s that one [that] you can see on the other side of the
s tre e t . door The e n t r side. an c e i s on t h e o t h er
k u r uun d i
U rorl h e ? Ndora k u
Ni a a h a
W here ar e b i t ar o .
r
n y e n e.
z o hi i r y a .
Point X to Point 6
Napa kur i
/
<L u v i n c o < a r i k o
but
n aazimi y e .
N ti w o o h a a n y e r e k a ? W ould you please show it to m e ? t owar d
amarora 190
B ASIC C O U R S E
UNIT 12
Point X to Point 5
Twaaga ku
ki vuk
0
ar Xk o
musca
m uc
i b u b aamfu.
- hera ( - h e z e )
oose Niyo
/ / / /
to al l
end
nz
i h er a z oo s
b ubaamf u .
l.
objects may be used as a modifier of a substantive. In Europ ean languages, this is done by us ing a sp e cial re lative pro n oun at the beginning of the clau se . K i r u n d i is q u ite di f f erent :
191
i yi
nzi r
i j a ku mi si y o o n i . . .
The words /ija/ and /zihera/ in these examples are RELATIVE verb forms, in contrast to /ija/ and /zihera/, which are indicative, and also in contrast to / zi h er a / which is participial. (The forms with the stem /-ja/ are parts of a defective paradigm In general, relative forms of the immediate tense have
h igh tone on the po s tradical syllable . T h i s i s th e s am e to n a l
).
pattern that was found on the imm ediate negative indicative forms
whic h
ha s no
postradical syllable, has high tone on the stem itself. Relative forms are used when a verb is used as a modifier of a substantive. R elative verbs have no separate disjunct forms, [For practice with relative forms of verbs, see Exercises 1-5 and
7-8. ]
2.
Rel a t i v e
r o n ou n s .
T he dialogue for this unit contains the fo llowing expr es s ions : ...aho H oteeri T. iri .
Ni i
ubona . . . 192
B ASIC C O U R S E
UNIT 12
cf.
Ni ~i
u bona . . .
The relative clauses in these examples do not modify nouns which are present in these sentences. In place of the nouns, and
indicating the classes of the nouns, are the forms wh ich have been underlined . T h e y w i l l be c a l led RELATIVE PRONOUNS The relative pronoun for ea ch
( Unit
3 , No t e 2
),
Exercise 1. R e lative forms of some familiar verbs. < A person wh o guteeka gucura kubaaza kuri ma kuvoma
g ut e e k a k wi i g a
a c u r a y i it w
u m u cuzi.
Umuunt a b aaza yiitw u m ubaaJi. u a Umuunt a r ima yiitw u m urimyi. u a Umuunt a voma yiit w umuvomyi. u a
A baant u A baant u b ateeka biitw
r
a b a t eetsi.
kugeendeesha
k waand i k i i s h a
i m a s h i in i biitw
a bakaraa n i .
193
UNIT 12
KIRUNDI
( >It
kuvuga
k waand i k a
/
N iind
ik i r u u n d i ?
Who sp e a k s W ho s i g n s
K i r undi ? p eo p l e
N iinde yaandik
a
/
a b a antu?
in /up ?
W ho r e a d s E n g l i sh '?
gusoma kumenya
Niind
/
e
/
asom
i . coongereza ?
/
Niin d
az i ur ub a a n g a angwe?
k wii g a
/
a
/
kumesuura
W ho was he s
W ho (pl. )
Kir u n d i ?
s p eak/
kwaandi ka ,
4.
t h e hot el ?<
I hoot ee r
i r Xhe ? a
ah
N tiwootwerek
/ / /
ih oo t e e r i i r i ?
I mbaang a a n gw e z a a c u zi r Xh e ?
/ / / /
N tiwootweerek
ah
194
BASIC CO U R SE
U NIT l 2
i b i r o vyiiwe biri?
U muduga waawe ur X h e ?
N tiwootweerek I mfura yaacu irXh e ? a ah o umud u g a w aa w uri ? e
i n g w a zaacu ziri'?
I r aang i
I kar aamu r y a a c u
ri rXhe?
ar c he ?
/ /
E xercise 5 . A f f i r m a t ive indicative vs. negative indicative vs . affirmative relat;ive, > Does t h i s p a t h g o t o t ;o w n ? >
<This Co ne ]
d o e s n > t g o t o t ow n . <
195
U NIT 1 2
KIRUNDI
Ntabaar u nyerek
a
Zyi tagis i r aziimbuutse? Z yi nt i zi i mb u u t s e . Ntabaar u nyerek i t agis i z i imbuutse. e a Uyu mubooy a m esuur U yu a i m p uuzu?
a a ka k az i ?
Aka s i k o nk o r a . Ntabaar a uny e r e k ak az e
/
uk or a .
E xercise 6 .
g uhiindukir a
H i i n d u k i ri r i b u r y o .
k ugeen d a u bur a a r u u k o
/
Geend
bur y o .
N tuugeend
i b u b aamfu. mu b u manuko .
G eenda mu bu r a a r u u k o .
/
N tuu g e e n d e
/
kubla
u buseruk o
J a mu b u r a a r u u k o .
J a mu b u s e r u k o .
mu bur ee n ger o .
196
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 12
Exercise 7. I n dicative vs. relative t;one patterns on j-rij >be<. i n y u ma Ihooteer ir . i nyuma
i The hotel is behind t he b a n k .
n i i h o o t e e ri .
Ihooteeri ir i nyuma
t he mar k e t .
ya i s b k o .
Inz i r u
3.soko
i n y uma y a
n' L i h o ot e er i . i
uburyo
ket .
The building which is t o the right of th e
i soko
market; is a hotel.
The hotel is behind
iki baanza
t he s q u a r e .
n i i h o oteeri.
/
h aakury a
I nz
/
i r i haak u r y a y
/ /
a
/
i kibaanza i kiv uk o
n i i h o oteeri.
197
U NIT l 2
/
KIRUNDI I nz
/
i r i haak u r y a y
/
a
/
ikivuko n i ihooteeri.
h eepf o Ihooteeri iri heepfo y i ki v u k o . Inz
i r i h e e pfo y
i kivuko
n i i h o oteeri.
A re t h e s e
T urakene y
i bi t abo v y o o r o s h e .
Ibi ntivyooroshe.
/ /
n o t ea s y . l a n guages s t ud y ?
We need difficult
Aya n t aziimbuutse.
I zi mpuuzu ziramesuuye ? T urakeneye impuuzu zim esuuye .
A re t h e s e c l o t h e s wa s h e d ? We nee d w a s h e d cl o t h e s .
Izi
nt i z i m e s u u y e .
T hese ar e
not w ashed.
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 12
A ya makee t
ar ah w a h u t s e ?
/ /
D ukeney
a m ak ee t anw a h u t s e . e e
n t ah w a h u t s e .
/
Ay a
D ukeney
i m a s h i in i ya andika neeza .
A re t h e s e
W e need c h ea p T hese ar e
not ch eap.
U yu mudug
ug e e n d a n e e z a ? e
umu d u g
D ukene y
u g e en d a n e e z a.
g oes we l l .
/ / /
U yu
/
n t u g e e nd a n e e z a .
This o n e d o e s n o t go w ell .
Does t h i s h ar d ? co o k wo r k
U yu mubooy .
i
ar a k or a c a ane?
D ukeney
u m u b oo y ak o r a ca a n e .
/
W e need a
work s
cook who
har d.
U yu
n t a k ora c aane.
Thi s o n e d o e s n o t work h a r d .
199
UNIT 13
KIRUNDI UNIT 13
to tr avel
around
(- t e emberey e 1A
)
I want to travel around dur i n g
Nshaa k a g u t e e mbeera
mur.
/
2B
Uz o o t e em b e e r e r a h ee h e ?
don>t k n o w wher e y et .
( 11, 1 0 )
j our n e y far
4B
Uzoof at kure?
ur uge e n d o r w a a
5A
Oya , n z ooteembeera mu
ma>provinces> ya haafi
W here ar e
I
you goi ng ?
d o n < t k n ow .
- j aana na .
to go together with
( -j aanye na . . . )
BB
9A
Uz ooj aa n a n a a n d e ?
Nz o o j a a n a n a u mu g e e n z i .
/
200
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 13
2. The driver of a company truck sees his friend John on the streets of the city. we - t e g e er a 1 0C
r
you -- -j (-tegeereye
/
Yoh a a n i w e , ut eg e e r e y e
i ki ?
f or ?
11D
t o wai t ;
but t ;o gi v e m oney, f r a n c s
Wait;, I<ll take you, bu t
amafaraanga/amafaraanga
1 2C Ror ee r a n d a k u j a a n a , m ugab
/
y ou>11 pay me u r a a mp 0 a
(money).
a mafaraanga .
( or: . . .
u rampa'. . .
'
'
)
t o go f r om
- va ( - v u uye )
13D Kuv a h a n o k u g e r Ky o
a angaa h e ? 14C S i m een s h i , ni
( get )
t h e re ?
I t<s no t
mu c h .
I t >s j u s t
50 EP].
miroong i t aanu gusa.
0
201
UNIT 13
/ /
KIRUNDI Nb e g u b o n a r r uungana g u t e ?
ikilomeetero
15D
ur u g e end o
(7, 8)
iguana (5, 6)
1 60 Har . i b i l o m e e tero ha af . i i
/
- hi t a 1 7D Ur ab a
( -hi s e )
umpi t an a .
3
18E Ns h a aka kuj i K igari. U muunt 19F Har age r K y o g u t e ? There a r e t hr e e w a y s [ of t o go t h e r e . I want to go to Kigali. H o w does a p e r s o n g e t t her e ?
in z i ra zitatu zo
k uha j a . 2 0E N. i z i i he ? i
/
What
/
( <which> ) a r e t he y ?
or
caanke
ikamyo ( 9, 1 0 o r indeege
2 1F
6)
truck
( 9, 1 0 )
a
or
a ir p l a n e Y ou can g o b y ( <wit h t ) t r u c k ,
ta xi , or p l an e .
Us h o b o r a k u g e e n d a n i k a myo , c aa n k e
/
t agi s i ,
indeege.
c aank
202
B ASIC C O U R S E
UNIT l3
umwaanya (3, 4)
22E U m u u n t a m a r u m w a any u a a u ngana g ut e
n zi r a ?
/
period of time How lon g (>a period of time w hich e q u a l s w h a t >) does a
p er so n sp end e n r out e ?
muu
2 3F
i k am y o n
ama s K h a
haafi umunaani. 24F N a t a g isi, ni haaf a masah a a ta anu. minut e By plane it is about 25 m inut e s . By taxi it is about 5 hours.
25F
i i t aanu .
2 6E 2 7F 2 8E
T hank y o u f When are you going to leave? I Im going the day after tomorrow. ( >the o t h e r s i de of t omorr ow> )
H ow long will you be g o n e ?
29F
U z o o ma r i g ihe kiingan a a
i k. i i Ki g a l i ?
( <How much t i m e w i l l y ou s pend en r o u t e ' ? >) I>m going to spend about a month.
3 0E
Nzo o m ar a n k
uu kw e e z i .
203
UNIT 13 1.
KIRUNDI
A n ote on the non-immediate future tense. This unit contains several examples of a future tenseg U zooteembeerer a
/
heehe?
W here ar e
t ravel ?
you going t o
U zoogaana na ande ?
fix
tomorrow, but under some circumstances it may be used where the meaning is clearly future today. An example is found in
Dia l o g u e 1 1, St c . 19 : u sh i t s eh o .
Uzoob
The t e n s e
$ 1 e won>t h e l p
H e won> t
you.
hel p y ou .
. .. he won' t
he l p y ou .
If as in the last of these examples, the <provisional> high tone (Unit 1, Note 8 ) of /nta/ is pronounced high, the high t one o f /-zoo-/ is not pronounced. [ For practice, see Exercises 1-4 an d 7 - 9 . j
ao4
B ASIC CO U R SE
U NIT l 3
guteembeera
N shaaka g u t e e mbeera .
. mu r iyi
kuduuga
Nshaaka k u d uuga .
Nzooduug a mii s i .
g ushi k a
N shaaka g u s h i k K y o .
Nzooshikayo mu r mii s i .
iyi
guhiindukira
Ns h a aka guhiindukira.
N zoohiindukira mur i y i
mii s i .
Exercise 2. I n finitive vs. future, 3 pl. affirmative. gufasha g ufat a k uror a kubona k ujaan a B ashaaka k u g u f a s h a . Bashaaka gufat a m afaraanga meenshi . a B ashaaka k u r o r K h e ? B ashaaka k u t u b o n a . Basha a k a k u t u j a a n a . B azooguf ash Bazooyaf at Bazoorora h Bazootubo n a ej o . 5j o . 5j o . 5j o . a ej o .
a
e a
Bazootu j a a n
Exercise 3. I n finitive vs. future, 3 sg. negative. >He wants to travel, but he won>t travel in the n ext f e w d a y s . > guteembeera
/ / / / /
kuduuga /
k uduug a
2D5
n tazi i g a . . .
guhiindukira As h a aka guhiindukira, ariko n t azoohiindukira...
Dushaaka kugufasha, ariko n t ituzoogufasha mur. iyi miisi. Dushaaka kukugaana, ariko n t ituzookujaana...
/
>t o w a i t >
R oreera n d a g a r u k a .
/
a r a gu f a sh a .
Roreera
Roree r
s h o o bu g ar ak w e e r e k ubur y o . a a
ab a an d i b a r ak w e e r e k
ubur y o .
~o6
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 13
jeewe
bo tweebwe u mushof e e r i
/
a
/
a m a faraanga.
Exerc i s e 7 . The /-zoo-/ tense: indicative negative with various kinds of subject prefixes, and relative affirmative.
< You won't help him . <
Shoobug a A baandi
ur ugeend o .
n t i b a z o o rufata .
/
N iind a z o o r u fa ta ?
k wi i g a
Ntuz i i
ga .
Shoobuga
A baandi
n t a zi i ga .
n t i b aziiga.
N iind 1
a ziiga?
/ nt a - / ,
1 , Note 8 ).
A baandi
/
n t i b a z o orikurikira .
/ /
N iind k uz i m i r a Ntuzoozimira.
a z o o r i k urikira ?
a z o o zimira?
gutaangur a
5j o .
n t az o o t a a n gu r ego . a
kubla kw ii s 5ko
N tuzaoga k w i i so k o . S hoobuj a n t a zo o g a y o .
Uzooga mu bumanuko?
/
208
BASIC C O U R SE
UNIT
13
D ushobora k u g e e nda n
um u d u g a .
D ushobora k u g e e nda n i k am y o . a
Dushob or a ku g e e n d a n
umu du g a
ca an k e n
i k a my o .
i n z i r a n g u Zi ?
Ukuun d
i n zi r a y a k u r e ?
U kuund
i n z i r a n g uf i
c a ank
i ya k u r e ?
M uramwaawe n
umu s o r e ?
/
M uramwaawe n
umu g a b o ?
/ / / /
n i umugabo'?
<ab o u t > .
N zoomara nk k ab i r i
/
a\
u u k w e e z i muu n z i r a .
/
Nzoomara nk
aa m e e z i ab i ri m uu n z i r a .
umwaaka
a
a
a m a y i in g
a t a t u mu u n z i r a .
i m i i s . i t atu muu nz i r a .
1
a a
u m u u s i muu n z i r a . i s a h a mu u n z i r a .
is%ha gataanu
Nzoomara nk amasah a
Exerc i s e
1 0.
m an y w ay s t o
a h ou s e .
k wuubak
a
i
U raaz.
k wuubak a ?
T here a r e m an y w ay s t o g et t h e r e .
/
k uhas h i k a .
/
Do yo u k n o w t h e s h or t e s t r oa d t o g e t t h e r e ?
210
B ASIC C O U R S E
UNIT 13
kumesuura ?
Exercise 11. D i stance and time of travel. [ Studen t s < b o o k s s h o u l d b e o pen t o t h e m a p (p.63).] > How many k i l o m e t e r s i s i t f r omB u j u m bur a t o G i te a? ~ >It>s a l most 1 2 0 k m. > <How long does it take to get there?< I Three h o u r s . >
Kuv i Bujuumbura kuj i Ngoozi har. ibiromeetero biingaahe? a a i Ni haafi iguanan a miroong
0
i t aanu.
a t at u .
i N u y i i n g a ha r
0
i N g o o z i ku j
ib i r o m e e t ero bi ingaahe ?
Umuunt
a h a g e en d
u m w a a n y a un ga n iki ?
a NB Th e different pronunciations of /na/ plus /imiroongo/ illustrated in the recordings for this exercise. ]
211
A masah
a bi r i
UNIT 13
KIRUNDI
N i haaf .
i guana n
u
i m i r o on g it a a n d a t u .
0
/
Umuunt
a h a g e en d
/
um w a a n y
ung a g
iki ?
Amasah
/
at a t u .
/ /
K uv
i G i t e g a ku j
i B u r u r i h ar . ibiromeetero biingaahe ? a i
0
/
Ni haafi ig uanan a m i r o o n g
Umuunt
i ne .
/ /
a h a g e en d
u m w a a n y ung a n
iki ?
Amasah
at a t u .
/ /
i t aanu.
/ / /
i mwe .
/
Umuunt
a h a g e en d u m w a a n y
un g a n
iki ?
Amasah [ The
abi r i . t h e t on e s i n t h e l a s t
/
s t u d e n t s h ou l d sup p l y
t wo s et s
of
s entenc e s ] .
K uv i B u j u u m b ura ku j i B u b a a n z a a a N i haafi miroon g Umuunt
0
i t a andatu .
a h a g e en d u m w a a n y
un g a n
ik i ?
I s ah
i mwe .
212
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 13
Ni haaf
at a t u .
Practice conversations.
N zooga gu t e embeera k w
i iyiinga riiza .
UzoororKhe?
Ni kur e J
Uzo o m ar a y
i gihe kiingaan i k i ?
F or a b ou t weeks.
t wo
O n Wednes d a y .
Ku wa
gat at u .
2. Is R u mo ng e o n . f a r f r om K igo ma ? Nu Rumoong e
/
ni
k ur e
mu
i gi he
iki?
d ont t
k no w
Sindabiizi neeza .
r
yet .
U zoogeend a mu u ndeege?
No, b y
car .
u munaani g u s a k u ki l o meeter o .
S i meenshi
caane.
B ASIC C O U R SE
U NIT
( -bari y e )
t o t el l how? t o buy , s el l
- gura ( - g u z e )
imboga (9, 10) 1A Mbar i r a i n gen e ugur a
v egeta b l e s
Tell me how you s ell t'hose
v egeta b l e s .
(5, 6 o r
9 , 1 0) 10)
( 9, 6 o r
(9, 10)
a i z i i he ? A m a shu,
C abbage. H o w m uc h d o y o u charge for that big [head]? (<How do you sell it?< ) O nly 3 0 F.
5A
Ni
i n t a v Kh o ?
Do yo u
c o m e d o w n o n y o ur
pr i c es ?
6B
7A
I me .
( or: Me . )
O y a , nda g u h a c u m i n a ataanu.
/
8B
Ek a n a awe
si
u k u gu r a d a .
(elliptical ) Come o n ,
r easona b l e .
l et ' s be
215
UNIT 14 9B
G ive me 2 5 .
ataanu. 1 0A Ud a s h a a t s
e
ama f a r a a n g a
If
y o u d o n > t wa n t
20 P . ,
g ood by e )
miroongo ibiri
urab5ho. - gabi r a
1 1B Ee g o ,
/
( - ga b i y e )
t o give as a g i f t
za n a , n k u g a b i r e .
Di al o 12C
ue 2 . U gur i i s h
iki ?
What are you selling? salt sugar I have salt, sugar, etc.
(3) (9)
Mf i s u m u u nyu, isukaari, e
n
i biindi.
1 4C
Ugu r i i sh
ut
umuun y u ?
How do yo u spoon
Two s p o o n s
sel l
sal t ,?
i kiy i i ko
15D
(7, 8)
Ibiy i i k o b i b iri kw i if ar aa n ga .
f or
a f r anc .
1 6C 1 7D
Ur az i i m b a c a a n e ) Oy a , k 0 ar i we w e n d a g u h a
bitatu bitatu .
Youir e
v e r y h i gh i
No, [but] for you, I>11 give you three [for one franc].
- ger a
( - g e z e) ( - g e r e y e) 216
- ger er a
B ASIC C O U R S E
UNIT 14
1 8C
Ng e r e r
uw amaf a r a a n g a a
at'aanu.
icaamwa indi mu
(7, 8)
(9, 10)
I ki caamwa I yi ndimu
n i ciiza. n i n ziiza.
piece of fruit
lemon orange
umucuungwa
(3, 4)
umucuungwa
umweembe
/
(3, 4)
( 11, 1 0 )
mango
umweembe
u rut o r e umuhwi i gi t o o k e
rwiiza.
/
e ggplan t
banana plant a i n o ni o n
igi t u u nguru
I ki gituunguru
i fi
( 9, 10 ) ( 9, 1 0 )
I yi fi
n i nziiza. n i n ziiza.
( lar g e ) ( small )
i ndagar a
I zi ndagara
Q ualities of fru i t .
/ /
- sha
>to
( - hi i y e )
ge t r i pe>
I yi micuungw
i r ahiiye?
A re t h e s e ripe?
No,
or anges
0 ya
n t ihiiye.
t h e y a r en ' t
( ri p e ) .
21(
UNIT 14
KlHUNDI U yu mucuungw
/
u r a h ii y e ' ?
sweet >
A re t h e s e
s weet ?
or anges
N o, t h e y
Are
ar en>t .
Irakaat a '?
t h e y s ou r ?
No, t h e y
ar en' t . n o t s ou r .
Oranges a r e
- bora ( - b o z e )
>to r o t <
U yu mucuungw
r
I
u r a b o ze'?
O ya n t u b o z e . U rahi i y e .
- h i i sh i r a
N o, t h e y
ar en>t.
nini
Sbig l
Is this head of
c abbage l a r g e ?
to I li t t l e > I yi shu ni nto? Is this head of
c abbage f r e s h ?
- kaba ( - k a v y e )
>to g r o w s t a l e , dry, old, wilted<
I yi
s h i r ak av y e ' ? u
Is this head of
c abbag e ol d ?
218
B ASIC C O U R S E
U NIT 1 4 .
bisi >unri pe ,
g r e e n , r aw <
I s t h is cabbage raw?
K ind s
o f me a t :
(9, 10)
Mp
i n y ama z
ii n k a .
c at t l e
i ngur u b e inkbko
l.
A n ote on non-indicative ne atives. In Unit 0, the use of / nti-/ as a negative prefix was
described. T his prefix is used with all negative : ndicative forms, and only with indicative forms. U shaats e . . . Utaguze
Uaashaatse ...
These two verb forms are participial. The third, which is negative, contains the prefix /-ta-/. Unlike /- 'nti-/ which occurs at the very beginning of a word, / - t a - / after the subject prefix. This prefix has an alternant form /-da-/, which is used
w hen the sy llable that fo llows it begins with a v o i c eless con so -
oc c u r s i m m e d i a t e l y
nant. This is illustrated by the second of the above examples. T onal l y , /-ta-/ is basically low, and has no effect on the
219
UNIT 14 2.
KIRUNDI
A n ote on the use of relative verb forms in indirect discourse. C ompare t h e s e two s ent ences~
/ /
T hey wor k
c it ' es .
i n ot he r
Amubar i r
r
a k o bak o r a m u
He t e l l s h i m t h a t t h ey w ork in other ci ti e s .
b iindi bisagara .
T he ver b
In
Exercise 1. A f firmative vs. negative of relative forms. >We want mangoes that are ripe.< <We don<t want mangoes that are not ripe.<
l
gusha
D ushaak
i m y e e m b ihi i y e . e a
/
ahi i ye .
/
indXmu
D ushaak
i n d xmu zihiiye.
/
in d i m u z i d a h iiye .
i m i h w . i h i iye i
/ /
Ntidushaak g usoo s a
/
i m ihw J
ida h i i y e
D ushaak
i m i hw . isoosa. i
/
N tidushaak i mi c u u n g w a D ushaa k
imihw
i dasoosa .
i mi c uu n g wa i s o o s a .
N tidushaak
i m i c u u n gw i d a s o o s a .
[ NB
/ when the word is followed by a word that begins with low tone.] t o / i nd i m u
220
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 14
Exercise 2. P a rticipial vs. indicative disjunct, affirmative. <Do these oranges seem ripe to you [as you look at
them]? <
3Yes,
/
t h e y ar e r i p e . >
/
gus ha
U bon
i y i m i c u u ng w Eeg
ihi i y e ?
i rahi i y e , n t o r e zi h i i y e ? z i r ah i i y e .
/
i nt or e
Ubon
i zi Eego
k ubor a
U bon
i z i n t ore ziboze?
/
E ego z i r a b o z e . imXhwi
U bon
i y i m x hw. iboze? i
E eg m yii z a
i r ab o z e .
/
/
/
a r i myiiza?
ni myiiza.
h a v e r i p e o r an g e s ' ? >
gusoosa
B afis
i m i c u u ng w
is o o s a ?
D o they
h a v e swe e t
oranges ?
ih i i y e ? Do t h e y h ave r i pe
gusha
B afis
i m i c u u ng w
oranges ?
Do t h e y h a v e r i p e l emons ? Do t h e y h a v e ex p e n s i v e o ra n g e s ?
indXmu
Bafis
in d i m u z i h i i y e ?
k uz i i m b a
Bafi s
i n d i mu z i zi i mvy e ?
221
kuziimbuuka
Ba f i s i m i hw iz i i mbuutse?
e
e
amashu
Baf is
amash
az i i mbuutse?
D o the y h a v e c h e a p cabbage?
Do they have wilted
gukaba
B at'i s
sma sh
a kav e ? ~
i nt or e
Bafis
in t ore zikavye?
gukaat a
indXmu
gusha
/ /
Bafis
Do the y h a v e r i p e lemons ?
Do th ey h a v e r i p e
i mi c u u n g w a
Bafis
im i c u u n w
i hii y e ?
oranges ?
E xercise 4 . I n d i c a t ive vs . relative in dir ect vs . indire c t discour s e . Nzoof a t a ur ugeendo r waa k ur e . l<m going to take a
l ong t r i p .
B abar i r e k o n z o of a t r waa k u r e .
/ /
u r u g e en d o
N zooteembeera, mu r
iy i miisi.
T ell them I am g o in g t o t r a v e l ar o u nd t h e s e
days'
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 14.
N zoov
a i Bu j uu m b ur a e g o .
B u)umbur a
t om o r r o w .
go.
N zoobahi t a n a . B abari r e k o n z o obahi t a na . I will pick you/ t h e m u p .
Tel l t h em I t hem u p . I wil l wi l l pi c k
N zoogaruka k u
whkane.
/
come b a ck
T hursday . B abari r e k o nz o o g a r u k a k u w a k a n e .
/ /
Tel l
t h em t h a t
wi l l
Babarire ko tutazoogur i v yaamwa. a Ntituzooken i v yaamwa. a Babarire ko tutazooken i v yaamwa. a Ntituzooteek i m b5ga. a
B abarire ko tu tazootee k im boga.
Tell them that we will not buy fruit. We will not need fruit. Tell t h e m w e w i l l need f r u i t . not
t abl e s . a
Tel l t h em t h a t we wi l l n ot c o o k v e g e t a b l e s .
N tituzoobagabi r
u y u muduga.
B abarire ko tu ta zoobagabi r
muduga.
/ / /
car.
We wi l l not t el l o ur n a m e s . a m a z in a y ou
B abarire ko tu ta zoobabari r
/
Tell t h e m w e w i l l n o t
yaacu.
223
UNIT 14
/
/
KIRUNDI
N tituzooja mu bir e g o .
0
N tituzoogur
iyi nzu.
house a
iyi nzu.
( bui l d i n g ).
B abarire ko tu tazoogu r
Sin z o o g a r u k a
ku wa g a t a t u .
ko
n t az o o g a r u k a k u w a
Tel l
t h em t h a t
wi l l
not c o me b ac k Wednesday. 6j o .
/ /
wil l
not
l ea v e h er e
t omorr o w .
/
Babari r e
ko
n t az o o v a h a n
5j o.
S inzoot a a ng ur a
/
g u k or a e g o .
/
B abari r e gukor
/
ko a ego .
n t az oo t a a n g u r a
S inzoozimira .
/ / /
B abarire k o
n t a z o o z im ir a .
220
B ASIC C O U R SE
U NIT 1 4
uwo o m f a s h a .
Nshaaka guteembeera kw iiyiinga riiza. Mubarire ko nshaaka guteembeera kw iiyiinga riiza. Ndamujaana. Mubarir e
N teg e r e y e
r
k o n d a mugaana.
/
umu d u g a .
/
i b a r a b ara r i n i n i .
/ r
M ubarire ko dushikiri y
i b a r a b ara r in in i . a
/
ib a a n k i .
/
M ubarire k
/
ib a a n k i .
225
UNIT 14
KIRUNDI
Exercise 6. Us e of the interrogative stem /-te/; indicative v s. r e l a t i v e v er b s . <How do they sell those vegetables?> >I don>t know how they sell those vegetables.< Izo mboga bazigura bate? Siinzi ingene bagur izo mb5ga. Izo mboga baziteeka bate? Siinzi ingene bateek izo mb5ga.
Siinz i g ihe bava mu kazi. A/a kw iisoko ryaari? Siinz igi h e a ) a kw iisoko.
Exercise 7. I n dicative vs. relative vs. participial. > Are t h e s e o r a nges s p o i l e d ? <
>Andre said they are not spoiled,> >but they look spoiled to me.> [NB /k / before a vowel is pronounced /kw/.]
0
226
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT j 4
av u z e k
i t ab oze ,
/
arik o I yi micuungw a
A ndereya avuze k
Anderey a v uze k
a
a r i matoomato,
/
/
Anderey a vuze k
a
/
a r i matooto,
/
a rik o
m bo n ak a v y e . a
Anderey
av u z e k
ar i
nt oot o ,
a rik o
m b ona z i k a v y e .
A nderey
av u z e k o k i da k a a t a ,
av u z e k o k i da s o o s a ,
/
a rik o
n u u mva g i s o o s a . 227
UNIT 14
KIRUNDI
Narrative version of the basic dialogue of Unit l. [ To b e l e a r n e d by the student. Th e teacher then asks questions about this narr a t i v e . ] Yohaani n a
/
A n d e r e y a b a r a r a mukanya . a
A n d e r e y izi n a a
/
Y ohaani abari r
/
ryiiwe n uu k ar a o
A ndereya amubari r
/
Um u n y aameerika.
/ / /
iz i n a r y i i w e
u uk
a k o r a ku u b a a n k i .
/
Y ohaani
avuga k
/
ak or a m u r i
J ohn a n d A n d r e w g r e e t o ne another . J ohn tells A ndrew his name an d t h a t he is a n Am e r i c an . A ndrew tells him h i s n ame an d t h a t h e wor k s i n a b an k . J o h n s ay s t hat he works at th e American consulate, bu t t ha t h e h a s a r r i v e d h e r e r ecen t l y . Th a t i s t h e
r eason h e
him.
/ /
hasn' t
s ee n
a h a g eze v u ba .
/
Ni co
/
NEW WORDS
-ramukanya
ko
(-ramukanige
t o g r e e t ; o n e an o t h er
that
( used t o
i nt r o-
d uce a n
i ndi r ec t
sta t ement
A rageend ac a
He goes an d
door
k n o cks a t t h e
a n d sa y s g o o d m o r -
a g i r a bw a a k e e ye . a
ayamugeenz
B amubaz k
/
a t i : >Ndoonder
a zi g u k or a . a
/
ak az i
a zi kwaandikiis h
i m a shiini.
228
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 10
B amubariy e ac
/
az oo g a r u k a b u k e e y 0 e
h i m t h a t ; h e i s t ;o r e t u r n
ar i i k eb a a n u r a ,
NEW WQRDS
to
knock
i n z u u g i ( 10 )
door
h ere t o
c o n n ect t h e
t wo c l au s e s w hi ch
c ontai n /komaanga / a nd / - g i r a /. special verb stem m eaning < s a i d < ayamugeenza an exampl e o f an >autonomous< form of
/ - geenza/ .
Th i s
Class 6 substantive
/ aya-/
b ukeey e
and th e 3 s g .
ab a z
An d e r e ya i y
Abaru u n d i
b a k o r a , n g o ku k
/
/ /
B ujuumbura hari ba ke .
A m u b arira
J ohn a s k s A nd r e w w h e r e the Baz undi work , b e ca u s e t ; h e r e i n Usumbur a t h e r e a r e f ew p eople . H e t e lls him that' t;hey work in other
cities. He explains to
UNIT 14
/
KIRUNDI
/
muung i w aabo.
0
B a r arima,
/
/ /
him that many people work on their farms. T hey f a r m , d o w o o d a n d metal work, and many
o the r t hi ngs .
b arabaaza, baracura, n vy i i n sh i .
ib i i n d i
NEW WORDS
iyo
that that
(pronoun)
( conj u n c t i o n
ngo
kuko
b ecaus e
g usigu u r a
(-si guuye)
t o expl a i n
Practice conversations.
T ell
me how you
Mbari r ivy o
sell this
i ngen
/
ugur
f rui t .
v y a amwa.
Ushaa k i bi i h e ?
O ranges a n d lemons.
I mi c u u n g w a
indl mu .
/
Imicuungwa minini
minini uyigur
oranges ? angaahe?
Umwe kw iifaraanga.
230
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 14
Ni in t a v Kho?
Nti h i
i sh i y e .
P ractice conversation 2 .
2.
H ow much a r e t hose c a r r ot s ?
Umupfuung u r imw
0 0
a makaroot i
a n gaahe?
A taa n u .
A razi i m v y e .
Nda g u h a
/
Mp
i m i p f u un g
0
ib i r i .
N tushaak No.
i z iindi?
Oya.
UNIT 15
KIRUNDI
i s h i m i i zi 1A N shaa k a k u g u r
(9, 6)
is h i m i i z i .
cornel
2B I n g o n kwe e r e k e . C ome and let me show y o u .
ubwooko 3A Mufi s
e
(14, ' ~ or
6)
k ind ,
so r t
a y a ahe mooko
<Arrow <.
wan t
Ar r o w.
-aambara 6B
7A
(-aambaye)
t;o wear
Cumi n a z i t a a n u . kaandi
- kwi i r a
8B
( -kwi i y e
)
/
t o sui t
a b aa n t u nk a a w e
[ t h a t ar e ] go o d a n d (<peopl e y o u <) ar e B e c o .
ni <Become
- roonder e r a (-r o o nd er eye )
to look for, for someone
232
B ASIC C O U R S E
UNIT 15
9A
Ndoon d e r e r n iy o
>Arrow >,
nshaaka.
Di al o
ue 2 .
agashimiizi ( 12, 13 )
s hir t ;
literally to size )
1 0C Waam b a y
aga s h i m i i z i
k eeza .
11D Nayi g u z
W a kaguzlhe ?
mu g i t;oondo kuu
E staf .
like that;
m eeza gu t y o ' ? 1 3D 1 4C 15D Si mbi Zi gu r caa n e . angaa h e ? T hey<re n o t H ow much do bad. they cost ?
N a y i gu z a m a ja n a t a anu. e a
- nj e
I pai d 5 0 0 F .
1 6C
Naa n j e n z o o y i g u r a . igitaambara
(7, 8)
i .c o
17D
ah aa n d i
n y en e,
git;aambara wakiguzehe'?
18C
233
IT 1
KIRUNDI
ifar aanga
imeya
Y ampaay i m e y a . e
1/2 P.
inooti
W hat kind of b i l l s
10 F
20 P
50 F
100 P
500 F
1000 F
( -vyuutse )
t o get
up
Navyuuts m u gitoondo.
I got up in the mo r n i n g .
2g4
B ASIC CO U R SE
UNIT l 5
-iiyoza
N ii y o g e g e . - kar a b a N aakarav y e .
Naambaye .
/
(-i i y ogege)
to bathe oneself I t o o k a b at h .
(-karavye)
I washed . I go t
t o wash h a n d s/ f a c e
d r e s s ed . t ;o e a t
( -f u u n g uy e
)
I ate.
I wen t t o w o r k. overseer
(3)
midmorning
In the middle of t;he morning
Daatabuja y
/
m u bi r o ance
ku musase.
the boss came into t;he o ff i c e . to be dissatisfied He was dissatisfied wit;h my work. At noon I returned home to
e at .
/
- gaya ( - g a y e )
Y aagay e ak a z i k aa n g e .
(-shi i mye)
n o oneh
235
U NIT 1 5
KIRUNDI
l.
A n ot;e on the hodiernal tense. Examples of the hodiernal tense are found in the following
s entenc e s :
/
N ~ a i uze mu Ni tooudo .
/
I bought it ( in )
m orni n g .
[t'his]
This tense is ordinarily used only for act;ions which have tak en
place on t;he same day. It's name is derived from the Lat;in word for >today<. In form, the hodiernal is represented by a prefix
/-a-/, which stands immediately before the object prefix or, if t here is no object prefix, immediat'ely before the stem. T h e basic tone of this prefix is low. [ See Exer c i s e s 1, 2.
The stem tones used with verbs in the ho d iernal t;ense vary
from set t;o set. As in the immediate tense, there are separate conjunct and disjunct forms for the affirmat;ive. [ See Exer c i s e s 3, 4, 5. ]
The mark of the disjunct; hodiernal i s not; / - r a - / , only /-a-/, and this second /-a-/ may best be t;hought of as fol l o w i n g t h e t ; ense p r e f i x .
but
Aga i n as i n t h e i m m e d i a t e t ; e n s e ,
conjunct forms have low s tem to ne ; disjunct; forms have basic stem t one: t;hat is t;o say, high verbs have a h igh. tone and low verb s
d o not .
[ See Ex er c i s e s
6,7. ]
as for the immediat;e (and for all other tenses ): high for partic ipial and low for r e lative . S t e ~i tone in the affirmative rela -
forms.
[ See Ex er c i s e
8. ]
B ASIC C O U R SE
U NIT 1 $
this respect, the hodiernal tense differs from the immedi.ate tense, whose affirmative participials have low stem tones.
[See
E xercis e 9 . ]
In the negative, all stem tones are low for all m o ods of t he hodiernal ten s e .
[ See Ex er c i s e
10.]
E xercise 1 .
H o d i e r na l c onjun ct .
< What di d
kubona
/
y o u s e e ( in )
[ t h i s ] m o r n in g ? <
W aboony
i k i mu gitoondo?
/
/
Wagiiyehe mu gitoondo?
W afash e i k i m u g i t o on d o ?
/ /
W ateembeereyehe mu gi toondo ?
Exer c i s e
2.
Ho d i e r n a l
di s j unc t ,
Cl a s s 1 su b j e c t
pr ef i x .
g ut a a n g u r a
237
Exercise Q. H o diernal disjunct, various subject prefixes. 3The oranges got ripe [sometime today].< imicuungwa
i bi t o o ke
/
Exercise 0. H o diernal disJunct vs. hodiernal conjunct. > He ret u r n e d [ t o day]. < > Nhen [ t o d a y ] r et u r n ? > d i d he
Yaahi i n d u k i y e . Yaash i t se .
Y aazimi y e .
Yazimiye ryaari?
238
B ASIC C O U R SE
U NIT 1 5
kuvyaar a kuvuga
Yaavyaaye.
/
Yavyaay
Yavu z
i k i '?
Yaavuze.
i ki ?
Exercise 5. Disjunct vs. conjunct, hodiernal indicative. t Some speakers may prefer to use conjunct forms in the first, sentence of each pair, as well as in the second. ] <The children have done a lot.< baakoze
I What have they do n e ? <
(Cj)
v yi i n s h i . Baakoz e i ki ? e
i k i '?
B aandits
Baboony
e
e
i ki ?
iki?
B uumviis Bi i z e
i ki ?
Baabajije iki?
yakoze (Cj
Yohaani
)
Y ako z
yaakoze (Dj ) v yi i n s h i .
iki ?
Y aandits i k i ? e
Yiiz e Wakoz i ki ?
Nakoze Naakoze
(Cj) (Dj )
vyi i n s h i .
iki ?
Nuumviise vyiinshi.
N abajije vyiinshi .
i k i '? i ki ? Xk i ?
e e
239
Twiiz
i k i '?
UNIT 15
KIHUNDI
Exercise 6, H o diernal disjunct with object prefix, personal. >Did you see me (today] at the market?<
W aamboonye kw ii s o k o ? W aatuboonye kw ii s o k o ? Waababoony e kw i i s ok o ?
W aamuboonye kw i i s o k o ?
Exercise 7. H o diernal disjunct with object prefix, impersonal. > Did yo u kubona k waandik a kuroonka kugera
t wei g h t
r
s e e t h i s l et t er e e
ir i Keete? ir i keete?
J
[today]? <
<I saw
/
i t .<
W aaboony W aandits
N aar i b o o n y e .
N aaryaand i t s e .
N aar i r o o n s e .
N aari g e z e .
k uroonder a gusoma [ NB
k eet e ?
E xercise 8 .
( >That c h i l d i s
Uyo mwaana
/
n iw e
l
naboonye.
Uyo mwaana
/
/
Uyo mwaana
Uyo mwaana
/ /
gufasha
B ASIC COURSE
U NIT 1 5
a r r i v e [ sometime t o d a y t ? >
IMaybe he
Nkeeka
a r r i v ed . <
Y aash i t s e ?
yaashi t se .
Y aaguz
i m p uuzu?
N keeka y a a g u z
impuuzu. gusoma
Yaasomy e i ki g i t ab o ? N keeka y a a s o my e
/
iki gitabo.
/
gukora
Yaako z
ak a k az i ?
N keeka y a a k o z a ka k a z i .
guteeka
Yaat e e t s
i zi
n y ama ?
k ugoroor a
Yaago r o o y
i z i mpu u z u ?
N keeka y a a g o r o o y
i zi mpuuzu.
Exercise 10. H o diernal relative negative. >The person who didn>t arrive [todayj is John.>
g ush i k a k ugeen d a U muunt U muunt U muunt U muunt U muunt
11
a t a a s h i ts e n i Y o h a a n i .
/
a t a a g i iy e n i Y o h a a n i .
/
a t a a vuze n i Y o h aani.
/ /
u
u
a t u u m v i is e n i Y o h a a n i . a t a a d uf'ashige n i Y o h a a n i .
24-1
UNIT 15 Exerc i s e 1 sg . 11 .
KIRUNDI
Hodi er n a l p as t .
Q uesti o n s
a n d a n s w e r s , 2 s g . and
i b iintu.
i b i ihe biintu? e
N aguz
i m b5ga.
Exercise 12. H o diernal past. Yohaani yagiiy6he mu gitoondo? Yagiiye mu gisagara. Yakoz iki mu gisagara?
e
Q uesti o n s
an d a n swers , 3 sg .
Yataanguye g u ko r
z ibi r i .
They went
t o s ch o o l .
i k i kw iishuuri?
Bi i z e .
242
BASIC CO U R SE
UNIT 15
W hat di d y o u ( pl. )
m orni n g ? W e wor k e d .
do t hi s
Twaakoze. Nwaakoz e a ka a h e k a z i ?
e
T waamesuuy
i m p uuzu.
W e washed c l o t ; h e s .
Practice conversat'ions.
N ayaguze k w i i s o k o mu gi t ;oondo. How much? W ayaguz e ut e ? Ntiyanziimvye caane. T here i s w h e r e m any peopl e have b ough t
them.
u u k o y a a z a n ywe n a
b eenshi .
2.
W aagiiye kw iisok u y u
0
m uusi ' ?
N aagii y e .
243
KIRUNDI W ashaaka k u gu r i ki ?
Nashaak i b iintu
vy i i n s h i .
Did y o u g o by car ?
Did yo u g o t o t he b an k a l s o ?
O ya, nagiiy e j o . e
F ree c o n v e r s a t i o n . Practice asking and answering questions about activities that have or have not been performed earlier during the day.
B ASIC C O U R S E
U NIT 1 6
i rXgi ( 5 , 6 )
ntaa 1A Ma da a m u , n t a a mag
u ro o n d e r a ?
/
egg
i t i s not;, t h er e i s n o t
-zana-( - z anye
)
Y es, I
t ;o b r i n g
-raaba (-raavye)
2B Nday a r o o n d e r a , z a n a ndaabe. 3A Raab a , u sa a n g ar i a m eeza caan e .
t o e x ami n e
Look [them] over, you'll find that; they are very nice.
akomeeye?
e
5A
Oy a', em a g x y a a n j
/
N o, a l l
my e ggs ar e good.
(7, 8)
week
to e n d , b e co m e e x h a u s t ; e d
( -shi z e )
in supply
245
UNIT 16 6B
/
/
/
KIRUNDI
Ay o nag u z e mu c u umweeru
/
/ /
Those that I bought last week were almost all bad (<bad almost all< ).
to
choose
Ror ee r a n d a g u t o o r e r e
/
/ /
ones f o r
y o u.
mw aameeza.
0
8B
i bi r i .
9B
Nguh
am a f a r a a n g an g a a h e '?
I gi v e
you)?
10A U m p a miroong i b i ri
0
/
(You give me ) 20 F.
ur aan z a n i r
-bonana ( -bonanye )
12A Ur ak o z e c a a n e Madaamu, t uzoobonan D ial o gu e 1 3A 2. a ego .
t o see
one an ot her
Ay a m a g i w a y a g uz e n a a n d e ?
1 4B 1 $A
Nay a g u z e n a Y o h a a n i . Yay a a z a ny e k u m u u s i
w aamber e ?
246
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT16
16B
Oy a ,
n t a a magi yar
shaasha 1 8B Yav u z e k a ri
0
aay a m a @
/
m a s h a asha .
l. A note on the tone of words like irX i A number of words, when pronounced in isolation or at the end of a phrase, have unanticipated high tone on the next to last syllable. An example is /irXgij <egg<. For some speakers, this tonal pattern remains constant regardless of contextt an egg ir ~X i r y aan g e m y egg
is heard when another word follows, especially if that word begins with low tone. The marking of tones in such instances vacillates in this book between one of these patterns and the other.
247
U NIT l 6 2.
KIRUNDI
A n ote on the hesternal a st tense. Examples of the tense are found in the following sen-
t ences : Baavuze k
/
aa z uy u m u u s i. o a aay a m u g . a r i
i
Yavuze k
m ashaas h a .
N ayaguze n a Y o h a a n i .
/
Yayaazanye. a yo nagu z e . . .
H e brough t
t h em.
This tense is ordinarily used only in talking about things that happened yesterday or earlier. It gets its name from the Latin w ord f o r > yester d a y . > In general, hesternal forms of the verb are spelled exactly like their counterparts in the hodiernal. Th e exceptions a re t h e d i s j un c t f or m s . (The hesternal is the only tense which
I t wi l l
/-8,-/
T he characteristic difference between hodiernal and h e s ternal forms is that the la tt er, in addition to the g e n eral past
/-a-/, have a high tone. The location of this tone varies accord in g b ef o r e t o t h e st r u c t u r e o f the t h e p r e f i x wh i ch st an d s i m m e d i a t el y
/-a-/ .
(i.e.
248
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 16
consists of a single vowel (/u,a,i/) or consonant (/n/), then the high tone is on the vowel of the syllable that follows the
Thus!
/-a-/.
I bought them [before today]. I bought them [today]. did you launder them'? ( hest e r n a l ( hodi e r n a l he went ( hodi e r n a l
)
( hest e r n a l
)
is
[For drill on this point, see Exercises 3, 0, 5.] If the prefix that stands before the past / - a- / DIPHONIC (consists of two phonemes ) , t h e n t ai n e d o n t he / - a - / .
t he high tone is r e -
on the second half of the vowel. T h us> b aatur u t s e h e ? cf. b aatur u t s e h e ? where did they come from [ bef o r e t oday ] ? where did they come from [today]?
T hus the tone fa lls on the s e cond mora of the ve rb , for mon opho n ic and diphonic prefixes alike . [ F o r d r il l on t his p o i n t , see
Exerc i s e s
1, 2, 5. ]
The disjunct forms are different from the conjunct only
in having the syllable /-ra-/ immediately after the tense prefix /-a-/. N ote that in this respect the hesternal tense is like the immediate tense, which also has /-ra-/ in its disjunct forms.
I t is unlike the hodiernal, where disjunct forms have an e x t r a
249
UNIT 16
KIRUNDI
Twaara b o o ny e t waa r i
W e saw John w h i l e
were i n Bur u n d i .
we
Bu r u u n d i .
The stem tone of most hesternal forms, both affirmative and negative, is low. The exceptions are the disjuncts, both indicative and participial, which have a high tone on the root syllable in those forms with a diphonic subject prefix. N keeka ba a r a g i i y e
k ivuk o .
ku
It should be noted that low stem tone is found even in the affirmative relative forms of the hesternal tense. I n this respect, the hesternal tense is unique. In the immediate and recent tenses, affirmative relative forms have postradical high tone (cf. Unit 4 , Note 3 ) . Be c a u s e t h e s t e m t o n e o f t he i n di -
cative forms of the hesternal tense is low, relative and conjunct indicative forms of the affirmative of this tense turn out to be
i dentical with one ano th er . Thus<
Naguz
a yo .
a yo nagu z e . . .
250
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 16
Participial forms of the hesternal have an initial high tone, just as they have in the other tenses. Where this tone
N keeka y a y a r a a v y e .
r
[For practice on this point, see Exercise 12.] W here t h e s u b j e c t pr ef i x i s <diphonic>, and the vowel
following it is long, the high tone of the participial is found on the first half of the vowel, and the high tone of the hesternal tense is retained on the second half. T his produces a double h igh t o n e .' Nkeeka b aa j e ej o.
Exercise 1. H o diernal vs. hesternal past, conjunct. P r actice in differentiation. D iphonic subject prefixes. a. < What di d y o u r ec e i v e [ t od a y ] ? < <What did you re ceive [before t oday ] ? > e e e e i ki ? i ki ? i k i ? (ejo) i ki ? (ejo) Mwaaroons M waaroons M waaroons M waaroons e
e
i ki ? i ki ? i ki ? i ki
r
( ejo )
e e
( e j o)
251
UNIT 16
KIRUNDI w e d o [ t oda y ] ?
/
[bef or e
t oday]? 1
i ki ? e e e
iki ?
e
e e e
i ki ?
i ki ? i ki ?
(ejo)
Twaakoz Twaakoz
i ki ? i ki ?
(ejo)
Twaako z
(ejo)
Twaakoz
i ki ?
(ejo)
c.
'Where did they come from [before today]?~ B aatur u t s ehe ? B aatur u t s e h e ? B aatur u t s l h e ? B aatur u t s l h e ?
(ejo) (ejo)
(ejo) (ejo)
D
Practice in identifi-
a.
Ve r b s t e m s u s e d i n E x e r c i s e l . mwaaroons
mwaaroon s e e
i ki ?
iki ?
/
{ejo)
Hs
Hd
b aatur u t s 5 h e ?
b aat u r u t s 6h e ?
/
(ejo)
Hs Hd Hd
t waa r o o n s
i ki ?
b aaroon s mwaakoz
b aar o o r e e
i ki ? i ki ?
(ejo) (ejo)
Hs Hs Hd
i ki ?
252
B ASIC C O U R S E
UNIT 16
Hs
Hd
i ki ?
b.
O t h e r v er b s t e m s .
b aagezl h e ? baagez5he?
(eJo)
Hs
Hd
m waashit s e h e ? baaguze i k i ?
(eJo)
Hs
m waasomy i k i ? e baate et s
e
(eJo) (eJo)
/
Hs Hs
Hd Hd
i k5 ?
i ki ?
(eJo)
Hs
Hd
m waateets i k i ? e
Exercise 3. H o diernal vs. hesternal, conJunct. P r actice in differentiation. N onophonic subJect prefixes. a. < What did I do [ t o d a y j ? >
Nakoz Nakoz e i ki ? i ki ?
todayj ?<
D
e e
e
i ki ?
iki ? iki ?
(eJo)
e
e
Nako z Nakoz
i ki ? i ki ?
( e J o) (eJo)
Nakoz
Nakoz
i ki ?
( e Jo)
253
UNIT 16
e
e
i ki ?
(ejo)
(ejo)
e e e
e
i ki ? i ki ? i ki ?
i ki 2
i ki ?
i ki ?
i ki ?
( ejo ) ( ejo )
S D
S
e
e
c. Where did he come from [before today]? Y atur u t s 6 h e ? Y atur u t s 5 h e ? Y atur u t s 6 h e ? Y atur u t s 5 h e ?
(ejo) (ejo)
( ejo )
(ejo)
S
D
Exercise 4. H o diernal vs. hesternal conjunct. P r actice in identification. M onophonic subject prefixes. nakoz
n ako z
e e
i ki ?
i ki ? e
(ejo)
Hs
waroons
i ki ?
Hd
y atu r u t s 5 h e ? wasomy e e
e
(ejo) (ejo)
Hs
i ki ? i ki ?
Hs
Hd
y ate et s
wamesuuy
i ki ?
(ejo)
Hs Hd
w ashi t s 5 h e?
a~4
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 16
yagez5he?
waguz e i ki ?
( eg o )
Hs
Hd
E xercise 5 .
H o d i e r na l vs . he sternal con/unct . P r a c t i c e in i d e n -
i ki ?
Hd Hd
(ego)
Hs
Hd Hd
i ki ?
(ego)
Hs
Hd
baamesuuy y amesuuy e
(ejo)
Hs Hs
Hd
i ki ?
( eg o)
w ashi t s 5 h e ?
E xercise 6 .
H e s t e r na l c on/un ct .
y o u d o (on) [ t h a t ]
m o r n i n g '?>
i k i mu gitoondo?
iki e e e
mu g i t oo n d o ?
/
W asomy
i k i mu g itoondo?
W aroons
i k i mu gi t oo n d o ?
i k i mu gitoondo?
W aandits
>55
UNIT 16
KIHUNDI
g utaangur a kuvyaar a
k uzi m i r a g ush i k a
/
si t a . si t a.
/
saa. si t a .
kugeenda g uhi i n d u k i r a
Exercise 8. H e sternal, object prefixes. >Did you finish the w ork y e s t e r d a y ? > kumara kuroonka k wii g a k wii b a g i r a
k ubab a r i r a
/
3I finished it yesterday.>
W amaz a k a z
e
/
ej o ?
/
Nakamaz
e
/
ejo .
/
Waroons
e
M e e t e jo? e e
0
Narir o o n s Nacii z e
ej o .
ejo?
ej o .
Y oh a a n
/
ej o ? ejo ?
W agaruts e
i m uhir u
/
ej o .
W arimy a m ash
/
ejo?
/ /
ej o .
/ /
[NB The apparently free alternation between / 5jo / [ i ] a nd / e j o / [ ] i n t hese sentences of Note 1. T his word will be left unmarked for tone in the remainder of these exercises, so that the student may
m ark the various occurrences of this word as he h e ars them from h i s
o wn t u t o r . ]
zg6
B ASIC C O U R SE
U NIT 1 6
Nonophoni c
p r e f i x es .
i t t oda y ? >
Yabi k o z
uy u
mu u s i ?
eg o .
e e
e
e
uyu muusi?
/
Yabii z a n y
ego .
uyu muusi? mu u si ?
/
u yu
ego.
ego . ego .
kugaya kugeenda
Y agay Yagii y
e e
a ka z . u y u muu s i ? uy u muu s i ?
/
Exer c i s e
10 .
i t y es t er -
g ukor a k uuza n a
Baabi k o z
u yu m u u s i ?
/
Baabiko z
ego . e
e
0
g upii m a
g ush i k a
B aashi tseh u y u m u u s i ?
0
kugaya
k ugeen d a
B aabiga y
uy u m u u s i ?
ego . ego .
257
UNIT 16
KIRUNDI
Exercise 11. H e sternal, affirmative vs. negat;ive. >Did they arrive yesterday'?> I No, t h e y d i d n > t
( arr i v e ) . <
kuuza g utaangur a gufasha
k uz i m i r a
/
B aal
ej o ?
e
eg o ?
k wii g a g uhiindukira
ego ?
Ba a h i indukiy e g o ? e
Ntibaahiindukiye.
Exercise 12. H est;ernal indicat;ive vs. participial. > Did he a r r i v e y es t e r d a y ? < II think he arrived y est e r d a y . <
kuuza
/
Ya J e
ego?
e e ego ? ego ?
N keeka yap
ego.
ego. e ego .
Yataanguy
ego ?
ego .
eg o ? e
e j o '?
y ii z
ego . ego.
Yahiindukiy
Nkeeka y ahi i n d u k i y e
Exercise 13. H e sternal indicat;ive vs. relative. >I bought some things y est'erd a y . > kugura kuuzana N aguz i b iint e g o . e u Nazany
e
>Where are the things y ou boug h t ? < Ibiintu waguze birXhe? Ibitab w a zany
0
i bi t ab
ego .
b i r Xhe?
258
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 16
kwaambara
k ugabi
Yangabiy
/
impuuz u
I mpuuzu y a k u g a b i y
irXhe?
n zi i z a .
/
guteeka k ugoroo r a
ego.
i mp u u z u
I mpuuzu b a a g o r o o y e z ir X h e ?
nyi i n s h i .
N keek N keek
a a a
at aa t u b o o n y e . a t aa t u m enye .
kwuumva k utegeer a
a at aa d u t e g e e r e y e .
Exercise 15. S ubstitution in Sentences 1 and 2. < You>re l o o k i n g f o r egg s , a ren' t y o u ? < N taa mag amashu gukuunda inyama kugura kwiibagira
/
ur oo n d e r a ?
Ntaa
m a s h u r o on d e r a ? u u
uk u u n d a ? u k u unda?
259
UNIT 16 E xerc i s e 16 .
t he y > r e v e r y
amagi amashu in y a ma
R aab a m X g i . a
R aab R aab R aab
/
a a a a
ar i a ri ari a ri
meeza c a a n e . m e e z a ca a n e . n z i i za ca a n e . n z i i za ca a n e .
/
am a s h u . i n y am a . i mp u u z u
a a a a a
impuuzu imicuungwa
i mi d u g a i bi t abo
/
Raab
Raab
i m i c u u n g wa .
i mi d u g a .
Raab
i bi t abo .
ari
vy i i za caa n e .
eggs ar e g o o d . <
/ /
Amagi yaanj a k omeeye yoose. e Imyeembe yaang i komeeye yoose. e Intore zaanje zikomeeye zoose. I nt or e
/
z a ange z i k a vy e z o o s e .
/ /
imb5ga
i bi t uu n gur u
26o
B ASIC C O U R S E
UNIT 16
Exercise 18. S u bstitutions in Sentence 9. >How many francs do I give you?< amafaraanga amagi 3 sg
i bi i n t u i mi c u u n g w a
/ /
N guh a m a f a r a a n g ang a a h e ? a a
N guh Aguh Aguh
a a
am a g
/
an g a a h e ?
/ /
amag a n g a a he-'?
j
a ibiintu biingaahe'?
Aguh im icuungwa ingaahe? a Tuguh im icuungwa ingaahe? a T uguh Tuguh a a m ag i a n g a a h e ? a m a f a r a a ng a a n g a ahe '?
/
1 pl . amKgi amafaraanga
Exercise 19. S u bstitutions in Sentence 13. >Who did you buy these eggs from [yesterdayj'?>
aIllcLgi
Aya
m a g i w a y a g uz e n a a n d e '?
i bi i n t u
Iyi karaamu wayiguze naande? U ru r u b a a ngaangwe war u guz e n a a n d e ? Iki gitabo wakiguze naande'?
/
/
iraangi
UNIT 16 E xerc i s e 20 .
amagi
i bi i n t u
uyu muusi
i bi t abo
/ /
Ibi bitabo yabiizanye uyu muusi. Ibi nitabo yab5izanye ku muusi wa gatatu.
/
/
Practice conversations.
A ya magi w a y a guz e h e e h e ?
N ayaguze n a B e r n a r d o .
How many di d
y ou bu y ?
W aguz a n g a a h e ? a
M iroong itatu.
W hen d i d b rin g
he t h em ?
Yayaazanye r y a a r i ?
K w iiyiinga rihe z e .
S i meeza c a a n e . 262
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 16
H ow much d i d y ou pa y f o r them?
W ayaguz
a m af a r a anga
angaahe? Miroon g
/
i ne n
a ataanu .
Y a azanye
Yar aa b e .
a k o m ey e .
2a.
(Hesternal )
W avyuutse r y a a r
/
ego?
Navyuut s i s a' zi bi r i .
W hat di d y o u do a f t e r y ou
W ako z i k e
uvy uu t s e ?
got up?
N ari i y o g e j e . W hat di d y o u do af t e r y ou
b at h e d ?
U maze kwi i y o z a
i ki ?
wakoz
Naraambaye.
Did y o u ea t b r e a k f a s t '?
Warafuunguye mu gitoondo?
nca nb a mu
263
Kw iisaha zitatu n
i nusu .
2b.
What
( Hodier n a l
t i me d i d
)
W avyuutse muus i? N avyuutse is5h i m w e . a r y aar i
/
uy u
y ou ge t today?
up
What d i d y ou do af t er
Wakoz
i k
u vy u u t s e ?
y ou go t
up? N ii y o g e j e .
When yo u h ad f ini s he d
U maze kwi i y o z a
i ki ?
wakoz
b athi n g ,
did
what
you do ?
a k a zi kaawe?
Si k a b i
c a an e .
B ASIC C O U R SE
VNn 17
[ in a
i y i i he ?
t h i s c ou n t r y ] ?
Ama s a ha y o gu f u u n g u r a
s. a amwe.
igoro
i saa s i t a 3B Isa h a ya kabiri, isaa
/
/
evening noon
E ight a.m., noon, and in th e
e venin g .
sita no mw iijoro.
- rya ( - r i i ye )
4A M u Bur u u n d i ba r y a k aangaahe k u 5B Har n
/
to
eat
muusi ?
Ther e a r e t h o s e w h o e at t hr ee
(8)
6A
Ibirii b w a m u f is e i bi k i ' ?
7B
Mu Buru u n d i h a r imwa
grown. v yi i n s h i . umukaate
8A Muraku u n d
(3, 4)
b rea d
im i k a a t e ?
Do you
( pl . )
l i k e br ea d ?
265
KIRUNDI There are those who like it, and those who don<t like it.
-soonza 1 0C 1 1D
(-shoonge)
I
t o be
h un g r y
f e e l hu n g r y . you b e s at i s f i ed t o go
Would
eat at my place?
-buza ( -bugige )
12C Noo b u zwa n i i k i ? Noobishiima caane. 1 3D Nt aa v y o ?
t o f or b i d
- shik a 14E
haasi
N i m u shike haasi.
P lease s i t
-boneka (-bonetse
1 5D Ngw i i n o d u f u u n g u r e . I ndya z a a b on e t s e . L 6C U m u g or e w a a w at ee k a e n eeza c a a n e f - r ek a
/
( -r e t s e )
-hema (-hemye) da
(emphatic particle)
266
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 17
1 7D
Re k a k u m uhema da . . .
mbeega
1 8D Nb e e g i z i nyama n i a
i z 1 9D 20C Ni
( a quest i o n wor d
i iki ?
i z
i n gu r u b e .
I t t s p o r k ( tof a
pi g t
).
i ngur u b e .
1.
A n ote on autonomous verb forms. Sentences 5 and 9 of this unit contain examples of so-
called tautonomous> verb forms: Har ~a t a r a gat at u . . . T here a r e t h o s e w h o e a t t hre e t i m e s . . . There are those that like them, and those that don<t like them.
a
An
ones in which nouns may be used: s u bject or object of a verb, position following /na / or / hari/, etc. In this sense, they are like substantives. U n like substantives, however, they may have the same objects and modifiers
t hat other verb forms ha v e :
267
Autonomous forms may contain object prefixes, and are inflected for aspect (imperfective vs. perfective ) and t e n s e , j us t ;
as other verbs are , except that there is no di stinction in th e p ast affirmative between hodiernal and hesternal . A utonomous forms are of course not differentiated for in -
dicative, participial and relative functions. For this reason, the classification >autonomous> is grouped together with those three categories into a single <dimension> of the Kirundi verb. The structure of the autonomous forms is completely regular. The vowels and consonants are those of the relative form, except for an augment vowel before the prefix in the autonomous form. If the corresponding relative form begins with a vowel, the pre-prefix consists of vowel plus s emi - v o w e l ; otherwise it consists of a v o w e l o n l y : a badashaaka . . . cf. a baantu b a d a s h aak a . . . iyisoosa cf.
/
imicuungwa isoosa 1 , 2. j
[ See Ex er c i s e s
With respect to it's first tone, an autonomous form has a h igh tone on th e th ird unit of vowel length . I f th e second
iyisoosa abataa r i i y e
268
B ASIC C O U R S E
UNIT 17
abaari,iye
[ See Ex er c i s e s 3, 4] .
'Zhe stem tones of autonomous forms are th ose most typ i cal o f the tense to wh ich the form belongs . T h i s m e an s t hat m ost s e t s
have low stem tone [see Exercises 5, 6]. The future affirmative and negative have high tone on the root syllable for all verbs, and the inceptive affirmative and negative ( Unit tone on the root sylla'ble of high verbs only: affirmative i mmediat e h odi e r n a l h este r n a l
f ut u r e
2 3 ) hav e hi gh
abasoma abaasomye
/ /
abaasomye abazoosoma
/ /
2.
A n ote on the infinitive as a substantive. Sentence 2 of this unit contains the expressions amasaha y u gufuungur a a y ogufuungur a
As in many other languages, the form which is ca l led an
/
/
>in f i
n i t i v e > h a s t h e p r i v i l e g e of
t a k i n g t h e s am e o b j e c t s a n d
modifiers as any other verb form, but it also may be used in posi t i o n s , or
b y nouns . >slo t s < i n t h e s en t en c e w hi ch a r e u s u a l l y f i l l e d
KIRUNDI that agree with it have the concordial prefix of Class 15 (/ku-/ /kw-/). T his class contains a few members which are not infinitvess /ukweezi / >m onth> is one of them.
c f. also: u g u s oma kw iiw e n i k w i iz a h is rea d i n g i s g o o d
W hen th e
wa
vya /etc. is used before an noun of Class 15, the /a/ of the particle and the preinitial / u/ o f t h e no u n c o a l e s c e t o gi v e / o/ , a vowel which is phonetically halfway between y a u gufuungur a
/
-+
y o g uf uungura
/ e/
( U n i t 3 , No t e 3 ) .
/yogufuungura / o r
/ y u g u f u ungura /.
[ S e eExercis e 7 . ]
Exercise 1. A u tonomous forms, immediate affirmative vs. negative, Class 2 subJect prefix. > Those who k n o w ho w t o w rit e a r e n u m e r o u s . >
kumenya Abazi kw a a n d i ka ni.
> Those who d o n > t k n o w h o w to write are few.> A bataazi kwaandika n i bake.
b eens h i .
gushaaka
Abashaaka k w i i g a
b eens h i .
ni
Abadashaaka k w i i g a
bake .
ni
kurya
Abary i nyama a
n i bake.
270
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 17
k uroonk a
Abar oo n k am a h e r a ni a b eenshi .
Abatar o on k bake.
am a h e r a ni
kuba
z a abo
ni
z a ab o
ni
gukora
Abakora mu
b eens h i .
g i s a gar a
ni
Abadakora mu bake.
g i s a g ar a
ni
Exercise 2. R e lative vs. autonomous, immediate affirmative, v ari o u s c l a s s e s . >Are r i p e m a n g oes e xpensi v e ? < imyeembe Zmyeemb i h iishiy e e irazi i mvye? imicuungwa Imicuungwa ihiishiy iraziimvye?
/
> Are r i p e
Zyihiishiy i r aziimvye? e
I yi h i i s hi y
i r a z i i mv y e ?
gusoosa
Iyisoos i r aziimvye?
ic a amwa
I c aamwa g i s o o s a
I gisoosa kiraziimvye ?
I nt or e
zi kavye
Izikavye ziraziimvye?
z ir a z i i m v y e ?
271
UNIT 17
in d j .mu
KIRUNDI Indimu zikavye ziraziimvye? Indimu zikaata ziraziimvye? Imicuungwa ikaat i r aziimvye? Izikavye ziraziimvye? Izikaata ziraziimvye? Iyikaat i r aziimvye? a
gukaata imicuungwa
>Who brought this book?> (>[He] who brought this book is who?~ )
U wazany U wasomy
/
e e
Uwaguz iki gitabo nii nde? e Uwatugabiy iki gitabo n5i nde? e Uwaandits iki gitabo nii nde? e Uwii z e
e
i ki
gi t abo n i i
nd e ?
Exercise 4. A u tonomous forms, hodiernal negative. < Those who d i d n > t gukora gufasha
k wi i g a
/ /
A bataakoze
n t i b a z o o roon k a m a f a r a a n g a .
A batiize
/
n t i b a z o o roon k a m a f a r a a n g a .
kubla
k ur i m a k ugar u k a
A bataarimye A bataagaruts e
n t i b a z o oroon k a m a f a r a a n g a .
n t i b a z o o roon k a m a f a r a a n g a .
272
B ASIC C O U R SE
U NIT 1 7
Exercise 5. A u tonomous forms as objects of verbs. A f firmat;ive v s. n e g a t i v e . > Bring t h e s w e e t ones. > >Stop bringi.ng ones that aren>t s w e e t . > R eka kuuzana i y i d a s o o s a .
Reka k u u z a n a i y i dak aat a .
(imicuungwa )
gukaat a
Z an i y i s oo s a . a
Z an i y i k aa t ; a .
(ind'Imu)
kubora
Z an i z i kaa t ; a . a Z an i z i . b o z e . a
R eka kuuzana i . z i d a k a a t a . R eka kuu zana i z i t ' a b o z e . R eka kuuzana i b i t ab o z e . R eka kuu zana i y i t ab o z e . Reka kuuzana iyidahiiye.
Z an i bi b oz e . a Z an i y i b oz e . a Zan
i yi hi i ye.
Exercise 6. A u tonomous forms, immediat;e negative vs. af f irmative. <The ones that, aren > t sweet; are cheaper than the o nes t h a t ar e . <
/
gusoosa gukaat;a
(indfmu
k ubor a
) )
[NB Some speakers may prefer to reverse the st;atement; of this comparison, putting the greater of the two it;ems before /-suumba/ > to pa s s > . ]
273
UNIT 17
KIRUNDI
Exercise 7. S u bstitutions in Sentences l and 2. P o ssessive plu's infinitive. < What t i m e d o y o u e a t her e ? < o f eat i ng v a r y . >
a amwe.
aam w e .
kugeenda mukazi
a amwe,
Exercise 8. S u bstitutions in Sentence 4. L o catives with varioes stems. >How many times a day do they eat in Burundi' ?> Uburuundi waanyu
/
274
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 17
ibiki ? ibiki ?
ivyaamwa
imb5ga
n iinki? i
(bo)
impuuzu abaana
E xerc i s e
10 .
Practice conversations.
M u Buruund i
b a f u u ngur a
iki mu gitoondo'?
M u bi s a g ar a a beenshi
imikaate.
har bary a
275
KIHUNDI
/
Barar y
i v y aa mwa mu
gi toondo?
u k uunda
gusuumba ibiindi n . i bi i he ? i
N kuund
i ny a m a z
i nkoko .
I nyama z
i nk ok o
ziraziimvye mu
B uruu n d i ? Nti z i zi i mv y e ca a n e .
/
Y ou i n q u i r e h o w
Ugeenda k w
/ /
i i s ok o
many times a
week y o u r f r i end goes t o t h e mar k et . Y ou f u r t h er a sk w h a t ' h o u r o f
kaangaahe mu cuumweeru?
t he da y
he goes.
Kabi r i ca a n k e
gat;at;u.
276
B ASIC C O U R SE
U NIT 1 7
U geenda g i h e k i ?
Ngeenda saa t a t u .
Y ou see t h a t y o u r
f r i e n d h as a b asket of frui t , a nd a s k w h e r e he bough t i t . You c o mment that it is very n i c e , a nd i n q u i r e a bou t t h e p r i c e .
N abi g u z e iisoko.
/
kw
N. ivyaamwa vyiiza.
i
W abiguz
ang a a h e ? N abigu z e am a f a r a a n g a
c umi o
F ree c o n v e r s a t i o n .
D iscuss the eating habits of the people of va rious countrie s .
UNIT 18
KIRUNDI UNIT 18
BASIC DIALOGUE D ial o gu e 1 . (Continued from Dialogue for Unit; 17.) food i ndya (9 , 1 0 )
1A Iziin d i n nd y a m u f u u n gura W hat ot;her foods do you e a t ?
(14)
(8) (8)
ubus h a z a ,
ibiharage n i b ijuumpu. a
inz6ga
/
(9)
/
beer
t o dr i nk
-nywa (- nyooye)
3A M u r an y w i nz o g a m u a B uruundi ? 4B Tur an yw i nz o g a k e e n s h i . a
Do you d r i n k
b e e r i n Bur u n d i ' ?
We drink beer oft;en. t o make o f What mat;erial do you use in m aking b e e r ? sorghum
mil l et
-kuura (-kuuye)
5A Inzog a m u z i k u ura mu k i ?
amahoonda
(6)
ub'Gro (14)
6B Tuzi k u ura mu bitooke, m u mahoonda, n o
buro
mu
278
B ASIC C O U R S E
U NIT 1 8
-heza (-he3eje)
- oza ( - o g e j e )
isahaani 7A
/ /
t o f i n i sh
to wash
d ish , p l at e
(9, 6)
(-oogeesheje
t o us e wat er
in washing
amaazi
(6) )
-mera ( - meze
8B
(-koreesheje
to use
( 9, 6 )
J
( o r : i sa b u ne ) s o a P
t o b e c ome c o o l liquid ) j : used s o a p ( f oo d o r
(-hoze)
i s abu n e
9A
Nak or e e s h e j
na a ma az .
/
and c ol d w a t e r.
ahoz e .
-shuusha
1 0B Sh uu s h
( -shuuh i j e
)
a
to
heat
ama a z i , h aa n y u m
a gain .
u yasu b i r e m w o .
-hora
(-hoze)
-shuuha (-shuushe)
1 1B Du h o r a du k o r e e s h
/
a
/
a maazi a s h u u s h e ,
279
UNIT 18
KIRUNDI
-kuura (-kuuye)
ubuhoma (10)
1 2B ni y
0
/ /
to remove, extract
dir t i nes s
ak uur
u b u h om a
13A
ar i
yamara isuku
(~)
(-aanduye)
o r :i nd w a a r a
/
/
h ygi e ne ,
c l e a n li n e s s
to cont r a c t; sickness
(a di s ease)
(9, la)
a
i s uku ritwii
g ii s h a
/
gukor eesh a
/
a maaz, a s h u u s h e
i
(indwaara).
w ait ; a minu t;e and
1 $A
Eeg o n d u u mv i i s e ,
hii ng a
r
/
1 6B
Ubo n a y a a m a a z i
y aash u u s h e ? mbere
/
i n f ac t
- bi r a
( -bi z e )
280
t o boi l
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT> 8
1 7A
Eeg o , m b e r e m b o n a
a r ik 0 a r a b i r a . i zi i k o ( 5 , 6 )
/ /
stove
a li t t l e T ake it off the stove and l e t c ool a little .
/ /
gatooya
18B Ya ku u r e k u z i i k o ,
u yare k 1 9B
aho r e g a t o o y a .
Then w a s h t h o s e d i sh es i n
Haa n y u m u b o n e g u s u b i r a a k uyoozamw a y o
0
/
/ /
( th e w a t e r ) again .
m asahaani .
l.
c f.
S y nopsi s p . xx v i
).
Grammatically, these forms are >dependent<, in the sense that they are not ordinarily used as the only or as the principal verb of a complete sentence. S emantically, the Kirundi subjunctive covers approximately the same area as that which is common t o
s o-called subjunctive of Indo-European, and of other Bantu la n g uages . p resen t T h i s w i l l b e d i s cu ssed more explicitly at th e e nd o f not e . t he t he
In form, the subjunctive shares with the (non-subjunctive) perfectives the final vowel /-e/. This / - e/ , ho w e v e r , i s pr eThus>
c eded by the imperfective stem , n ot by the perfective st em . cf. Perf e c t i v e : Subj u n c t i veg
a guze. . . a gure . . .
UNIT 18
KIRUNDI
The subjunctive does not take any tense prefixes except the
/ - e/ e
tu
zi
mesuur
t hat w h i c h u n d e r l i es t h e pl ac e m ent o f t he s t e m t o n e i n m o s t ot h e r v er b forms. The location of the stem tone of the other forms is stated in terms of syllables, with the root syllable ( Unit
4,
s hort
l o n g v o w e l (two
vowel length, that is the basic unit, for calculating the position
o f the stem tone for most of the other forms of the Kirundi ve r b . In the subjunctive, on the other hand , the number of s yllables is irr elevant for the description of stem ton es . d oes count is the number of un its of vowel leng th : What
282
B ASIC C O U R S E
U NIT 1 8
d utabaar e tugur e
/
' nt i t u g u r a
From this point on, the word NOHA will be used as an equivalent f or unit the phrase < o f v ow e l l eng t h . <
In the above examples, the stem tone of all the subgunctive forms falls on the third mora of the stem except that in / t ugur e/ , which has only two moras in its stem, the tone falls on the last
mora.
[ See Ex e r c i s e s
1, 2] .
In affirmative subgunctive forms that have a single object prefix, the mora or moras of the object prefix must be counted in finding the location for the stem tone. The tone falls on the third mora of the unit which includes both the object prefix and
t he st ems t ubi g u r e
t hat w e
s h o u l d b u y/ s el l
t hem
t uzi mesuur e
t ubi r a a b e
t wi i y o z e [ See Ex er c i s e s 3, 9 . ]
283
UNIT 18
/n-/ <I>, then there is an added syllable /-da-/ between the two< t u bi b a bi -
-raab- -e
- raab- - e
n --d a - b i - - raab- - e
[ See Ex er c i s e
3. ]
simpler. The negative begins with / n t i - / , wh i ch c o m b i n e s w i t h subject prefixes in exactly the same way as for the negative indicative ( Unit 4 , No t e 2 ).
There is a high tone on th e s e c ond
mora of the word. S tem tone is low< n ti b a k u g ay e ' ntaazimire [ See Ex er c i s e 4. j so that they should not criticize you
s o that he should not get lo s t
Uses of the sub unctive. Any attempt to summarize the use of the Kirundi subjunctive
in terms of its m e aning would be fru itless
a nd c o n f u s i n g .
T he dialogues and ex er cises provide a fair sampling of the w ay s in w hich subjunctive forms are us ed : a f t e r i m p e r a tiv es , a f t e r c er The
/
t ain verbs, and af ter certain other wor d s s uch a s student is adv ised to note the kinds
/ hi i n g a /.
s epara t e l y .
of sentences in wh ich h e
{ See Exer c i s e s
2 , 3 , 4 , 9 , 10 . ]
284
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 1 8
k ugur a
e e e
Shall I buy th ese f ish? S hall they read that bo o k ? S hall we finish now ?
gusoma
guheza
r
/
Basom Duhe z
g ukor a
Ashaak a
/
days
i miis. ibiri . i
B.
/
C V VCV s t;ems.
Roree r
g uhi i s h i r a
ah i i s h i r e .
kuraaba
Zan
i y o m y e e mbe
n dayi r a a b e . g ufuungur a
/
N go duf u u n g u r e .
M uh
eat . t o h i m s o h e may
g utoor a
at; o o re .
[After each section of Ex er cise 1 has been pra c ticed by i t s e lf, it' s houl d b e c om b i n e d wi t h a l l p r e c e d i n g s e c t i o n s , s o t h a t ; t; h e student is given sen tences taken at random from all s ect;ions
k umesuur a k ugo r o o r a
um e s u u re .
r
Go do
t h e l aundr y .
G eend u g o r o o r e . a
r
gut;abaara g utegeer a
Geend Geend
a
a
ut; a b a ar e Y o h a a n i . u t ;e g e e r
/
i nk a .
UNIT 18 D. CV s t ems.
/
KIRUNDI
k ur y a
N tiwoor o r e e r a
/
n g o t ur y e ? ng o n y we?
/
kunywa
N tiwoondor e er a
e
kubla
kuva
L et>s l e a v e h e r e .
E.
T h e s t e m / -za/ . Hi i ng a z e t ur aa b e . a
/
k uuz a
g u s o ma.
/
kvlUubak-
Ngo t w u u b a k
i n zu h a n o .
a ho u s e
kwiiyoza kwaambara
kwooza kuuzana
in y a ma
u zan
i
e
/
a m a s a haa n i . i ny a m a .
e
G eenda mu g i k o o n G eenda mu g i k o o n
u zan
guteeka
u tee k
i ny a m a .
286
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 18
indya
/
G eenda mu g i k o o n . . ut ee k i ndy a . e i
Qeenda mu g i k oon . ury i n dy a . i e
/
kur ya umukaate
k ur o o n d e r a ibitaambara ibiyiiko
ooni . u ro o n de r
/ /
umu k a a t e . i b i t aambara. ib i y i i k o .
/ /
e e
e
u r o o nder
/
amasahaani kwooza
/
w ooz
a m a s ahaan i .
Exercise 3. S u bjunctive after imperative: O b ject prefixes after 1 sg . w i t h /-da-/ vs. other persons and numbers without / -da-/ . >Bring the fruit so we c an l o o k i t ov e r . < kuraaba g upii m a
k ugur a
/
Z an
i v y a a mw a tu bigure .
/
kurya
i v y a a mwa nda b i r y e .
B.
<. . . s o t h a t , t h ey . . . <
/
k ur a a b a g upi i m a k ugur a
a
a a
i mp u u z u n d a zi r aa b e . i m p u u z u n d a z ipiime . i mp u u z u n da z i gu r e .
/
Z an
Z an Zan
a a
i m p uuzu b a z i r a a b e .
i m p u u z u b a z ipiim e . i mp u u z u b a z i gu r e .
/
kwaambara
Z an
im p u uzu ndazaambare.
Z an. i m p u uz u b a z aambare . a
287
U NIT l 8
KIRUNDI
/
kumesuura k ugoroo r a
C.
<. . .s o t h a t I . . . >
gushuvzha
k ur a a b a kunywa
am a a z
/
ayashuushe.
/
Z an
a a a
am a a z i n da y a s h u u s h e .
Z an a m aa z ay a ra a b e . a Z an a m aa z ay a n y w e . a
/
Z an
Z an
a m a az i n d a y a r a a b e .
am a a z i n da y a n y w e .
/
Exerci s e
/
0.
Nega t ; i v e s u b j u n c t i v e .
/
kuzimira
ufa s h e nt;aazimire.
kwaandura
kugaya
K ora n e ez a n t ; i b a k u g ay e .
you.
/
jeewe
K ora n e ez a
s i i n d a kugaye.
p lai n
a b out y o u .
Exer c i s e 5 ,
a m a s ahaani.
e k wa a n d i k
i k e et 'e .
Naahejeje gupiim
a m a g i..
288
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 18
kurya gukaraba
kwaambar a
N aahejej e N aahej ej e
kurya. gukaraba.
Naahe j e j e kwaambam.
Exerc i s e
6.
kwoogeesha
kunywa
/
W anyooy
a m a a z i a me z aat e ?
inzoga kugura
isabuuni ibiriibwa k ur y a
/
W anyooy i n z5 g i m e z i i t e ? e a e W aguz
Waguz W aguz
e e e
i n z o g i me z i i t e ? a e
i s a bu un
/ /
i me z
i i t e?
i b i r i i bwa bimeze bi t e ?
W ariiy
e
e
inyama
u mukaat e
/
W arii y
/
i ny a m a z i m e z e z i t e ?
W ariiy um ukaat u m e z u u t e ? e e e
Exer c i s
e 7.
Th e v er b
/ -hor a/ .
u s e h ot wa t e r . > ama a z
/ /
>We al w ay s
/
g ukor e e s h a k ur y a k wi i y o z a
Duhor a
dukor eesh
/
a s h u u sh e .
D uhora tur y
i m b o g a n y i i n shi .
/
UNIT 18
KIRUNDI
jeewe
M pora nk o r e e s h
am a a z i a s h u u s h e .
E xercise 8 .
aku u r
/
ubu h o m a .
/
isaabune
k uz i i m b a
Isaabune ni y Isaabune ni y
/
i k uu r u b u homa. 0 a
0
i z i imvye.
/ /
n i zo zi zi i m vye.
0
AmKgi ni y
a z i imvye.
0
0
umudu.ga
i mi d u g a
Umuduga ni w
I miduga
u z i imvye.
izi i m v y e .
niy
E xerci s e 9 . p ref i x .
<
r
amaazi.
H ii n g a H ii ng a
ndayashuushe. nd a b i s h uushe .
H ii ng a
H ii n g a
/
n d a wur y e .
n dawuteeke .
/
H iinga nteek
290
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 18
t;weebwe kugura
k ur a a b a
Hiinga tuwut;eeke. H ii ng a H ii ng a
/
t u wugure . t u wuraabe.
H ii n g a
t ;uraa b
u mu ce r i .
Exer c i s e
10 .
Su b j u n c t i v e wi t h
/ - r e k a/ .
< Leave i t ( th e w a t e r ) t h a t
e e e e e
a sh u u h e .
Rek
a m aa z abi r e .
/
ab i r e . ah o r e . u ho r e . ushe, zi she.
/ /
R ek a m a az . a h o r e . a i R ek u m u c er . u h o r e . a i R ek u m u c er . u s h e . i a R ek i ny a m a z i s h e . a R ek
/
Z ir ek e
guhora
i ny a m a z i h o r e .
Z ir ek e z i h o r e .
Pract;ice conversat;ions.
A banyaameerik a
/
barary
Bararim i m yeembe
muri Ameerika ? A bo mu b u m a n u k o
b aray i r i m a . 291
U NIT l 8
2.
KIRUNDI
Naahej ej e impuuzu.
/
k u m esuur a
W ameshuu j
amaazi
a yaho z e . Ni k u k . i e
ut aak o r e e s h e j
ayashuushe?
3.
A s an empl o y e e , y ou r e p o r t ; 0 h a t ; t he s u p pl y o f soap i s e x h a u s t ;ed.
Y ou a s k w h e th e r
I sabune y a a s A i z e .
Geend
u gu r
i yi i ndi .
y ou s h o ul d g o i mmediat e l y .
Ngeende k u y i g u r
ubu ? O ya bur a ) a an a s a a
s it a .
4
You a r e a n em-
angaahe?
Nayi g u z
/
a ma f a r a a n g a
iyo
292
B ASIC C O U R SE
U NIT 1 8
m akeeya?
Waguz e
iyiziimvye.
/
Yaanziimvye, mugabo
ni n zi i z a .
293
UNIT 19
KIRUNDI UNIT 19
ntaa
u rut o o f a n y i
( 11, 1 0 )
p otat o
m waateet s e ? h ii n g a
2B
/ /
(>Are there not potatoes t hat y o u c o o k e d ? > ) w ait ! Wait, let me go see. (>Wait that I may go to examine. < )
t ha t W hat about it ? I t h ink that
( or: h i i n g e)
Hi i n g a n j e k u r a a b a .
there aren't any of them. koko 4B Waab i m enye kokof trul y You wer e r i gh t . t r u l y . <)
t o f ee d
( >You kn ew
- gabur i y a
( -gaburi y e )
5A Ng ab u r i r a umu c e r i , n a Give me ( >feed me> ) r i c e
a nd me a t .
inyama.
2.
Prep a r i n g
/
Ri c e
6c
Ej
u m u c e r i n a r i iy e uur y oo s h e .
w ar . i
294
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 19
7C
H ow is r i c e co o k e d ? (<Rice, h ow do t h e y c o o k i t ? > ) Y ou t a k e r i c e a n d t h e n y o u
wash it; in clean cold wat'er.
8D
Ufat
um u c e ri, ukawuroonga
meez
mu maaz i
ahoz e . pot
inkono -suka 9D
(9, 10)
( -sut s e )
t o p ou r
i nt o
Haany u m uk a w u s uk a muu a
/ /
n kon
i r imw
aam a a z
k u zi i k o .
0
i nk on
i mez e
i safu r i y a
1 1D
(9, 6)
Us h o b o r a k uw u t e e k a m w
I k i r uundi . W hen i t i s d on e , t ;h e n w h a t ?
12C
U h i i y u m u unt, agir e u a
a at e ?
( >.. . h o w d oe s a p e r s o n d o ? < )
-uumuuka 1 3D Um u c e r
(-uumuuts e
t ;o ge t
dr y
ur y oo h a w u umuut s e .
Rice t;ast;es good when it doesn't contain much wat;er. cover, lid of a Kirundi po t c oal s cover of a k e t tle
igipfuundikizo amakara
u mufu n i k o
(7, 8)
(6)
(3, 4)
295
as h u u s h e k u a
is a f u r i y a .
hot
m ufuniko w
umuunyu
/
(3)
1 5C
a t a a mu u n y u w a v u z e ?
m entio n e d . >
- koza ( - k o j e g e )
16D Abaantu bamwe bashiima gushi r
/
t o ea t
wi t h co n d i m e n t s
um u u n y u muu k u wukoza .
m boga zo
3.
imaangaziini ( 9, 10 o r
1(E Har in t o o f a ny i z i sigaye
/
6)
Are there some potatoes in t he storeroom ye t ?
m u maangaziini ?
uy u
ar i z
/
Cook
th em.
Na a h e j e j e ku z i h a r u r a n o k uz i r o o n g a .
2 1F
No o n e n zi t e e k a a n t e ?
N ow how d o
c o ok
0h em ?
z96
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 19
'
t o fr y
or r oas t ;
amav u t , a
G o on a n d I <1 1 s h o w y o u t; h e f at ; t o u s e .
ay o ma v u t ; a .
N g o n kw e e r e k e .
I [ >l l j s how
n tuuz e
2 7E
1.
A n o t e o n t he
rese n t a t i ve forms.
O ne type of verbless sentence in Kirundi has as it s n u cleus a PRESENTATIVE fo rm . in t ; h e s e s en t e n c e s : E x a m p l e s of p r e s entatives are found
UNIT 19
KIRUNDI
Zan in toofanyi. a
N gii z i .
Ngi i z o
Ngaay
a ma f a r a a n g a n a z a n y e .
These
t he following formula :
/ng/ plus demonstrative with the first vowel long; the first mora has a provi.sional high tone ( Unit 1 and the last has an anticipated high tones
>This i s h e, et c .
, Not e 8 ) ,
C l.
nguuyu
/
nguuyo ngaabo n gi i r y o
ngaaba n gi i r i
/
ngaaya
etc.
ngaayo
nguuyo
nguuno
nguurya ngaabary a
etc.
/
n guu r i i y a
r r
ngaabo
etc.
ngaabano
etc.
ngaabar i i y a
etc.
298
BASIC C O U R S E
UNIT19
The third of these series (/ nguuno/, / ngaabano/ etc.) is not; used by all speakers of Kirundi.
A presentative form may be u sed as the only word in a s entence . I t m a y a l s o be u sed fo llowed by a n o un , as i n c Ngiik. igit'abo caange. i Thi s h e r e i s my b o o k .
( <Thi s i s
it,
my book. >)
N giikirya igitabo caanje . Ther e i s my b o ok . e noun, in turn, may also be followed by a r e l a tive
verb, as in the t;hird of the above examples. present;ative forms, see Exercises 5, 6].
-ri
I >m a Eu r o p e a n . U racaar .
/ /
Pers i s t i v e r
u musore ?
N on-re c e n t '
U muceri . . . w a r.
i
was
u uryooshe .
I mm. P a r t i c i p : I mm. R e l : M bon
( cf .
They
St c . 6}
l oo k good
a
0
ar i nziiza.
to me. ar
t ha t h e i s A meri c a n .
. .. k
U munyaameeri k a .
Non- r e c . Re l y
. ..i g ihe
y a r i han o .
. . . t h e t i me h e
w as he r e . ( Unit 1 6 ,
S tc. 1 6 )
T he s t e m /-ri/ is inflect;ed for mood (indicative, participial, relative and au tonomous) and for four of t;he t;enses
299
UNIT 19
KIRUNDI
f ol l ow t h e sa m e
patt e r n
syllable, forms which for most verbs have high tone on the p ost;-
radical syllable (e. g. the immediate relative ) will have high t one o n t h e / -ri /
ari
i t s el f <
~ .
. .who i s <
(rel a t i v e )
In the same way, the prefix tone of the participial, which for most' verbs falls on the first vowel after the first; consonant, will fall on /-ri/ if the subject prefix is monophonicc ari
r
>he bei n g . .
.<
(participial)
Sample forms are given in the t;able below, which is t'aken from Meeussen (p. 106). Each set contains a 3 pl. form as an example
of the forms with diphonic subject prefixes, 3 sg. as a representative of the forms with monophonic vowel prefixes, and 1 sg. as
the form with monophonic nasal prefix .
PART. bari
r
REL. bari
r
abar i uwul i
r
ari
ndi nc1 i nc1 i
300
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT lg
Hodi e r n a l
baar i
baari yari
/
abaari uwari
yari
nari
H est e r n a l
nari baari
y ar i nari b aki r i a ki r i n ki r i
/
/
baari yari
nar i
/
abaari
uwari
Pers i s t
b ak'i r i .1 a ki r i n ki r i
a bak i r i u wuki r i .
/
Varr .
bar a c a a r i , a r a c a a r i , nda c a a r i .
IND.
/
PART.
/
BEL.
/
Zmm.
n ti b a r i
b at a r i a tar i n tar i
!
b at a r i
/
n tar i
sindi
a tar i
n tar i b ataar i
a taar i n taar i
/
H odier n a l
/
ntibaari
nti y a r i s inar i n ti b a a r i
/
ba t a a ri
a taar i n taar i b at a a r i
/ /
a bataar i
uwut aa r i
/
H es ter n a l
b at a a r i a taar i n ta a r i b atakir i
/
a bat a a r i
/
n ti y a r i s inar i
a taar i
/ /
u wut a a r i
Pers i s t
abat a k i r i
a tak i r i
n tak i r i
u wutak i r i
n tak i r i 301
UNIT 19
KIRUNDI
Forms that contain /-ri/ never contain an object prefix. They may, however, be followed by the locative enclitics / -ko/ , / - h o/ , ( cf . / - y o / , / - m w o / , or t ; h e i n t er r o g a t i v e l o ca t i v e enclitic /-he/ . Un i t 3 , Not e 4. ). [ F o r p r a c tice with some of the fo rms that; /-ri/, see Exercises 1-4.]
Apparently not completely subsumed by the f o r egoing ar e t he data of Ex er cise 10 s
c ontai n
a r imw
/
in z '6ga.
B ri n g t h e k e t t l e s w ith beer in th em .
i s a f u r iya zirim w a a m a a z i .
0
tive. ( 2)
r
of /-mwo/ undergoes normal elision, but before nouns of the ot'her c lass e s (e. g. /amaazi/, above), the vowel is not; lost. Instead,
3.
-te
< to d o
how?<
. . . h o w d o e s a p e r s on d o ?
( Sentenc e
12)
302
B ASIC C O U R S E
UWn 19
/Nzi t e ekaante? /
M oo g e e s h e j am a a z i
H ow do I
c o o k 0 h em?
(Sentence 21
a
a mez
aa t e ?
These verbs have certain peculiarities~ ( 1) T h e y a l w ays o c cur after some other ver b .
(2) Unlike the participial forms of other verbs, these verbs never hav~ the tone on the last syllable, even when the subject prefix is monophonic. (cf. Unit 16, Note 2
).
(Q) The final vowel of the preceding word is usually lengthened if the vowel of the syllable which precedes it, is short (cf. the second example, above. ) . Len g t h e n i n g a l s o o c c u r s ,
of course, before the 1 sg. form, which begins with a nasal plus a nothe r c o n s onant
( /nt-/ ) .
> Ii m n o t S ind
a Bel gi an . <
je e we wewe
N d. Umunyaameri k a .
i
/
U m ubirigi.
Ur
/
U m u nyaameri k a .
/
we tweebwe
mweebwe bo
/
N . Umunyaameri k a .
i
T ur
Nuri
A b a n y a amer i k a .
/
N titur
A b a n y a amer ik a .
A b a n y aamer i k a .
303
U NIT l g
KIRUNDI
Exercise 2.
>He arrived when I was at the market;.< (<...I being at, the market.< )
je e we N agiiye kw iisoko . Y ashitse ndi kw iisoko . wewe
/
Yohaani
tweebwe
Twaagiiye kw iis5ko.
Yashitse turi kw iisi5ko.
mweebwe
Mwaagiiye kw iisoko.
Y ashitse muri kw iisoko .
bo
Exer c i s e
3.
Th e v e r b /-ri/, affirmative vs. negative participial. <Does h e l o ok t o y ou l ike a Belgian ? > <He seems t o m e n ot b e a B e l g i an . < M bon Mbon M bon Mbon t o
Umubirigi umuzuungu
/
U bon
a a a
a r . Umubirigi? i
a a
a a
U bon
U bon U bon
a r . um u z u u n gu ?
i
/ /
umwiigiisha u mudaand a z a
/
ar
/
umw i i g i i s h a ?
/
a r . u mu d a a n d a z a ? a i
3O4
B ASIC C O U R SE
U NIT
19
umusore
U bon a r . um u s o r e ? a i
M bon a t ar a
umus o r e .
abasore
a baka r a a n i
/
Ubon a r a
Ubon U bon
abas o r e ?
a b ak a r a a n i ?
/
/
a t a r . a b a s or e . i a t ar
/
ar
a b ak ar a a n i .
/
a bazuu n g u Abahi i nd i
ar . a b a zu u n g u ? a i
a t a r . a ba zu u n g u . a i
Ubon
Ubon
a a
a r . A b a h i i nd i ?
ar Abany a a f i r i k a ?
a a
atar
/
Aba h i i n d i .
/
A banyaafirik a
a t a r , A b a ny aafirika .
t h a t t h e y a r e h e r e. >
i micuungwa y o o s e
Mbon
i r i hano .
/ /
Y avuz e
k
/
ir i
h an o .
amKgi
A magi y o o s e a r i
Mbon
han o ?
ha n o . k
0
/
ar i
Yavuz e abaana
/
ar i
hano .
Abaana
boose bar i
/ /
hano ?
Mbona b a r i Yavuz e
/
hano . ko ba r i
/
hano .
i bi.cer i
Yavuz e
305
UNIT 19 inkono
/ /
h an o .
ko zi r i hano .
[It is suggested that, the student or instructor devise a num b er of similar exercises for practicing contrasts among the va riou s
f orms o f
/ -ri / . ]
Exercise 5. Two sets of presentative forms. < Bring p o t a t o e s . < Zan i n toofanyi. < Here t h e y Ngii z i
/
/
are. >
are. <
Z an u m u c e r i . a Z an
Zan
Nguuwu.
Ngi i k i .
a
a
i gi t uu n g u r u .
u r u t or e .
Z an a m a s h u . a Z an i k ar a a mu . a
/
Z an i s ab u n i . a
Zan a abaan a .
N gii y i .
Ngaaba .
E xercise 6 .
P r e s e n t a t ive with relative verbs . <Here are the potatoes we cooked [todayj. <
/ /
N giiz
i n t o o f a nyi twaateetse .
N gaay
a m agi n a z a ny e .
go6
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 19
g ukora a k a z i
N gaak
kwoogeesha amaazi
kurimiisha isuka
a k a z i na k o z e .
E xerc i s e 7 . / Ntaa/ plus noun plus relative verb. S ubstitution i n Sentence 1 . <Didn>t you cook any potatoes?< (>Aren>t there potatoes that you cooked'?>) guteeka intoofanyi k ugura i b i t uu n g u r u i m p u u zu Ntaa ntoofanyi mwaateetse?
/
Ntaa bituunguru mwaaguze? Ntaa mpuuzu mwaamesuuye? Ntaa Yohaani N taa k a z i m waaboonye?
k umesuura
m w a akoze ?
k urya
i b i t uu n g u r u
/
kuvooma amaazi,
E xerc i s e
8.
IThere a r e n ' t
s o me>.
a ren>t
any. >
) )
Hari intoofanyi?
N gira
ngo 'ntaazo.
H ar H ar
i m Xhwi ? i bi t uun g u r u ?
N gira N gir a
307
KIRUNDI
i nt or e ? i s ab u n i ?
i gi t abo ?
N gira n g o ' n t a a z o . N gira N gir a N gira ngo 'ntaayo. ngo 'ntaaco. ngo 'ntaarwo.
...zi r
Xho.
...i r Xho.
. . . k i r Xh o . . ..r ur j ho,
>I feel
h u ngry. >
h u ngry. <
> Give ( > f e e d > ) me r i c e . > Ngaburi r Nugaburi r Tugaburi r Bagaburi r a e e e umu c e r i . umu c e r i . umu c e r i . umu c e r i .
a s h o on j e .
Sub-
>I don>t know the way they use this fat. >
/
g ukoreesha amavut a
k ugeen d e e s h a umuduga
/
k urya
i n y a ma i m b o ga i n z5ga
i z o nyama.
kuroonga g ukuura
i nz 5ga .
308
B ASI C COU RS E
UNrT 19
kugaburira imashiini
auteeka umuceri
u m u ceri.
E xercise 11 .
( <in w h i c h i s wa t e r . <)
/ / /
i saf u r i y a inz6ga
ikiyiiko, umuunyu
ibiyiiko
/ /
i m f u ungurwa.
/
umuduga ,
u m u dug
uri m w
isa a n s i..
S u b s t i t u tion in
( ~.. . h ow
agir a u h i i y e' , u mu u n t u
at e?
at e?
/
309
Amash a h iiye, umuunt a g ira ate? u u Intoofanyi zihiiye, umuunt a g ira ate?
l ntoofany Umucer . i zihoz e', umuuntu a g ira ate? u muunt u a g ira ate?
uh o z e' ,
Amaazi ashuush e' , umuunt a g ira ate? u Imblga zishuush e' , umuunt a g ira ate? u I mb5ga z i h e z e', umuunt a gira ate? u A mafaraan g ahe ze', umuunt a g ira ate? a u
/
[NB The comma in each of these sentences represents an optional pause. If 0he pause is made, the final vowel of the word that p recedes i t m u s t of cour s e b e p r o n o u n c e d . j
Exercise 13. T ones on monophonic and diphonic prefixes with /-tej. S ubstitution in Sentence 7'.
a)
3 pl . and 2 sg.
> How do t h e y cook r i ce'?>
>How do Uwutee k Uzi t e e k Ubi t e e k you c o o k i t ?>
umuceri i ntor e
i bi t oo ke
Umuceri bawuteeka bate? Intore baziteeka bate? Ibitooke babiteeka bate'? Imboga baziteeka bate' ?
ut e?
a ut e?
a a
ut e?
I
imb5ga
Uzit e e k
ut e?
310
B ASIC C O U R S E
UNIT 19
b)
3 sg. and 2 pl .
> How does sh e cook v egetabl es ? < < How do y o u (p1.) cook t h e m'?> N uzit e ek a mute '?
imb5ga
i bi t oo ke i nt or e
I mbog a
Ibitook
az i t eek K t e ? a e
a b i t e e k Kte ?
M ubiteeka mute ?
umuceri
E xerc i s e 1 4 . s yl l a b l e s .
Vowel length before /-te/ after long and short Substitution in Sentence 7. < Rice, how do you c ook i t ' ?> u w u t e e k ut e ? >How do yo u Uwugur Uzigu r U bigu r U yagur Uzigu r a sel l i t ?<
Umucer
a a
I ntoofany u z iteek
ute?
inyama
u t e '?
Npegej 311
ubu .
UNIT 19
KIRUNDI
N dayajaane k u u p o o s i t a ' ?
z aa > t i m b r e s < .
2.
Ntaa
<timbres t mfise.
stamps.
(>I
)
Ndazifise nyiinshi. U keneye z i i n g a a h e '?
/
T wo te n f r a n c
[stamps].
Zibiri z amafaraang a a
/ /
/
i cum, imw
iimwe.
Ngiizi shirako.
312
BASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 20
UNIT 20 REVIEW Exercise l. I d entify the following indicative con/unct verb forms for tense. R e spond by supplying the appropriate time e xpres s i o n . a. Subject prefix consisting of a vowel (/u/ ) c ounte r p a r t ; (/w/). uboony
e
o r i t s n ons y l l a b i c
i ki ? e e e i ki ? i k i '? i ki ?
uyu muusi
Ubu
i ki ?
/
wasaanz
i k i '?
uyu muusi
ego
uyu muusi
/
w ariiy
iki?
ego
313
UNIT 20
KIRUNDI
baaboony
b aaboon y b aasa an z b asaan z
ego
u yu mu u s i ubu
e e
baasaanz
i ki ?
uyu muusi
ego
uyu muusi
/
ego
[After completing both halves of Exercise 1, the instructor should give the students lines from both halves, selected a t r a n d o m. j [After the students have completed this phase of the exercise,
t he instructor should add verbs in the imm edia t e , recent
314
B ASIC C O U R SE
U NIT 2 0
Exercise 2. Co n trast among participial, relative and indicative forms. T his exercise may be done with either the English or
t he K i r u n d i a a t h~ cu e .
Umucer
u hi i y e ,
(turawurya.
Umucer
uhl i y e
( 'ni mwiiza. )
Umucer
u r ah i i y e,
( ari k o . . . ) (urageenda.) (n
ukwaakabi r i .
U kweezi k u b o n e t s e ,
When th e m o on c omes up . . .
U kweezi k u b o n e t s e
T he moon t h a t has app e a r e d . . . T he moon h a s risen, W hen th e w a t e r i s hot . . . Mater that is h ot . . . The wate r hot, i s
U kweezi k u r a b o n e t s e ,
/
A maaz
a s huushe,
A maaz
/
a s huushe,
/
( ni y o ak u ra ubu h oma. )
A maaz
/
a r a s huushe,
/
( ariko . . . )
( umbari r e .
Abaana
bavyuut se ,
W hen t h e
ch i l -
dren g e t
u p. . .
A baana ba v y u u t s e
(bakwiiye kwiiyoza.)
T he c h i l dr ' e n t ha t h a v e
gott e n A baana b a r a v y u u t s e .
up. . .
( ari k o . . . )
T he ch i l d r e n a re u p .
315
UNIT 20
KIRUNDI
The r i ce i s done .
The rice is getting done
3. 4. 5. 6.
T h e one [i. e. the bookj that is heavy... The vegetables are wilted. V e g e tables that are wilted... Those [vegetables) that are wilted...
7.
8.
9.
14..
1 5.
TWO-LINE CONVERSATIONS 1. Nd o r a k u u B . B . A . a r i k o
n taho n z i
ne e z a .
316
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 20
2.
Nd a g u s a a n g
mu h i r a k u
i nz u .
early in the morning [i. e. around 8 a.m.]. If you don>t find me there, I >11 b e d o w n b e l o w t h e house.
S i kur e .
I t i sn < t f ar .
U rwo r u r i m i
/ /
r w o h aakurya
/ /
That; language from abroad (>the other side of the water< ) i s n < t e a s y . But it isn<t harder than
Engl i s h .
S o yi i t w a
nde?
Ngo s h o o b u j
ar i
kw
1 hear y o u r b o s s i s at t h e hospi t a l .
i ivuur i r o ?
/
Yes,
h e t o o k h i s d au gh t er .
KIRUNDI I s 1 00 0 f r a n c s e n o u g h f o r them?
a rabakwi i r a
e
7.
ik
uy u
i nda g a r a .
8.
haambavu y
i s5k o .
9.
Amafaraanga y a an g heehe'?
ar i
Where is my money'?
Here
1 0. Ubwooko b w
i z o mp u u z u
z ir emeer ey e g u t y o
b ut u r u k h h e g a nt u ?
318
B ASIC C O U R S E
U NIT 2 P
Ariko
r e e ro n
i zi va
si nke.
Many come from Europe. (>But in addition the ones that come from America are not
few. ~)
m uri Ameerik a
1 2. A h
u r o r e er ey
i ki ?
/
N dore e r e y
u mu v u u k a n y i
o f my b o s s .
w a daat a b u g a .
ni w a r e e n gaan
/
Follow this road and when you get to the forge, y ou>11 b e t h e r e ( >you wi l l have a r r i v e d t he r e < ).
u rugaanda , u shi t s e h o . Al
/
uzoob a
n . i r y a n z i h er a u i zoose?
/
A h)
W ho is y o u n g er , y o u o r y ou r s ist e r ?
one.
good
Eego n i. nz i i z a , k aand Y es, it is, and it is l i g h t
[ too. ]
i rahwahut s e .
319
UNIT 20
KIRUNDI
16.
i n zu ni
i s a hotel .
H ow ta l l
J ohni s
( bi g ,
old )
i s
s i s t er ?
His s i s t e r ( bi gg er ,
i s mu c h t al l er ol d e r ) t han h e .
D on>t y o u
h av e an y o r a n g es'?
1 9.
Ni k uk i Yoh a a ni . avuga
b uhor o ? Ni b u h o r o ar i k o
r
/
Why does John speak so softly / slowly? It ( I hi s s p e a k i n g ] ) i s soft, but, it isn>t bad.
si
naabi..
20.
U r a s h i ima kw i ig a I kir u u n d i ?
D o you en ) oy s t u d y i n g
Kir u n d i ?
J eewe
s i ns h i . i m a k u c i i g a . 320
K ir a g o oy e .
B ASIC C O U R SE
U NIT 2 0
21.
Qu t aambuka no guhita
I "hM
different?
biraf'ia itaandukaaniro? e
0! B i f i s ita a n d u k a aniro e r ini ni ! O h, theywre quite different !
22. Waguz
i m b oga zikavye.
2 3,
I yo m p uuzu y a ashi z e .
I d o n > t h a v e m o n ey .
H elp me, and give me som e
(>a few I f r a n c s ] I ).
Practice conversations.
You say
want week,
t h a t y ou
t o go t o
K ayanza n e x t
an d as k
y our
f r i en d
h e has
U ramaze k u j K y o ?
M aze kujay
0
whet he r
ibihe
b itaanu .
/
H ari
am a h o o t e e r i, a n ga a h e ?
321
KIRUNDI
/
Har
aa t at u .
A mez a a t e ?
e
pri c e o f ac c omodati o n s .
You e x p r e s s y o u r a ppr e c i a t i on , and t h a n k y ou r friend, for his h el p .
I mwe muriyo n i
n zi i z a g u su u m b a i zi i ndi .
/
u shaaka k i r i m w o . N zoobah
a mafaraang
angaahe? B izoova k u u n z u
uzoofata n i m i is a uzoomarKho.
/ / /
i r i hano
ni
n zi i . za .
N ayiguze ku Muziinda . Uramaze kuhashi ka ?
W a y ig u z l h e ?
B ASIC C O U R SE
U NIT 2 0
w hat h e t here .
does You as k
Uhor
u g ay o gukor
H im what h e
t r a de s i n . Y ou ask h o w busin es s s e e ms t o be g o i n g . U daandaz5y
0
i i k i .' ?
N daanda z a y
/
Ivy
a ubu d a a n daza ,
dukeeduke.
323
UNIT 21
KIRUNDI
U NIT 2 1
BASIC DIALOGUE - t e e mb e r e z a
/
t o c a us e
to go about
( - t e ember e j e
1A
)
G o take the children to th e
U ge gut e embere z
a
/
aba a n a
p ark t o d a y .
Ndabajaana nka-
giheki ?
W hat t i m e
shal l
I t ak e t hem ?
a s, l i k e
/
3A
N ka saa t a a n u Nk a i s a h a z i t aa n u ,
/
By el e v e n , s o a s t o br i ng them back for lunch at ( >so t h a t at n oo n noon. you return with them to
s aa si t
ubaga r u k a n e
eat.>)
(9, 10)
e A re t h e y s u p p o se d t o w e a r
hats?
wearin g
( <Do they g o
hats? > ) p r o t ec t
(they)
( -r i i n z e )
t o guard , sun
(5)
E e , k a an d . u b ar i i n d e i
/
(7, 8)
0
N ab oon y e h a ri h
ib l t i .
igituutu
(7)
B ASI C CO U RS E
UNIT
21
7B
Si v y i i z a ku g a a n a
I sn' t
i t [ a ] go o d [ i d e a ] t o
abaana mu gituutu
caavyo?
2.
/
mouth t ha t o v er t her e
ur y a m w aa n af ' s a e mu k a nwa?
Hi i nga nd a a b e . N. i f ar aa n g a .
L et me s e e . It>s a piece of money. to try Prom now on, try to keep him from putting things in his mouth.
-gerageza ( -geragej e )
1 1C Kuv a uy u m u u s i,
It
uk o
nshoboye.
1 3E
Um w aa n ar c he ? a iki go
W here i s
t he baby? back y a r d
(7, 8)
( -i i c a y e )
a n en c l o s e d
t o be se a t e d
-iicar a i vya a t s i
(8)
325
grass
UNIT 21
KIRUNDI
-kina (-kinye)
14F A r i m u kigo yiicaye mu vyaat s - hava ak i na . ( - h avuuye)
to do
a s a co n s e q u e n c e
-guma (-gumye)
1 5E Ur ar aa b a n t a a h a v e aguma ku z u u b k inin i
/
to stay ( You) w a t c h o u t s o h e do e s n > t stay in the sun a long time, and consequently get sick.
a i gi he a ar wa a r a .
y oo h a v
-ryaama (- r y aamye )
1 6F Nah a a n d i n y e n e ,
/
-ruhuuka ( -ruhuutse )
17E I g i h e caa saa sit
/
( you ( p l . ) ) f e e d h i m ,
then bathe him, and put him to bed so he gets s ome re s t .
a u mwooze,
ubone kumuryaamik
a ruh u u k e .
18F
Ni
v y oo s e n k w i i y e g ukora ? inzoka
(9, 10)
snake
326
BASIC CO U R SE
UNIT 2 1
19E
d on>t b i t e
( >eat<) h i m .
nka-
n ka sa a t a a n u
11 a. m.
7,
N ot e 1 ) , i s
Som e
Nka Yohaani
y o okubari r a .
s e e Exerci ses 6 , 7 . ]
2.
in the shade of th em
[i. e. the trees, Cl. 8] t he wor d /caavyo/ contains two concordial morphemes.
The f i r st
/igituutu/ (Class 7). The second concordial morpheme is represented in this word by /-vy-/ (Class 8) and agrees with /ibXti/. 327
UNIT 21
KIRUNDI
Xngo zaabo
i nyama ya ay o inyama zaazo
their
( Cl, 2 ) f a r ms ( Cl . l O )
( Cl. 9 ) ]
meat ( C l . 10 ) o f t h e m [ e . g . c hick en s ( Cl. 1 0 ) ] book o f it
ibi t ab o v y aaco
/
[ e. g .
K i r u ndi ( Cl . 7) ]
b a a co
/
people of it [e. g. the city (Cl. 7)] beyond it [e. g. street ( Cl. 5 ) ] n ear ( C 1 . 9 ) t h e m [ e . g . hou s e s ( Cl. 1 0 ) ]
yaaryo
yaazo
The general formula for the non-personal possessives is: Concord 1 pl u s /aa/ p l u s
C oncord 2
p l u s /o/
-0
-aaetc .
-ch-
3, 4. ]
3. A
In Unit 3 , Note 2
i ntr o d u c ed a
t hi s
chil d
[ h er e ]
urya mwaana
328
B ASIC C O U R S E
U NIT Pl
u taam b u t s e
rirya ...
when y o u
cr o ss t h a t
one
(i.
i rya
/
e . / i ba r a b a r a / Cl as s 5 )
h o u s e [ ther e ]
nzu
t hat
b arya b a a n t u
The general formula for this series of demonstratives is< Concord with high tone, plus /rya/ but if the concordial prefix is monophonic, the tone is pronounced on /rya/ and not on the prefixa
C l. 1
urya
A not e o n t h e u s e o f
UN1T 21
KIRUNDI
Sentence
. ..kumuriinda ntaashi r
i b i intu
putting things
i nto his mou th .
mu kanwa T hese t w o
this point, see Exercise 2, ] [ This note is typical of many that could be written concerning the use of the subjunctive, infinitive, participial or other form of any verb when it follows certain specified verb stems. The student should be alert to these matters, and compile his own lists of verbs that are followed by certain m oods o f ot h e r v e r b s . ]
5.
A note on the conditional tense. Examples of the conditional tense have been encountered
Itd like it .
noobuzwa n
i i ki ?
/
yoombaza, n o omuf a s ha
me, I would help him In the last of the above examples, the conditional is u sed i n
b oth clauses . N o t e t h a t , although the second clause may b e
B ASIC C O U R SE
U NIT
21
/ - z oo- /
t ense.
With respect to its meaning, 0he Kirundi conditional
is fairly close to the so-called conditional forms of certain Indo-European languages. The conditional in some languages is c al l e d a >mood>, but in Kirundi the conditional marker /-oo-/
is mutually exclusive with the markers for immediate, hodiernal, hesternal, and future tenses, and so is itself called a >tense. I The conditional has no affirmative participial form, but all other combinations of affirmative and negative with the four moods(indicative, participial, relative, autonomous ) are
f ound.
Separate conjunct and disjunct forms exist for the immediate affirmative, but for high verbs only, since the only difference between the two linkages is that conjunct has low stem tone where
(Cj) (Dj )
What would they do? Would they do my work'? What would they
ak a z i k aa n j e ?
b ut t
Soofuungu r
i ki ?
(Cj)
eat ".
Would they eat'?
B oofuungur a ' ?
(Dj)
a per so n wh o c o u l d h elp y o u . . .
"
All other conditional forms have low stem tone: Uwogutabaara n i Y oha a n i . [ A pe r s o n ] w h o c o u l d h elp y o u i s J oh n . I A per s on ] wh o woul d n ot h e l p y o u i s John.
Uwutoogutabaara n i Yohaani.
331
U NIT 2 1
KIRUNDI
N ote that in di sjunct forms that have an ob j ect prefix , t he stem tone remains on the root syllable and not on th e ob j e c t . T his contrasts with the tonal behavior of infinitives I
t o hel p t o hel p I hi m
w o u l d h el p
6.
Ad hortative forms. The dialogues of this unit include the following: a From now on , Stc. 15
i
tr y t o. . . <Watch ou t . ..<
Ur ar a aba . . .
T he underlined verbs are here translated into English as imp era t ives, but they are quite different in form from the simp l e i mper a t i v e d i s cu s s e d i n Un i t are called ADHORTATIVE verbs . 1 1, No t e 1 .
T he f o r m s q u o t e d a b o v e
us (
the second person, with the syllable /-ra-/ after the subject
prefix . l the first T h e s e f o rm s h ave provisional high tone on S t e m t o n e is low for b oth hi gh
332
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT
21
Exercise 1. C onditional forms, affirmative. L o cation of tones in forms containing object prefixes.
t woojaana.
n oomubari r a .
Y oombaza, n o omugabur i r a .
E xerc i s e 2 . /-riinda/ as the first of two verbs. N e gative subjunctive vs. affirmative infinitive. <They shouldn't go into t he su n mu c h . < (<... i nt o m uc h s u n . > ) k uja k u z u u b a r yi i n s h i 'Ntibaje ku zuuba ryiinshi.
I Keep t h e m f r om going into the
kuj a
g uki n i r a m w iibarabara
Ntibakinire mw iibarabara.
Ub a r i inde gukinira m w ii b a r a b a r a .
k uj a k w i i y a nduz / a ingwaara
'Ntibaje kwiiyanduz
/
Ubar i i
n de k u j a
i ngwaara .
k wi i y a n d u z
i ngwaara .
k uzi m i r a 'Ntibazimire. U bariinde kuzimira .
333
UNIT 2l
KIRUNDI
U bari i n d e
kury
n de k u v a
hano.
Exercise 3. I n a nimate possessives. < Do you s e e t h e t r ee s ? < (>Is it not trees t hat y o u s e e ? >) i bXt i Ntaa b i t ubona ? <Take the children into t hei r s h a d e . <
caaco.
Exerc i s e
4.
Dem o n s t r a ti v e s w i t h j " r y a/. Inanimate possessives. > Do you s e e tree?> Urabona k i r y a that
>Take t h e i t . ~ ch i l d o v er by
g a ti ?
J aan J aan
a a
u m waana h a a f i y aa c o .
/ /
/
urugaanda
U rabona r u r y a rugaanda?
/
u m waana h a a i i y aa r w o .
BASIC C O U R S E
U NIT
21
icamion
Urabon
i r ya
J aan
u m waana h a a f i y aa y o .
<camion>?
u ruseenger o i seenger o U rabona r u r y a irya r useenger o ? s eengero ? Urabon ur y a
/
/
J aan
u m waana h a a f i y aa r w o .
yaayo.
u m waana h a af i y a a w o .
/
umuryaango
a
/
J aan
m asaangaanzi r a ? i nz i r a Urabon
a i r y a nz i r a ?
J aan
u m waana h a af i y aa y o .
Exercise 5. D emonstratives with j ryaj. M onophonic and diphonic p ref i x e s . <Whose child is that?> umwaana umuunyu ig i t u u n g wa
u rut o r e
/
( <tha t
c h i l d i s of who m ? < )
n n
ur waa n d e ? i c a a n de?
igitaambara
inkoko ikiyiiko
Kirya gitaambara n I ry a nk ok o n
i pi k i p i ki akazi
ak aand e ?
335
UNIT 21
KIRUNDI
i saha z i t aa n u .
/
/
Bazooheza nk i s aha zibiri. a Bazoov5yo nk i s aha zibiri. a B azoovKyo nka saa mooyajisKh i m w e . a
/ /
E xerc i s e
7.
Yaambaye nk a mweenewaabo.
/
/ /
or >
nk a s e wi i we .
umwiigiisha kwaambar a
mweenewaabo
336
B ASIC C O U R SE
U NIT 2 1
/-riho/ .
a ppropri a t e .
)
>Did y o u s ee a ny t he p a r k ? < t r ees i n
II s a w
s o me (today).<
bi r i ho .
ibXt i
W aboonye hari h
i b Xti muu
Naboon ~
Naboon ~
bar i h o .
N aboony
at aa y o .
m uu <par e > ?
/ / /
i vy a a t s i
W aboonye hari h
i v y aatsi
Naboony
bi r i ho .
N aboony
at aa z o .
N aboony
at aa y o .
m uu >par e < ?
J /
inka
N aboony
at aa z o .
I parc < ?
i mi s o z i W aboonye hari h muu
0
i m i sozi
N aboony
a t aa y o .
<pare<?
337
Exercise 9. Participial used to express current action. M o nophoni.c vs. diphonic prefixes with participial forms. IThe children are sitting on t he g r a s s p l a y i ng . > Abaana biicaye mu vyaatsi bakina. k wii g a kuryaama gusoma
/
<The child is seated on the grass p la y i n g . < U mwaana yiicaye mu vyaats a k ina . Umwaana yiicaye mu vyaatsi yiiga. Umwaana aryaamye mu vyaats y i i ga .
/ / /
Abaana biicaye mu vyaatsi biiga. Abaana baryaamye mu vyaatsi biiga. Abaana haryaamye mu vyaatsi basoma.
/
Lu
kwiicara gufuungura
b afuungur a . kuryaama
/
a fuungur a .
/ /
B ASIC C O U R SE
U NIT 2 1
U bagaana h e eh e ?
m ugi t o o n d o
I
Wabagaanye h e ehe mu
g ito ondo ?
ego
giheki
W abagaanye h ee h
ego ?
W abagaanye g i h e k i
eg o?
m u gi t o o n d o W abagaanye g i h e k i
(uyu muusi
imiisi yoose
Practice conversations.
T waateembereye . M waagumye ku z u u b a
i gihe k i ni ni ?
sure t h a t
t he
i n t h e s u n t oo long .
i s5h
339
UNIT 21
KIHUNDI
2.
(As a p ar ent;,
y ou i n t ; e r v i e w a n app l i c a n t f or a j ob c ar i n g f or y o u c h i l dren. ) Y o u a s k
whet;her t he
U raazi
k w o o z aba a n a a
no kubagabur i r a ? Ndabi i z i n e e za .
U ramaze k u r e r a haandi ?
a ppl i c a n t k n o w s h ow t o f e e d a n d
b ath e c h i l d r en .
abaa n a
Y ou ask w h e t h e r s he ha s h a d p ri o r e x p e r i e n c e .
Ndez
a b a a n a i gi h e c aa n e .
k inin i
Free Conver s a t ; i o n ." l. A parent; gives instructions for t;he day to t;he person who t;akes c a r e o f hi s chi l dr en . 2. A parent; int;erviews a prospect;ive babysit;ter. 3. A babysitt;er, who feels underpaid, tries to make a case f or a n i nc r e a s e i n w a g e s .
300
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 22
-gwa (- guuye)
l A Ub o n a h a an z
i ri k
ir a gwa? i gi c u 2B
(7, 8)
cloud
ari vyiinshi.
many.<)
r ai n I n t h i s s e a s o n ( <time<), h o w long does it rain?
imvura
3A
(9)
/ /
i ki ?
- hi t a
( -hi s e )
urushaana
( ll )
season (May)
4B N i iyur u s h a an a n tiigwa ng i hi t e. I t is the rain of the uru shaana ,
inyuma
(9) (3, 4)
b ehi n d , n oon ,
a f t er d a yt i me
umutaaga 5A
y a umutaaga c a a nk e mu
gitoondo ?
34.l
UNIT 22
/ /
6B
a a
<bel)
i s evening f al l s a t ni ght ,
(3, 4)
sunset.
perhaps I feel it is warm here ( <here is warm< ); maybe it will r ai n ? I t > s ( o f ) t h e ur u s h a n a ; t he r e <s no-one wh o k n ows wh er e i t c omes f r o m . s mall c l ou d
8A
a i gwa ?
9B
Ni
iy
a ur ush aa n a n t a a
wumeny i y i t u r utse. a o
a gacu (12 ,
1 0A
1 3)
2. 1 1C Hano m u f i s
ib i h e v y
u umwaaka b i i n g a a h e ?
1 2D Dufis
/
ibi h e v y
/
W e have f o u r .
Could y o u
g i v e m e t he i r na m e s ?
342
B ASIC C O U R SE
U NIT 2 2
- tega ( - t e z e )
to receive ear
b egin n i n g d ry s e a s o n
( physica l l y )
u Hutwi (l5, 6 )
impeeshi
(9)
o f d ry s ea s o n
i ci ( 5 )
agataasi 1 4D Teg
(12)
ur us h a a n a , i ci , n
s eason o f
e a r l y r ai ns
a ama t w i s
Which one has the most rain? ( >I t 1 s w h i c h s e a s o n i n which is much rain?> )
nyi i n s h i 1 6D 17C N
? It<s ur u shana.
ur u sha a n a .
Mu c i muhora mukor
i bi k 1 ?
1 8D
Ici n
igi h ab a a n a e
bakuunda. - kuundi r a 1 9C
( -kuundiye )
to like for What do they like it for? to run no) They p l a y a n d r u n , w e ll , i t>s n i c e )
( -i i r u t s e )
20D
Bar ak i n a , bak i i r uk a ,
e ka ni vyi i za.
34.3
UNIT 22
KIRUNDI
2 1C
Mba r i r
a
/
ubu r y
/
ukuun d
2 3C
Ni
k uk i
u t ar uk uunda ?
-kanya ( - k a nye)
ivy oondo 24D
(8)
mud The rain is heavy, it>s cold out, and there>s a lot of
mude
v yi i n s h i .
1.
A n o t e o n t he
er i h r a s t i c
ro ressive.
T he sen t e n c e s : Ubona haan z e i r i k o ir a gwa? ar abi r a . Can you see if it>s raining outside? The water is boiling. They (Cl. 8) are getting
r ot t e n . c ontain a construction which is summarized in the f o llowing fo r mula :
Amaaz
Bi r i k
ari k
o b i r abor a .
344
B ASIC CO U R SE
UNIT 22
for t;he indicative is on the syllable /-ko/. The first; of t;he above examples contains an example of the participial mood. This construction consists of a two-word phrase, but the phrase plays much the same part in sentences as do the one-word tenses that have already been st'udied. For this reason, it; is
cal l e d a I periphrastic tense. < I t i s u s e d w hen th e sp e aker wi sh e s
to call attention to t;he cont;inuing nature of an action which is going on. W ith respect to English translations, the periphrastic progressive of Kirundi is oft;en but not; always matched by an English present progressive ( Iis ing<). The infinitive that [ For p r a c t i c e w i t h t he per i -
c orresponds t o
/-riko/ is /kubako/.
2.
A e n e r a l note on the stem extensions. C ompare t h e Bakuund a t w o s e n t ; ences : i ci . They like ici. What do they like it for?
/
B agikuundir i k i ?
The root which underlies each of these verbs is /-kuund-/ >to like<. The stems of the two verbs are respect'ively /-kuund-/ a nd / - k u u n d i r - / .
a STEM EXTENSION. T here are a number of such Iextensions< which may o c cur w i th
The el e ment
verb roots in Kirundi. S tem extensions have the following characteristics: 1. They follow the root of the verb.
2. Th ey n e v er en d a wo r d .
may
34.5
UNIT 22
KIRUNDI
conta1n one, two, or even more of them. 4. Each extension has its own effect upon the way 1n which the total verb form is used, a nd on its meaning .
3.
A note on the a l i cative extension. The particular stem extension which was used as an exampl e
in the preceding note is called the APPLICATIVE extension. further examples ares Yagukore y e i ki ?
/
Some
Ntiwoomumesuurir i m puuzu?
/e/ or /o/ in the preceding syllable, it is /-er-/q o ther w i s e (i. e., after /i, u, a/) it is /-ir-/.
Very frequently, the meaning of the applicative e xten s i o n is that the action of the verb is performed with reference to, or for the benefit of, some thing or person. T he t h i n g o r per s o n
is usually, though not invariably, to be found 1n the sentence, either as a noun or as an object prefix.
The applicative extension is
English with a >for< phrase, as in the examples which have been cited above. In other instances, the translation may be somew hat different :
Ari k
ar ak i na . he ?
H e is
pl ayi ng.
Akin i r l
. . . n d a y i sh i k i r e
( Unit 2 0 )
346
B ASIC C O U R S E
UNIT 22
With some verb stems but not for others, the applicative stem is used in the following construction: ahaantu h o g u s o mer a a pl a c e f o r r ead i n g
( cf.
ahaantu h o k u r y a a ma
a pl a c e t o s l ee p
A note on the reci rocal stem extension. Another rather productive stem extension is found in this s enten c e s Turabonana.
/
See you
lat erf
( <We [wi l l ]
s ee one
another. < )
The form of this extension is /-an-/. U n like the applicative extension, it is not subJect to change according to the vowel of t h e r oo t . The meaning of the extension /-an-/ is often that two or more subJects are acting upon one another. For this reason, it is called the RECIPROCAL extension. I t may also be used to show
t hat two or more sub J e cts are performing the ac tion Jo in t ly .
347
UNIT 22
KIRUNDI
bo
abaana
Barik o
bar akor
i k i '7
A baana ba r i k o
barakina.
b a r akor
ira v a .
ak az i .
T he men ar e
worki ng .
irik
i r a gwa.
It is raining.
a r e r ot t en . <
0
(imicuungwa ) ( ib i t o o k e ( in t o r e )
Imw irik i r a bora, e o Bimwe biriko birabora, Zimwe ziriko zirabora, Imw irik
e
0 0
n ay
i r abo z e .
n azo z i r a b o z e .
0 0
(imihwi)
(umuhwi) (int o o f anyi (amashu)
i r a bora, ur abor a ,
Umw u r i
e
ar abo ra ,
a yaandi
nay
ar abo z e .
348
B ASIC C O U R S E
U NIT 2 2
Exercise 3.
Pr o gressive periphrastic,
>The oranges ar e
imicuungwa
i ntor e
/ /
r o t t i n g .>
0
I micuungw
irik
ira b o r a .
Intore ziriko zirabora. Intore ziriko zirakaba. Isereri ziriko zirakaba. Indimu ziriko zirakaba. Indimu ziriko zirasha. Ibitooke biriko birasha.
/
Imicuungw i ri k i r a sha. a o
/ /
/
Imicuungw i ri k i r a bora. a o
Exercise 4. The applicative extension with certain verbs in < where< qu e s t i o n s . >The child is playing.> gukin a
k wi i g a
Umwaan ari k a
/
0
/
ar ak i na .
/
he ?
U mwaan
/
arik
o
/
ar i i g a .
r Kh e ?
gus orna
kwooga
k wi i y o z a
U mwaan a r i k ar a so m a . a o
/
AsomerKhe? YoogerKhe? Y ii y o g e r e z l h e ? A ri i r 5 h e ?
Umwaan
ar i k
arooga.
Umwaan a ri k a r i iyoza. o a
/
kurya
Umwaan
a ri k
a rar y a .
UNIT 22
KIRUNDI
Exercise 5. Us e of the applicative extension after /ahaantu/ with certain verbs, but not with others. < I want gusoma kwiicara kuryaama kurya gukaraba k wii y o z a
/
t o r ea d . <
>I>m looking for a place to read.> N doonder Ndoonder N doonder Ndoonder Ndoonder N doonder a a aha a n t u h o g u s o mer a . aha a n t u h o k w ii ca r a .
/
a
a
a
a
Exercise 6. A typical use of the applicative extension. > Please b r i n g s poon. <
i ki y i i k o inkono
/
me a
Ntiwoozan i k iyiiko? a
/
Ntiwoonzanir i k iyiiko?
a a a a
N tiwooza n
i nk o n o ?
i safu r i y a igipfuundiki zo
Ntiwoonzanir i g ipf>un di k i z o ?
/
umuunyu
/ /
N tiwooza n
Nti w o o z a n
/
a a a
u m uunyu?
/
N tiwoonzani r N tiwoonzani r
a a
u m uunyu?
/
isabune
i sa b u n e ?
i s abune?
/
amasahaani
N tiwooza n
h aani ?
a masa-
350
Exercise 7. The applicative extension. O b ject; prefixes in disjunct immediate verbs. > They ar e
/
B arik o
b a r a w u t e e k er a n d e ?
bar akor
ak az i .
b a r a g akor er a n d e '?
b a r a gor oor
a a
i mpu u z u .
i s h imiizi. i keete.
b a r a r y a a n d i k i r a n de ?
b a r ay u u b a k i r a nd e ?
b a r uu b a k
i nz u .
/
B arik o
b a r a y a v oomera n d e ' ?
UNIT 22
KIRUNDI
Exercise 8. S ome sentences containing the reciprocal extension, with a variety of translations into English. < one anot h e r ~ a. gufasha Abiigiishwa barafashanya.
/
The s t u d e n t a not h e r .
s h el p o n e
kubona
Turabonana.
kumenya kwaandikira
b. kuba k waandik a
< togeth e r > They live together. They are writing together. [i . e. in the same room] They ar e d o i n g t h e i r l aundr y t o g e t h e r . We ate together yest er d a y .
kumesuura
B arik o
b a r a mesuur a n a .
k ufuungur a
Twaarafu ung ur an y
ego .
c . (o ther s )
gukur i k i r a gutaanduka U kuri k i r a n a n a a n d e ? Barat a a ndukaanye . Whom do you f o l l o w ' ? T hey hav e p a r t e d company.
352
B ASIC C O U R SE
U NIT ~ ~
[people]
A bo boose b a ag e mu g i t o o n d o . A bo boose b a a j e
/ /
umuraango umugorooba,
/
k u mur aango.
A bo boose b a ag e k u
/
B aaje k u
mugorooba.
mugorooba.
ig oro
/
A bo boose b a ag e mw i i g o r o .
/ /
s aasi t a
A bo boose bag.je k w i s a a
B aaje saa ( i i s a a) si t a .
(ii s aa ) 8 a. m.
/ /
s i t a.
'/
A bo boose ba aj e
zi b i r i .
k w i i sah a
Exercise 10. O b ject prefixes with negative relative. R e lative m ood i n a < why> ques t i o n . <I don> t l i k e urushana. <
/
S inkuun d S inkuun d
a a
u r u s h aana. i vy oo n d o . a i v y oo n d o .
N i k u k . u t a r u k uu n d a ? i Ni k u k u t ab i k uu n d a ?
(tweebwe )
amKgi
kuduuga imisoz i
N ti d u k u un d
N i kuki mutabikuunda ?
Ntidukuund a m Kgi. a
Ntid u k u u nda ku duu g
Ni kuki mutayakuunda?
N i kuki mutabikuunda ?
i miso z i .
353
U NIT 2 2
shoobuj a amapikipiki
indeege
/
Ntidukuund i n deege . a
N i kuk i m u tazikuunda?
E xercise ll .
t ive
concords. > Those l i t t l e cl ou d s d o n > t s eem heavy [ e n o ug h t o giv e r a i n ] . > <They ar e n o t he a v y . >
uducu
Turya ducu ko mbona tutaremye. K arya g a c u k o m b on a k a t a r e my e . Birya bicu ko mbona bitaremye. Kirya gicu ko mbona kitaremye. Kirya gicu ko mbona kitiiruka. Birya bicu ko mbona bitiiruka. Karya gacu ko mbona katiiruka. Turya ducu ko mbona tutiiruka.
agacu
i bi cu igi cu k wii r u k a
i bi c u
agacu uducu
Exercise 12. A u tonomous mood after /'ntaa/, an object prefix. > There i s n o - o n e w h o k nows hi s n a m e . > kumenya k ushobor a gushaaka Ntaa wuuzi izina ryiiwe.
/
Nt aa w u s h o b or a k u d u f a s h a . N taa wushaaka k u v u g a .
N taa wub i s h o b o r a .
N taa w u b i s h a a k a .
B ASIC C O U R S E
U NIT 2 2
gushii ma
kurya guhema kunywa g ukwi i r a
i b oze.
N taa wukwi i r a
Practice conversations.
You ask w ha t t he weather is like i n Bu gumbura i n J uly . You co m ment o n t he similarity or dissim1larity of this weather to s ummer weat h e r in the U. S.
2.
Noon
i w a a nyu i ci a
igihe
r imar
United States.
k in@an
a iki?
355
UNIT 22 Y ou r e p l y . Rimar
KIRUNDI
/
a m e e z at a t u .
/
I waanyu h a r w
/
a
/
F ree c o n v e r s a t i o n . l. A asks B about; t;he four seasons in North America. 2. C and D discuss regional differences in climate within i-.he c onti n e n t a l U n i t ed S t a t e s .
NOTICE Beginning with Unit 23, the student; will be given a number of responsibilities in connection with the exercises and even the dialogues. T h ese responsibilities will include marking tone, marking vowel length, and completion of exercises. In thi s way,
t;he student should become increasingly self-sufficient in his language study, so that by the time he has finished t;he book he
will be independeni-. of printed helps .
356
B ASIC C O U R SE
U NIT 2 3
< What i s
i n s ea s o n ? >
I <11 be going to Che ma r k e t
kugur
/
a a
i mi c u u n g w a
intoofanyi.
- eera ( - e e z e )
2B Nt av y
0
to ripen You won' t g e t any . (<There are not those Chat you get.> ) They a r e n ' t r ea d y y e t . And what about potatoes' ? l ong a g o T he s t o r e d o n e s a r e n o l on g e r
ur oon k a ,
n ti b i r e e r a . 3A N . in t o of'anyi nazo'?
i
keera 4B I zaa k ee r a n t aa
z iki r i ho ,
{3, 4)
v al l e y And the new ones aren>t [mature] (<...are still in the yet.
n azo z i r ac a a r i
v all e y s . >
W ell, w h e n d o o r a n g e s a p p e a r [ on t h e m a r k e t , ] ' ?
i b o n ek a a tar i 7B
except a
They don<t start to ripen u nt i l J une .
Ntitaa n g u r a g u h i i shir
a tar i
mu kwaa
g ataandat u . inanaasi
(9, 10)
357
p ineappl e
UNIT 23
KIRUNDI N iina n a asi ntizireera? And the pineapples, aren't t hey r i p e y et ? I think [ s o ] b ut I don > t k no w
8A
9B
f o r su r e .
2.
(7, 8)
maize f r e sh , g r e e n , u n ri pe
N t a a bigoori bitoot
0
ubu .
There<s n o g r e e n c o r n t o be seen at the market nowadays. ( >There i s n o t gr e e n c o r n that a person would see at t he mar ke t n o w . >) to be exhausted, finished Those grown in the valleys a re a l l gon e . ( <Those t h a t t hey g r e w . . . > )
i n th e hi l l s
- raangir a
11D
( -raangiy e )
12C
No o n i v y i muhXr a e o n ti b i r e e r a ?
1 3D 1 4D
Ub u
n i mu k w a a m b e r e . u z oo b o n a
Nt aa bi g o o r
kw iisoko atari mu
see... >)
k waa ga t a t u .
amasKka (6)
-herah eza
( -herahej e )
358
B ASIC C O U R SE
U NIT 2 3
Mu ci , m u k w
(7, 8)
countr y ,
r egi o n
Ki no gi hu g u u m e enga kirashuushe.
1 8F
Han
Bugu u m b ur a
/
(9, 10)
(5)
c ott o n [ Around ] h e r e w e g r o w r i ce a nd c o t t o n .
20F
(7, 8)
2 1E
No o n
Ubu r u u n d i b wo o s e
v ate
t h os e c r o p s'?
359
UNIT 23 22F O y a ni h a n
r
KIRUNDI
i B u juumbura
no mu Kumoso.
23E Ipaa m p a r y a a nyu mu r ikoz i ki ?
to
send
(14)
Ri m w e ritumw i B u raya, a
iriindi rikaguma
hano.
l.
A n ote on the e r s istive tense. Examples of the persistive tense are to be found in
Sentences 4 and g of this uni6: Ntaa zikiriho. there are not those which still exist (autonomous n egat i v e )
they are still in the va ll ey s
Z iracaari mu myoon ga .
(indicative immediate )
Compare al so<
U racaar
um u s o r e ?
again the only exceptional form, with high stem tone for high 36O
B ASIC C O U R S E
U NIT 2 3
verbs and low stem tone for low verbs. O t herwise, the tones of the persistive forms follow the general rules for their moods,
a fflrmat1ve and ne gative .
A racaakor a . Aracaasoma.
N takigeenda mu ka z i .
/
He no l o n g e r
g o e s t o w o r k.
The meaning of the persistive in Kirundi is that an action or state lasts comparatively late with respect to some e xpect a tion expressed or implied in the context. r at he r It is called a <tense>
represent it occur in the same slot within the word where other >tense> prefixes are found, and is mutually exclusive with them. [For practice with persistive forms, s ee Exer c i s e s 2 - 4 , 12 . ]
2.
A n o t e o n t he i n ce t ive tens e .
N ti b i r e e r a .
[Nti-bi-raa-eera)
r i pe
r e er a .
361
UNIT 23
/
KIRUNDI
Sindaamenyeer i Bujuumbura.
( Unit 1 2)
Sindaahamenya. I don>t know it [ t h e p lace] y e t . {Unit
13)
F urt he r e x amples a r e s
N ti b i r a a k a b a . They arenlt wilt;ed
yet . Ntibaraarima.
/
B ir e e r a ? B ir a a k a b a ? I mvur
/ /
r i p e y et ?
t h e y wi l t ed y e t ; ?
a
/
i r aag w a ?
Araaryaama'?
In it;s formation, the inceptive tense is gratifyingly regular. I t is marked both in the affirmative and in the negative by the prefix /-raa-/. It; alone among all the tenses of Kirundi, has basic stem tone {high for high verbs, low for low verbs ) in all its moods, both affirmat;ive and negat;ive. There
are no perfective forms for the inceptive tense, and th ere is no
cont;rast between conjunct and disjunct' linkages. wit;h inceptive verbs, see Exercise 1.]
[ For p r a c t i c e
P ossessive
h r a s e s u se d in noun s l o t s .
S entence 4 of the ba sic dialogue for this unit i s o Izaa keera nt a a z ikiriho. Those o f l ong ago
no l o n g e r 362
ex i st .
BASIC COURSE
UNITP3
that are normally occupied by nouns subject or ob)ect of a verb, for example. I n stead, a form that; begins with /i-/ is found, as in the first; of the above examples. F urther examples are:
a b aana /
/iz uumwaana/ / i z a i mi s o z i /
/iz
a um u s o z i/
a
363
KIRUNDI
/ i z a i nd a g a r a /
/iz i ikaraamu /
The f a c t s a b o u t t o n e a n d l en g t h o f d ata may be summ ar ized as fo llows s t h e s e c o nd v ow e l i n t hes e
I. and the stem vowel of the noun ( e. g . /ibaanki/) begins with low tone, then the second vowel of the possessive phrase is short, with high tone:
/izibaanki /.
II. and the stem vowel of the noun ( e. g .
/i z uumwaana/.
b. which has no initial vowel, the second vowel of the possessive phrase is long and low, with
n o effect on the tone of the fo llowing syllab le :
/izaa Bujuumbura /
/iz a a kare/.
2. where the word that follows /i(z)a/ is not a noun, the second vowel of the possessive phrase is long, and the third mora has high tone: [Por drill on these matters, see Exercise 6.]
/ i z uubu/ .
364
B ASIC C O U R S E
U NIT P 3
Compare the p h r a s es :
i no z in o nzu nzu
this house [near me and maybe near you] these houses [near me and maybe near
you]
1yi i zi n zu n zu
t hi s h o u s e [ n e a r u s ] t hese h o u se s [ n e a r u s ]
Note that the demonst;ratives that contain / no/ have high tone on the first vowel that follows a consonant. this set of demonst;ratives, see Exercise 5.] [For practice with
The use of Cl. 8 for mixed antecedent;s. Compare the following pairs of sentencess Mpava ngeenda kw iisoko kugur
/
im i cuungwa.
N ta~
ur oo n k a . in t oofanyi.
im i cuungwa n
in t o ofanyi.
v Nta~
ur oon k a .
Where, as in the third of these examples, the ant;ecedent nouns (here /imicuungwa/ and /intoofanyi/) are members of different
).
365
UNIT 23 E xerc i s e l .
KIRUNDI I n cep t i v e t en s e .
kuroonka
Ntaraa r o on k
a
a
i k eet e ?
gushuusha
N taraashuus h
am a a z i ?
water
k ubi s i g u u r a
N taraa bi s i g u u r a ?
H asn>t h e
i t y et ?
g usubi r a
Ntaraasubira mu kazi?
Hasn>t h e r et u r n e d t o w ork y e t ? Hasn' t h e p a s s e d t hi s w ay y e t ? H asn>t h e b e g u n t o s tudy y e t ? D oesn>t h e y e t u n d e r stand what it means ? H asn>t s h e c o o k e d t h e c hicke n y e t ? Hasn't he left Europe
y et ?
gutaambuka
/
g utaangur a
/
Ntaraataangura kwiiga?
g utegeer a
guteeka
kuva
Ntaraa v
i Bur ay a ?
k ur i m a
Ntaraarim
i m 'boga?
Has he a l r e a d y w a s he d t h e p otat o e s ?
Has h e a l r e a d y r e c ei v e d t h e l e t t er ?
366
B ASIC C O U R SE
U NIT 2 3
A raashuus h
a maazi ?
Araa b i s i
guur a ?
A raasubi r a
mu ka zi ' ?
Has he b e gu n
t o s t u d y y et ?
D oes he a l r e a d y u n d e r s t a n d what it; means? H as he a l r e a d y c o o k e d t h e c hick e n ? Has he l e f t / come bac k f r o m E urope y e t ? Has he planted vegetables yet ?
A raat ee k
a i nk ok o ?
Araav
i Bur ay a ?
Araarim i m boga ? a
[After the two halves of Exercise 1 have been pract;iced separately, they should be practiced together, using the affirmative question from Part B as cue, and the negative from Part A as response. ]
E xercise 2 .
P e r s i s t ive ten s e .
>Isn<t that book finished ( or< wor n o u t ;) yet ?> i gi t a b o i bi t a b o imp uuzu
ici
/
367
KIRUNDI
/
Aka gataasi n t ikaraashira? Ivyo vyoondo n t ibiraashira? Iyo nkoof cero ntiraashira?
Uyo muuny u
/
K azooshi r a
vuba.
n t u r a a sh i r a ?
W arashi z e .
Yara s h i z e . Bwaara s h i
/ /
uburo
ze.
i bi juumpu Ivyo bi juumpu ntibiraashira? Vyaa r a shize. [NB The loss of high tone on /raa/ when the preceding f 'nti / i s high , c f . Un i t l 3 , Not e l . ] E xerci s e Q. Persistive tense, affirmative question vs. negative answer. >Is that water still >That w a t e r i s no b oi l i n g ? < longer boiling.>
/
k ubi r a kunywa
/
Y aa maaz
/
ar ac a a b i r a ?
/
/
U mwaana ar a c a any w
a maazi ?
n t ak i n y w
kuri ma
kuro r ee r a
S hoobug
/
ar ac a a r o r e e r a ?
/
S hoobuga
/
n t agi r or e e r a .
/
Umunyeeshuur 1 <r ad i
0
ar ac a a s o ma?
/
/
< i r aca a v u g a ?
/ /
a r a c aacura?
/ /
U racaakor e es h
i y o sab u n e ?
S ingikorees h
sabune.
368
B ASIC C O U R S E
UNIT 23
gushuuha kugwa
H aanze ha r a c a a s huushe ?
H aanze
n t i hag i s h u u s h e .
lmvur
i r a c aagwa'?
Imvura nt;ikigwa.
Exercise 4 .
kuba
T here i s
no - o n e ( who is )
s till in the of f i c e .
kumenya
N t;aa wukimeny
i n zira.
kuba
N taa wuk i h a b a .
i nz 6g a .
beer a ny
kwuubaka
N taa wucuubaka g u t y o .
kuumfasha kugaruk a g uf i t a
k ubon e k a
N o-one h e l p s
me any mor e .
W e don>t s e e a n y o n e a n y m ore t h e s e d a y s .
ones
I ziziimvye ziri ha n o .
urubaangaangwe
Runo r ub a a n g aangwe r ur a z i i m v y e .
369
UNIT 23
KIRUNDI
igitaambara
i zi i k o
Uno mudug u r aziimvye. a Ino nz i r aziimvye. u Ano meez a r aziimvye. a Ino nkoofeer i r aziimvye.
0
e e
uri
hano .
iri hano.
Ino sh i r aziimvye u
ibaanki i noot i
I z i b a a nk i z irXh e ?
a
a
I vy
i b a anki birXhe?
I z i n o o t i z ir lh e ?
impuuzu urushaana
/
Iz Iz a
i mp u u z u z i r X h e ? ur us h a a n a z i r X h e ?
b. ici i zi i k o i s h i m i i zi
Iz iici zirlhe?
I vy I vy I vy
a
Iz 1izfiko zirXhe? a
I z i i s h i m i izi zirXhe ?
a a
370
BASIC C O U R SE
UNIT ~3
kare
Yohaani
I zaa kar e z i r E h e ?
I za a Y o h a a n i zi r Xh e ?
I vyaa k a r e
b i r l he ?
b i r Xh e ?
I vya a Y o h a a n i
Buguumbura
Iv y a a Buguumbura birlhe?
d.
vuba ubu
I zaa v u b a I zu ub u a
/
zi r Xhe?
I vyaa v u b a
bir Xhe?
zi r Xhe?
I vyu u b u b i r l h e ? a
/
ego
uyu mwaaka
/
I ze e g o z i r X h e ? a Z zu uyu mwaaka z i r X h e ? a
[After each section of this exercise has been practiced separately, it should be combined with the section (s) that preceded it.]
Exerc i s e
7.
[his] clothes. Aja mu kazi mu gitoondo? Atari ku musase n t aaja mu kazi. Nshaaka k umenya n e e z a O NU. I want to get acquainted
wit h t h e UN .
Atar u ku j
k iindi
T here i s n o w a y e x c e p t t o go t o N ew York .
wo ok o r a .
371
UNIT 23
/ /
KIRUNDI
/
[about ]
ex c e p t J o h n .
Exercise 8. The non-concordial >semi-verbal< forms. >I see that there are a
l ot of clouds . <
! /
lbl
Cu
imikaat e i ngur u b e
amKgi
izuuba
/
amafaraanga amakara [The student should write out the r emaining sentences in th i s
exercise, showing vowel length and tone, and then pr a c tice the compl e t e d ex e r c i s e i n t h e u su a l man n e r . ]
/
372
B ASIC C O U R S E
U NIT
23
T he ver b
/-ja/ plus
i ki ? i ki ?
Aje g u ko r
Aje kugu r
A je g u t e e mbere z
a a
i ki ?
Aje kugur i b iriibwa. a Baje kugur i b iriibwa. a Baje gufat i b iriibwa. a Tuje gufat i b iriibwa.
Baje k u g u r
i ki ?
/ - hava/ .
<I>m goin g market ? t o t he >I>m going to go [somewhat later] to the market.
kugeenda
N zoohava n g e enda k w i i s 5 k o .
k waand i k a
N z o o hava
kugwa
I mvur
i z oo h a v a
kuruhuuka
Nzoohava
373
UNIT 23
k ubon e k a
/ /
KIRUNDI
I z u u b a r i h a va r i b on ek
/
I zuuba r ' z o o h a v a
i nyuma ya
gusoma
saa s Xt a .
/ /
Nzoohav a Nzoohav a
kugerageza
k ubi b a
Nz o o h ava
[The student should write out the rest of Column 3, showing tone and vowel length, and then use the exercise for drill. ]
Exercise 11. The construction of Sentence 2. >I'll send him [to get] oranges. >
/ /
ar oo n k a .
N tayo n d o o nk a . N tazo n d o o n k a .
/
/
N tazo b a r o o n k a .
N taz o Ntaz o Ntavy o N tavy o N tay o bar oonka. t u r o on k a . t u r o on k a . ndoonka. ndoonka.
a a a
i nanaasi .
i n anaasi. i bi go o r i .
Mpava mbatum
wewe amakara
bo
/
M pava ngutum'a i b i g o o r i .
/
a makar a .
N tay o b a r o o n k a .
374
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 23
imyeembe
/
we imicuungwa
ar oo n k a .
a ro o n k a .
Mpava mutum
i m i.cuungwa.
Exercise 12. I mmediate vs. persistive tenses, negative. <Isn't the maize ripe?>
kweer a
/
<It
Nti b i
i s n > t r i p e y et . <
r eer a .
N ti z i r e e r a . N ti z i r a a s h a . N t1raas h a . N ti r a a h e r a . N ti r a a h e r a . N ti r a a s h i r a . Ntiziraashira.
N tiziraaziimbuuka .
Ntiraaziimbuuka.
Ntiraaziimba .
[ The t u t o r
T he new o ne s a r e
s til l i n t he
v al l e y s .
Bitooto n a v o b i r a c a a ri mu myo onga.
The new / s of t
gr e e n
375
UNIT 23
/
/
KIRUNDI
/
Abaant u
bar ac aa ri
k u k i baanz a .
Abaantu b a r i k o
~ bara v u
na z o z i r a c a a r i k u k i baa n z a .
/
E xercise 14 .
A l t e r n at e su b s titution drill based on S e n t ence 14 . I You wonmt find any corn except in Ju n e . I
N taa b i g o o r
i nt or e
kuroonka
amahera
Ntaa Ntaa
r naher u z o o r o on k
at a r i m u k wa a g a t a anda tu .
376
UNIT
23
BASIC C O U R SE
guha
umwaanya
k ur o o n k a
Ntaa maher u z oomuha atari mu kwaa gataandatu. a Ntaa mwaany u z oomuh a t ari mu kwaa gataandatu.
/
i vy e e t e
N taa mwaan y
a / / / u z o o r o on k a t a r i m u k wa a g a t aandatu .
B arik o
bar abi b
[The student or the instructor may complete this exercise, using other verb-object combinations from among those that the student h as a l r e a d y Exerci s e 16 . met . ] Th e u se o f /umeenga/, based on Sentence 17.
/
377
UNIT 23
KIRUNDI
Practice conversat;ions. l. A conversation in which A asks B whet;her he has seen any potatoes at the market; recently. B replies that he has been
there but hasn>t seen any . A a s ks why . B s a y s it; is because
the st;ared ones are all gone, and the new ones aren't ready yet.
2. A c o n v e r s a t ion in w h ich A asks B ab ou t certain crops an d B r e p l i e s t;hat' they are not A a s k s what we do with
our corn. B r eplies that some is used for fodder and some for
food.
3. A conversation in which A asks whether cotton is grown in the U.S. B replies that; it is, mainly in the south. A asks about; rice, and gets the same answer.
F ree c o n v e r s a t ' i o n . 1. Ask a speaker of Kirundi about the differences between the economy of Burundi and the economy of Rwanda. 2. Speak for two minutes on the economy of your home state. (For this purpose, it may be necessary to use some nouns t;hat are not in this book. )
37'8
B ASIC C O U R S E
U NIT 2 4
GEOGRAPHY OF BURUNDI
Ki.ruundo When,did you come from K ir un d o ?
Nape h i i r y a
ar i k o
eego
n z o o c a n s u bi r a y o
vuba. I zuuba r y
i waa n y u
/
nuumva ng o ir y a a 4A
ni nk
B u g uumbura .
W hat is it lik e ?
R imeze g u t e ?
akeeza (12)
5B E ka n t a a k eeza karut a
(14)
ubush u u h e
b wo mw iijoro n i c o
kimwe. ubwo
( a qu e s t i o n
w o r d ) us ed
-teera (-teeye)
- t e er wa ikiyaga
/
to cause
to be ca u s e d
(-teewe)
(7, 8)
379
lake
UNIT 24
7'A
bi r ya
8B
Eq, o k aa n d i ng i r a ng o
/
ni
na
u uk
ar i
haas i .
(>that
inyoni
(9, 10)
9A
Rwiihiinda, ariko si i n z i uk w e e z i z i ba
I>d like to go to see the birds at [Lake] Rwihinda but I don>t know [which] month they [should] be back. ( >. . . t h e y a r e t h e y h avin g - r e t u r n e d > )
z aagaru t s e .
10B Ni m u ci . ni naho
I t>s [ i n ] i ci .
in addition
i shaa b a umupaka
1 1B
(g, 6) (3, 4)
b o undary
Ni n a h o h am e z e n e e z a ho kur aa b
/
[ the w e a t h e r ] i s n i c e
i sh a am b a
r yo k u
m u p ak a .
to be br oug h t
Which w a y w o u l d a p er so n g o i f h e we r e o n a t ou r ?
380
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 2 4
vya
( here s
< the a r e a
a r o u n d >)
1)B
U s h aatse, mu vyaa
K ayaanza, a ho woobon
b abu r
(there)
aho buuba k a
(a )a h o b a r i ma . - i i h a r i za ( -i i h a r i g e
)
wild animal T hen you w o u l d (>wil l > ) c o me b ack n e a r /thru Gitega, Bururi, and Nakamba, ( there ) [ w h er e ] you would find cat;tie and wild animals living by t hemselv e s .
(7, 8)
i nk a n a
ar i v y o
vyiiharij a m ashaamba. e
- geza ( - g e j e g e )
1 5A Ar i k o ububus h uuhe b waa B uj u u mb ur a buuza
( -i i p f u u j i g e )
t ;0 wi s h
( for )
g8i
UNIT 24 16B N
u geenda g u s h i k a
r
harya
haruguru mu mi s o zi
u kaca w i i p f u u z a
i ki k u g ar u k ana .
i ki b i r a 17A
(7, 8)
d ense
f or es t
Nahaa n d i n y e n e k i r y a k ibir a k o nk i b o n e r a
k ure k i m e z e g i t e ?
t o be
f r e sh ,
c ool
s mall
s t r ea m
( -hanaantut s e
ibuye 18B
)
stone
(5, 6)
i
The ai r i s f r es h ( >th er e i s f r e s h > ) , [ a n d ] t h e r e ar e m ountai n s ( which ar e ) separated by small streams w hich c a s c a d e d own o v e r
t h e r o ck s .
n aant u k a
i gi i s h o
1 9B
(5, 6 )
Ek a har a r y o o h e y e
i j i i s ho .
in the middle of
382
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 24
2 0A
Mbe g
imisozi yo hagati
Are the mountains ( of) i n the middle of the country like those I see above Bujumbura ?
h eejur u
caane.
inzuuzi
(9, 10)
l arg e
r i v e r (cf. /uruuzi/
2 2A
Noo n e
nt a a n z u u z i
nini ziriho?
2 3B
Har i ho R u v u b u n a Ruvyir o o n za ,
/
na z
iziindi ni ntoonto,
Su l ementar
lions
( which a r e ) i n
>
B urun d i . i nta r e in g we
(9. 10)
(9. lo)
(9, 10) ( 9, l o )
( 9, lo )
383
UNIT 24
/
KIRUNDI
umuswa
i nto z i u ru n y e g e r i i mpoong o
w hit e
ants
(10)
( 11, 1 4 )
a rmy an t s
small, black ant, a nt e l o p e g aze l l e
i nger e g e r e
/ /
igitaangurirwa
imvubu
s pi d e r
hippo
>There are some antelope in Burundi, but they aren>t v ery n u mer o u s .
H ari h
0
<There
1.
Th e v er b
- ca
f o l l o wed b
ar ti c i i a l f o r m .
..a r i k o
n z o o ca n s u bir a y o v u b a .
. ..but g oin g f or U n i t
384
B ASIC C O U R SE
U NIT
~4
U taambutse rirya, u c
ubona.
.
[ When] y o u
cro s s e d
have
one ,
t ha t
you>11 t h e n
Further examples are the fo llowing :
see..
N zooca ng een d
i muh X r a .
When I finish, I
( will )
Mpejeje nkageend i m u hxra. a N avuuye k w i i s5 k o , n c a n g e e n d a
k wa Y o h a a n i .
g o . ..
w ent t o
J o h n 's
[once].
Ngeenda kw i i s 5 k o , h a a n y u ma n ce ngeenda kwa Y .
/
I will go to th e
N geenda kw i i s o k o , n k a c a
/
ngeend a . .
( habi t u a l
W ithout a large number of further examples, it is imp o s sible to give a full d e s cription of these constructions, which
involve the use of the verb /-ca/ plus some form of another
verb. I t i s p o s s i ble to po int out, however, that in all of
these examples except one, the second verb is pa r ticipial in form. A s f a r a s m e a n ing is con cerned, the verb phr ase with
/-ca/
g85
UNIT 20
KIRUNDI c omplet i o n
2.
Th e v er b
- ba
f o l l o wed b
arti c i i a l f o r m .
...ziba
z aagarut s e
( have) r e t u r n ( e d )
Compare also Unit 11, Sentence 8: U zoob a u s h i t s5 h o .
Y ou will be th er e
In both these sentences, a form of the verb /-ba/ is followed by a participial form of some other verb. The English translation for this construction varies, in part according to the tense of the f orm o f / -ba/ . W hen t he
/-zoo-/ tense is used, the meaning is not unlike an English future perfect tense ( Bwil l hav e
the immediate tense, the Engli.sh translation may be with <should>, or may refer to the regular time [e. g. in each year, week,
semester] at which a c e r tain action or pro cess is or dinarily c ompleted . T h e f o l l o w ing are further examples : Azooba yaagu z e i bi t abo . He will have bou gh t b ooks . H e sh o u l d h a v e b ou g h t t he b o o k s . or . He
Aba y a a g u z
i bi t abo .
week of
cl as s ] .
386
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 24
uk
ar wa a y e , a b a y a a g i i y e
kw ii shuure.
3.
T he wor d
ni
lus
uko
lus a cla u s e .
ar i
haas i
In this phrase t;he verb is relative in form. C l auses of this kind seem to have a causative meaning (>since<, >because< ), bu t
4.
T h e wor d
k i mw e
this unit, is of course the adjective root / mwe/ >one> with the prefix for Class 7. I n this sentence, t;here is no noun of
t ;he s a m e c l a s s wi t h wh i ch i t ca n b e s a i d t c b e i n a g r e em e n t ; .
/ikiintu/ >thingI.
s imi l a r
< the same thing > .
c o n s t r u c t ; i o n s , co r r e s p o nd s f a i r l y cl os e l y t o Eng l i s h
5.
The word
h a Kti
ha ati
c ount r y . . .
387
UNIT 24
KIRUNDI
(2) With two nouns following it: Muraamvy iri hagati ya a B ujuumbura n a Ngoozi .
Muramvya is be tween Bujumbur a a n d N g o z i .
by /ya/ .
(3) Not followed by a nouns i yo haga t i . . . those ( Cl. 4 ) i n t he interior or : those [ which a r e ] bet w e e n
[For practice with /hagati/ in the second of these uses, see E xerci s e
9.]
Na)e h i i
r y a y ee j o .
ego
Wavuuye m u
Nag e
e)o.
W avuuye m u
/
K i r u un d o
N aJ
uy u muusi .
u yu m u u s i ?
r
k ubi b a k u w a amb er e
W ayabivy
uyu muusi? k u wa a m b e r e ?
Nayabi v y
u y u mu u s i . k u wa a m b e r e .
W ayabi v y e
N ayabi v y e
388
B ASIC C O U R S E
U NIT 2 4
n ii n d e
N ii nd e y a y a b i v y e k u
waambere?
hiirya yeejo Ni i n de yayabivye h ii ry a uyu muusi
/
k u w a a mber e .
yeejo? uyu
Nii nd e
/
yayabivy
N ije nayabiv y
uyu muusi.
m uusi ? kumutuma
/
'Niinde yamutumye mu Ki r u u n d uy u mu u s i ?
/
ejo
N ije namutumy e j o . e
ej o ?
Exercise 2. B a sed on Sentence 3, substitute nouns and also possessive plural personal pronouns.
>The sun at your place is like that of
Bujumbura. <
/ /
a a
i w a a c u ni n k i w a a b o ni n k
a a
ubw a a B u j u u m bu r a . ubw a a B u j u u m b u r a .
wewe
b aant u j eewe
/
a a
i w a a n y u ni n k i w a a c u ni n k
/ / /
aba a B u j u u m b u r a . aba a B u j u u m bu r a .
amashuure
389
UNlT 24
/
KIRUNDI
/
a a
i wa a b o
i wa a cu
ni
ni
nk
f v y a a B u f uumbura.
geewe
vy
n k f vy a a B u j u u mbur a . a
E xercise 3 .
inyoni
ibik o oko
ibiyaga
u bush u u h e i mi s o z i
/
i wa a n y u b u meze g u t e ?
/
abaantu
E xerc i s e
Ukweez i
4.
gus hi z
, u zoo j a h e ?
W here ar e
you goi ng
a fter the end of th e m onth ? I <1 1 g o b a c k t o w ork . ik i' ? W hat will you do wh en you've finished washing t he f l o o r ?
Nzooca
n s u b i r a k u k a zi .
N i waheza kwoo z
i nz
ukor
390
B ASIC C O U R SE
U NIT
24.
N ca ngeenda k w i i s5 k o .
/
I>11 go to market.
/
What would you do if you knew th e l a n g u a ge' ? I>d then begin to study other things.
W hat would you do if h e b rou gh t eg g s ?
Y oozan
a m a g i w o o mu h
iki ?
N ooca ndamuh
a maf a r aanga.
I>d give him some money. W hat woul d gone? you have done
t o him if he ha d n a t
Naca ndamuh
a k a a ndi k az i .
I woul d h a v e g i v e n
h im o t h e r wor k .
E xerc i s e
/
5.
They ( Cl .
m onth .
N ti z i r a a g a r u k a .
/
/
c o me
Zib a
z e e z e m u r . uu k u k we e z i . i
10 ) sh o u l d
Nti z i r e er a .
They a r e n a t yet .
r i pe
Nti r a a g wa.
I t
h as n > t f a l l en y e t,
391
UNIT 24.
/ /
KIRUNDI
/
uuk u
kweezi .
N ti h a r a a s h u u h a .
/
It hasn't gotten h ot y e t .
r
uuku
Ntiziraashira.
yet .
Exercise 6. S entences that contain /"o/ plus /ku/ plus a noun of location. ( Based on S e n t e n c e 1 1 . ) <We will look at, the forests of the border.>
/
umupaka i mis o z i
i Ki b i r a
/
Tuzooraa b
i s ha a mba r y o k u m ~u aka.
a a a a a a a a
i m i s o z i yo mu K~ibir
/ /
inzuuzi i gi h u g u abaantu
i Koongo
/
Tuzooraab
Tuzooraab
in z uuzi zo mu Kibira.
r
/ / /
i n z u u z i zo ha gati m u ~ i h u u .
Tuzooraab
Tuzoor a a b Tuzooraab
indimi i Bugaande
r
/ /
T uzooraab Tuzoor a a b
/
i B u g aande.
ibi sagar a
i Tanganyi k a
/
i b i s a a r a vy
Bu g a a n d e .
Tuzoor a a b Tuzooraab
i b i s ag a r a v yo mur i
/ /
T a nganyi k a .
indimi
ind i m i z o muri
T a n g a n y ik a .
392
BASIC C O U R S E
U NIT 2 4
a r a y iiharije. e
He has
t h e h o u s e t o hi m s e l f .
Why doe s h e h a v e t h e wh o l e h ouse t o h i ms el f ? Who h as a house to hi ms e l f ? John owns all those stores
Ni i n d e
y i i h ar i j
i n zu ?
( by)
hi msel f .
W e are
Are yo u
th e o nes who. . .
Are t h e y
t h e o nes who. . .
maangaziini yoose?
Exercise 8. S e ntences with /-iipfuuza/, based on Sentence 16. a. W i th aut o n o mous c ompl ement . a
i k i k u g a r ukana ? or > ic o o k u g a r uka n a ? i k i i n g a r ukana . o rg i .coongarukana . u w o omp
W iipfuuz
Do y'ou wish for some means / way/occasion to come back? I wish for some means /way/
o cca s i o n t o com e b a ck .
W iipfuuz Niipfuuz
N iipfuuz N iipfuuz
aka z i .
g ive me w o r k .
393
UNIT 24
/
Y iipfuuz
u w o omuh
aka z i .
b.
a a
i nz u . i nyoni.
Y iipfuuza kuraa b
H e wishes to look at t h e bi r d s
E xerci s e 9 . /hagatf/ plus two nouns: a l e s s o n i n t h e ge o g r a p h y of Burundi. [Students should look at maps, and not at this page Muraamvy iri hagati ya Bujuumbura na Ngozi. Muraamvya
/ /
Ngoozi iri hagati ya Muraamya na Butare. Gitega iri hagati ya Muraamvya na Ruyigi. Kigali iri hagati ya Nyaanza na Byuumba. Uburuundi buri hagati y Urwaanda r u r i
a
/
i K o ongo n a T a n g a n y i k a .
J / / /
Urwaanda
h ag a t i y a U buruundi
Ubug a a n d e .
E xercise 10 .
I mi s o z i
T he mountains of Ng o zi a ren' t v er y h i gh .
caane.
I mi s o z i y
Ng o o z i
/
nt i f i s e
a mashaamba meenshi ?
Ngozi h a v e f ores t s ?
m a ny
3g4
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 24
in t are?
M u mashaamba o ku mu aka
i nt a r e. M u mashaamba yo ku mu pak a i mf' l . s i . ~
/
hari
ha r
hyenas.
/ /
ntaa
Ha ati mu ihu u
practice conversations.
l. A c o n v e r s a tion in wh ich A a sks about the climate in B > s
home state. B replies briefly. A responds by comparing it with some other state. B makes a non-committal reJoinder.
2. A conversation in which A (an American) is trying to persuade B to s tudy in some one par ticular part of the U n i ted States
3,
395
KIRUNDI
1. Plan a vacation itinerary from your present location to Denver, Colorado, returning by a different route.
396
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 25
UNIT 25
BASIC DIALOGUE 1A Vy o o ba v y i i z a n g umuus. i
0
It
u m w u sh i k e e
us (a t
h o me ) some d a y .
k utur aa b
i muh X r a .
- geza ( - g e j e j e
2B 3B 4A Nz oog e z a k u u z a . Nzoo z a n k a r y a a r i ? Ur aaza k u m u u s i
w a Muun g u .
5B
Ur ako z e .
Thanks;
waanj e
1 0A
Aba
aabaa n a b a a c u n a Any e e s i .
Yohaani
[B greets the children. T his greeting is probably not formal enough for use with adults. ) 1 1B 12B Ur aa h o g a Y o h a a '? Ur aa h o g a Any e ? How are y o u , J o hn' ?
H ow are y o u , A g n e s ?
397
KIRUNDI
S it
downj
haasi .
T hank y o u .
Ur a k o z e .
amakuru
1 5B
(6)
What i
Ay a a n di m a k u r u ?
amareembe 1 6A 1 7A 18A 1 9B 2 0A
21B
(6)
amar ee m b e .
C oca-Col a . Don>t y o u d r i n k be e r ?
ib i i n t u
You k n o w
h o w t o c h o o s e n i ce
t hi n g s f
v yi i z a f akabaati 2 3B Nk a
( 12, 1 4 )
c los et ,
cu p b o a r d
ak a k aba a t i
wakaguz5he? u mufre e r e
2 4A
I
( 1, 2 )
[religious] brother
I bought it in Kam enge at
Na k a g u z e m u K a a m e e n g e k u b a f r e er e .
/
the [religious
] brot h e r s .
B ASIC C O U R SE
U NIT 2 5
2 5B
Bar ak o r a n e e z a .
T hey do a
- taeni a
2 6B
( - t a anze)
t o gi ve ,
W a g a t a a n z e k ay a a n g a n 0 a
i ki ?
2 7A
Ibih u u m b i b i b i r i .
T wo t h o u s a n d .
[When A>s children are out of earshot, B compliments A and his w if e o n C h e m. ] i nder o 28B
(9, 10)
M u r a fi s a b a ana bari e n a i nd e r o n z i i za .
/
/
- rer a ( - r e z e )
2 9A Tur ag e r a g e z a k u b a r e r a n eez a ar i k o b i r ag o o y e .
[B prepares to leave.]
-sigara
3 0B
3 1B
(-si gaye)
Good-bye.
See yo u
Si gar
ama h o r o .
( <stay [ i n ] p e a c e < )
( awe wi l l be
Tu z o o b a t u b on a n a .
l at er .
S upreme Bei n g
/
Good-bye
( Igo w i t h
God< ).
G eenda amahoro .
( >go [ i n ]
p e a c e <)
399
UNIT 25 Su l ementar i di r i s h a
in y e g a mo
/
window
c hai r
ameeza
u bur i r i i bi k o r ee s h o
t abl e
bed
t abl e war e
i nz ovu
(5) (5. 6)
( ll )
i v or y l amp, c a n d l e
door ( the ob j e c t ,
) )
O ral readin
ra c t i ce.
[The student should read each sentence to his t;eacher. The teacher corrects his pronunciation, and the process is repeated until t;he student can read aloud perfectly. The student may then t'ry writ;ing t;he tones on the selection. The right hand column
may be used for an E n g lish translation, which the student may t hen use as a ba sis for r e translation into Kirund i . j Andereya yabajije mugeenzi we ko u muusi umwe atooshi k
i m u h ira iwe.
k waa mugeenziwe A n d e r e ya .
Yar a b o o n y e
4ao
B ASIC C O U R S E
UNIT 25
u mugeenzi
a baana ba A n d e r e y a .
e
ntay
Ama z
an yw a .
umwa a n y
Yany o o y e a
a b on a
k aa k a b a at i
Ander e y a , ar a k a -
y a a baana b a A n d e r ey a n a M a r i y a .
1.
T h e c o n s t r u ctio n
ni
-ba I n case
it
J
Ni wab u y ifise... a
/
y o u ( sg.)
have have
Ni mwaaba muyifise...
I n case
t p
y o u ( pl. )
N i b a ab a b a z o o geenda . . .
In the above examples, / ni/ plus /-ba/ plus a participial form of another verb is used as shown. C ompare Sentence 21 of the
b asic dialogue for this un i t .
UNIT 25 2. S e n t e n ceswi t h - ri
KIRUNDI na . . .
The construction used in the right hand column of examples is sometimes used as a synonym for /-fisc/. Its literal meaning
i s of > have t . B arafis e a b a ana babiri. B ari n a a ba a n a b ab i r i , c ou r s e <be w i t h , < a n d i t s u su a l En g l i sh t r a n s l a t i o n i s
>They h a v e T urafis e
t wo ch i l dr en . < + Turi n
i n t o ofanyi.
i n t o ofanyi.
> We have p o t a t o e s . > Arafis imyaak i b i ri. e a < He is two y ear s o l d . <
+ Ari n
i i m y aak
ibi r i .
But this new construction with /-ri n a-/ cannot be used f reely in all situations and so should be used with caution. T h e sentences marked with an asterisk are acceptable to some speakers,
b ut sound unnatural to others .
3.
. ..ga
Yohaa ?
/
or : or ! or :
/
ga Yo h a g a Ma r i g a An y e g a An d e r e
Andereya
/
or ;
ntuuze >what<s-his-name<
nt uu
[ The student should prepare a general statement about the di f f erences in form that he ob serves in the two columns of da t a
g iven a b o v e . ] 402
B ASIC C O U R S E
UNIT 2 5
Exerc i s e l . Us e of /nka / to introduce a sentence; concord involving a demonstrative and the obJect prefixes of two verbs. ~Where did you buy this cupboard, f' o r i n s t an c e ? > akabaat i ububaat i ameeza inyegamo ibi k o r e esho itara amatara isaandugu
/
/
>I bough t
i t her e . >
N ka ak a
k ab a a t i
wa k a g u z 5 h e ?
Nakagu z
e e e e e e e e e e e
i no .
N ka ubu b u b a at i
/
w a b u g u z 5he ?
/
Nabuguz Nayaguz Naziguz Nabigu z N arig u z Nayaguz Nayigu z Nayaguz Nabuguz Nayaguz
/
i no . ino .
ino.
Nka aya meeza wayaguz5he ? Nka izi nyegamo waziguz5he? Nka ibi bikoreesho wabiguz5he? Nka iri tara wariguz5he? Nka aya ma t a r a N ka i y i
/
w a y a g u z 5he ?
s aa n d ug u w a y i g u z 5 h e ?
i no.
U rafi s
i n z6g a ?
Barafis im boga? e
M uraf is i m ~ g a .e
e
e
UNIT 25
/
wewe
umuunyu
e
e s
wew e ? um u u n y u ? e
umu u n y u ?
/
/
bo amaazi
mweebwe u bur i r i
/
Barafis am aazi? e
M urafis N uraffs
/
e e
amaazi? u b uriri?
drink beer?< i n z5 g a ?
>I d r i
nk
i t . >
N tuunyw
/
Ndayinywa . T urayi n y w a . A rayi n y wa . B arayi n y w a . B aayiny o o y e . Y aayiny o o y e . N aayiny o oy e N arayi n y o o y e . Y arayi n y o o y e . B arayi n y o o y e , B azooyi n y wa ,
A zooy i n y w a . N zooy i n y w a .
Ntimunyw i n zbga?
N taanyw
i n z5 g a ?
N tibany w
/
i n z5 g a ?
uyu rruusi
Ntibaanyooy i n zoga uyu muusi? e Ntiyanyooy i n zoga uyu muusi? e Ntiwanyooy i n zoga uyu muusi? e Ntiwanyooy i n zoga e j o?
e e
we (3 sg. )
wewe ejo
/
Ntibaanyooy i n zoga e j o?
e
[ fut u r e ]
i nzo g a e j o ?
i n z og a e j o ?
wewe
N tuz o o ny w
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 25
Exercise 4e R andom substitution. Uyu n Uyu n u m u g eenzi waanje Mariya. umu k o obwa waanje Mariya.
/
Uyu
Twaa aan e
umu k o o bwa w a
u r n ugbre n a a b a ana b a a
a baan d i .
Uu ~
i muhfra.
see us a t
Y ohaan
avuze k
az oos h i k a k u t u r a a b a
h e > 1 1 c ome t o
v isit us at hom e .
i muhXra .
40>
UNIT 25
Y ohaan
/
a v u z e k o b a z o o) a k u r o o ndera
/
m u maangaziini . V yooba
/
v y i i za n g o b a j e k u r o on d e r a
/
I t would be nice if . . .
m u maangaziini .
B azoore r
/
abaa n a n e e z a .
/
Y ohaan
a v uze ko b a zoorer a
J ohn s ay s
that . . .
ngo barer
abaa n a
N zoosubi r a y o
/
vuba.
/
I >11 r e t u r n
/
t he r e s o o n .
Y ohaan
avuze k
azo o s u b i r a y o v u b a .
V yooba v y i i z a
ng
a subi r e y o v u b a .
Tuzoog a
k u t e e mbeer a mu r
i yi
mi i s i .
f ew] d a y s . Yohaan
mur,
/
a v u z e k o t u z o o g a k u t e e mbeera
i yi mi i s i .
J ohn s ay s
that . . .
i yi
mi i s i .
406
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 25
avuze k
mi i si .
az i i ga caa n e m u r
J ohn s a i d
t hat . . .
l t would be good i f . . .
I mvur
/
a
i
Yohaan.
i mvur
i z oog w a a
ego.
Vyooba v y i i z a ng i gw ego . o e It would be nice if it would rain tomorrow.
Exercise 6. C oncord with a demonstrative and an ad)ective, but n ot w i t h / ari / . >This table, for instance, do you t hin k i t <s ni c e? < aya meeza a ka k a z i a ha haantu N k aya a Nk a k a a N k aha a Nk i a
/
/
i B u guumbura
/
Bu g u u mbura , u b o n ar i heez a ? a
ryiiza '?
izi n y eg a m o
/
Nk
i z i n y e g a mo, ubo n
a r i nziiza?
amasKka
N k a m a s aka , a
u b o n ar i mee z a ' ? a
407
a
a
a
/
Nk
i n o , u b on
a r i h e e za ?
E xerc i s e
7.
> futur e
p e r f e c t;>. <We'll be seeing ( ' wil l be w e-havi n g - s e e n < ) one a n o t h e r , < T uzooba t u b o n ana . T uzooba t u j a a n a . T uzooba du k o r a n a . T uzooba t u b a a n a . <[At that timej we will be living together.< Tuzooba turima mu
/
gukora kubaana
kuri ma
Tuzoorima mu myoonga.
T u z ooteembeera. T uzooshi k a .
Tuzoohe z
T uzooba d u t e embeera .
Tuzoob a dushi t se .
ak o k az i .
kazi .
Tuzoogeenda. T uzoorya .
/
ye.
( twaagii y e )
t ur i i y e .
/
T uzookwooz
a m a s a haa ni .
Tozoosh u u s h
ama a z i .
(>we will be boiling water< ) Tuzooba twaashuuhije amaazi. ( <we wil l ha v e b o i l ed t he water, but i.t may no l onger b e h o t ')
408
B ASIC C O U R SE
U NIT p 5
form of
'but this is 1dentical in form with the same form of m eaning <we will com e> .
/-za/,
Exer cise 8. Indicative vs. autonomous forms of the / zoo/ < They'l l co me. <
t ense.
Abazoogeenda b eenshi .
kwaandur i yo
/
B azaandur
n g waar a Bazuumva.
i y o ng w a a r a .
A bazaandur
si
i y o ng w a a r a
beenshi .
s i bee n s h i .
/
si
been s h i .
s i b ee n s h i . si si been s h i . been s h i .
r
Abazoogaruk a
A bazoomuhem a Abazoob a b a r i r b eens h i . a
/
s i b e enshi. si
g uki n a
B azook i n a .
Abazoo k i n a
si
b e e n sh i . si
kureengaana
Bazooreengaana.
Abazoo r e e n g a a n a
009
b eenshi .
KIRUNDI
h e has been married for two years . B says they have a l i t tle boy .
A s a y s b r in g them al o ng , e t c .
2. A
B s a y s h e ca n c om e if
A a s k s w h e n B w il l k now f o r
3.
Fre e
conver s at i on .
1. Invite a friend to visit you. M ake necessary arrangements concerning time, and give him clear directions for finding your p la c e .
410
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 26
UNIT 26 BASIC DIALOGUE [The student; should try t;o use the first version of the dialogue, imitating and later reading aloud. H e shoul d t h e n writ;e the t;one marks, checking by reference to the second version
l.
1A N . a m ak i i g a n t uu ? What' s t h e ma t t e r ?
( pp 414-5 ) ]
-pf a a na
(-pfaanye)
[cf .
2B Nt ubo n a k
0
-pfa, (- p f u uy e
umu d u g a
)]
order
)
l ac k
t o mi s s ,
(3, 4)
u r i mu
5A
Uk ab ur
ama a z
m iha n a ? 6B No ogi r a n t e k o b a t a an z i ?
-saba 7A
(-savye)
8B
UNIT 26
KIRUNDI - aki i r a ( -aki i r i y e) to take from someone Take it and pour it in. T hank yo u v e r y m u c h .
to recover from il lness t o do r i ght a wa y
9B 1 0A
Ak i i r
us uk e m wo .
Ur ak o z e c a a n e . - ki r a
( -ki z e )
- ca p l u s p a r t i c i p ia l v e r b 1 1B N oon
ub
i ciiy
ikir a ?
i me (or :
- unguru z a 1 2A I me .
/ me/ ) ( -unguruj e )
yes
to give a lift
Ur or a h ee h e
n kakwuunguru z a ? 1 3B 1 4A W e w ur or a h e e h e ? e Nd o y i Mur aa m v y a . e
Where a r e ~o u g o i n g ?
- geza ( - g e j e J e )
1 5B Nt ab a a r unge z e m u a Bukeeye. - i n j i r a ( -i n g i y e )
1 6A In ji r a t u g e e n d e .
to come in to
2.
-neezerwa
1 7C K
0
(-neezer ewe
t o be
pl eas e d
u t an e e ze r e w e n a maki ?
412
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT26
18D
Is a a nsi iraamperanye mu
mudugay
m e in t h e c a r . a)
S end me to buy some for y o u .
1 9C
Nt u m a n z e ( or: n J e )
k uy i k u g u r i r a .
iriitiro ( 9, 1 0 o r
or: iriitiro 2 0D Irii t;ir i m w e n
0
6)
l i t er
a maher 2 1C N
a a
ang a a h e ? i n dw i gus a . It>s only seven francs. t o hur r y Go and get; me ten liters.
amah e r
-ihuuta 2 2D
(-i huuse)
e
I huu t e un z a n i r
H ow much di d
you pay?
O nly 7 0
f r ancs.
t ip,
s al a r y , wa g e , r ewar d
2 5D
Niro o n g
ita t u n i
impeembo yaawe.
K eep th e c h a n g e . i s y o u r t i p . <)
( >Thi r t y
c oncer n i n g ( - a anse)
a t o r ef u s e
me
J e h um u d u g u r a anyaankiye. 413
M y c a r won>t work.
KIRUNDI
W ould you help me ?
H ow (>wit h
h el p
w h a t ~) can I
you ?
t o c u r e f or
29F
erega
a ls o [ h e r e , a n e x p r e s s i o n of s u r p r i s e ]
W ell) T h e r e i t g oe s a t
3 0E
Er eg a bi r ak u u n z e .
l ast f
3 1F N. ah o ng e z a k a a n d i
i
ngir a
ng
ur ash i k
amahoro. a gashi r u k a
3 2E Ur ak o z e ca an e . n guh
b u t e (12)
No on e Thank
f ee ,
t i p An d
y o u v e r y mu c h .
i ki
ku
what ca n f ee ) ?
I gi v e y ou (as a
g ash i r u k a b u t e ~
3 3F
Oy a nt aa c o .
Naan j e
No, n o t h i n g . You ' l l do t h e s ame for me if you f ind m e i n the same fix .
b iinyaankiriye .
414
BASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 26
34E
Ur ak o z e c a a n e .
Tur a-
Thank yo u v e r y m u c h . y ou l a t e r .
See
bonanye.
akagaruka 3 5F N ak agar u k a .
(12)
Hurr y
a ret u r n i ng ba c k )
1A
ama k i
ga n t uu ?
2B 3A 4B 5A 6B 7A 8B
9B
N tu b o n a k u m u duga wampiaanye?
0
H aap f uu y i k i nkagufasha? e Ama a z i y a a m p er a n y e . Ukab u r a m a a z u r i mu mihana? a N oog i r a nte ko bataanzi? H iin g a nje kuyagusabira. N tab a ara mugeenzi waanje.
Ak i i r
/
u su k em w o .
1 0A l lB 12A 1 3B 1 4A 1 5B 1 6A
1 7C 1 8D
W e w ur or a he e h e ? e Nd oy
e
i Mur aa m v y a .
Nt ab a a r ung e z e m u B u k e e y e . a I n gi r a t ug e e n d e .
K
/
u t an e e z er e w e
/
/
ama k i '?
/
Isaa n s
ira a m p e r a nye mu mu du ga .
415
UNIT 26 1 9C
2 0D 2 1C 2 2D
KIRUNDI Nt u m a n z e ( or> n g e )
Irii t i r im w e n 0 N. a ma h e r
kuyi kuguri r a .
a maher
gus a .
an g a a h e ?
i n d wi e
Ihuu t e u n z a ni r
2 3D 24C 25D 2 6E
27F
Mi r o on g i t at u n i impeembo yaawe.
0
J eh
umu d u g ur aa n y a a n k i y e . a
e i k j. ?
Nti w o o n t a b a a r a ?
Nda g u t ab a a z
28E 29F 3 0E
3 1F
u r a shik
a ma h o r o .
32E 3 3P
3 4E
Ur a k o z e ca a n e .
Tu r ab on a n y e .
3 5P
N. ak ag a r u k a .
i
1. A
-an-
/ - an- /
was
described as adding a m eaning of reciprocality or mu tuality to a verb stem of wh ich it forms a pa rt . T h a t s t a t em ent does no t
hold true for the el emen t /-an-/ in these sentences, taken from
416
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 26
D on<t y o u s e e t h a t t he c a r h a s d i ed on me?
[ cf .
/ - p f a / < to d i e > ]
A maazi
/ /
y a a mperany e .
on me] .
2 2 , N o t e 3 ).
As a
matter of fact, informal usage (at least for some speakers) allows t he us e o f /-herera/ in place of /-herana/ in the above examples. The same i.s not true for /-pfaana/ and /-pfiira /.
The
latter is used in such contexts as discussions of Christian theology, corresponding to English >to die for or on behalf of. <
[For practice with / -an-/ used in this way, see Exercises 1 and 2 . ]
2.
Th e v o c a t i v e u s e o f
n ou n s .
< Help me ,
my
f riend) >
T he w o r d
I t
d o e s h a v e a h i gh
UNIT 26
KIHUNDI
I t has t h i s f o r m when i t i s
used >vocatively>, that is to say, when it is used to name the p erson b e i n g s p oken t o .
The following are some pairs of ci tation and vo ca tive f orms of some nouns that are commonly used in this way : umwiigiisha mwiigiisha mukoobwa
umukoobwa umuhuungu
/
muhuungu
These three nouns have, in the first stem syllable, a long vowel with high tone on the second mora. The vocative is just like the citation form except for the absence of an initial vowel. T h ese next three nouns do not have, in the first stem syllable of the citation form, a long syllable with high tone on the second mora: umugeenzi d aatabuj a umwaana mugeenzi daatabuga mwaana
/
For these nouns, the vocative differs tonally from the citation form. A noun that lacks an initial vowel even in the citation
form, thus makes possible a pair of sentences which differ only i n t one :
N tabaar a d a a t a . N tabaar a d a a t a .
I help my fa th er .
[/daata/
man.]
4l8
BASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 26
3.
/-ka-/ :
H aapfuuy
U ror a
h e eh e n k a k wuunguru z a ?
g oing ,
and I < 11
Each of these sentences may be compared with a pair of simpler s entenc e s : Haapfuu y e i ki ? What is out of order? I [ 3 11 j h el p yo u .
N dagufasha .
U rora b e c h e ? N dakwuunguruz a .
W here ar e
y o u h e a d e d '?
[For practice with t;his use of /-ka-/, and for additional examples, s ee Exer c i s e 9.
]
- ki r i z a
to cure
419
UNIT 26
KIRUNDI
/ -z- /
+/- k i z i
k o w o o s h o b o r a k u w u u n k i r i za .
S ee i f
y ou ca n
f ix it for m e .
5.
Fo rms that contain two ob ect r e f i x e s . The infinitive in this sentence contains two object
( or: n j e )
ku~ikugurira
The first of the two prefixes (/-yi/) stands for /isaansi/, which would be the direct object of the verb, w hil e p ref i x
object .
t h e se cond
first prefix has high to ne, and the first syllable of the s t em
has high tone. [ For practice with infinitives that contain two object prefixes, see Exercise 5.]
I mmediate disjunct indicative forms follow the sam e t ona l rul e:
Ndakiku g u r i r a . (/-gur a/ ,
a l ow
I [ >11] b u y i t
f or y ou .
verb
I [ a l l ] g et i t f or y o u .
f or 42O
me.
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 26
N aakguf a t i y e .
A hesternal form i s :
[ today] .
Narakigufatiye.
[The student may want to explore for himself the tonal pa tterns
used when two object prefixes are used with some of the verb forms that are not covered by these few examples. ]
Umuduga waamupfaanye . Imashiini yaamupfaanye. Imashiini yaampfaanye. Ipikipiki yaampfaanye. Ipikipiki yaamupfaanye. Urubaangaangwe r waam upfaa n y e .
/
j'eewe
Urubaangaangwe r waampfaanye.
U rugupf a an y
r u r Xh e ?
ikar a a mu
Iyi-/Irigupfaany
(r)i r Xhe?
42l
UNIT 26
KIRUNDI
Ikaraamu (r)yaamupfaanye.
Iyi-/Irimupfaany
(r)i r Khe?
imboga jeewe imir Xma
we
/
/
Imboga zaamupfaanye .
I zimupfaany
e
e
zirXhe?
Izigupfaany z i rXhe?
I yigupfaany
irXhe?
I yimup f aany ir X h e ? e
w a te r . <
>That [ i
. e . wat e r ]
n e ed . <
i s what I amaazi
N iyo n k e n e y e . N iyo n k e n e y e .
N iwo n k e n e y e .
/ /
isaansi
umuunyu
/
y a a mper a ny e .
U muunyu w a a mp e r a n y e .
/ /
I sukaar i U muceri
y a a mp er a ny e , w a amperany e .
/
N iyo n k e n e y e .
N iwo n k e n e y e .
A mahoonda yaamperanye .
U buro
/
N iyo n k e n e y e .
N ibwo n k e n e y e . N iy o N iy o N ivy o N iz o Niyo N iy o
/
b w a a mp e r a n y e .
/
ivyaamwa
indimu
Ivyaamwa vyaamperanye .
I ndimu zaamperanye .
amKgi inzoga
BASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 26
amavuta
A mavuta y a amperany e .
N iyo n k e n e y e .
N ivy o
/
i bi t o o k e
umwaanya
/
Ibitooke vyaamperanye.
Umwaanya waamperanye .
nk eneye.
/
N iwo n k e n e y e .
Exercise 3 .
s emanti c a l l y r el at ed ~wh - q u e s t i o n . >How can yo u l a c k w a t e r , an d you in an inhabited area?l> wewe Ukabur am aazi uri mu mihanaf a
/
<Why do y ou l a c k water rt
Ni kuki
u buz
a maazi ?
geewe
we tweebwe
/ /
Ni kuki
Ni kuki
mbu z a maazi ? e
a buz e a maazi ?
mweebwe bo
m ubuz a m a a z i ? e
/
b abuz
a maazi ?
E xerc i s e
Nti b a a n z i
4.
.
N oogiraante ko ba taanzi ?
W hat shall I do ,
[ si n c e ]
know me '?
t hey d on>t
Simfis am afaraanga. e
/
N oogiraante ko nt'afis
a m a f a r a anga ?
Sindavyuumviise.
/
N oogiraante ko ntavyuumviise ?
now].
423
UNIT 26
/ /
KIRUNDI
Ntibaraabiinsiguurira.
T hey ha v en> t
i t t o me .
explai ned
Noogiraante ko bataraabiinsiguurira?
S ii n z i
/
k wo o g a .
I haven>t finished y e t .
I>m back .
e k o n g a r u t se ?
/
I>ve forgotten.
i mb w a .
T hey'v e p r e s e n t e d m e w it h a d o g . e
imbwa? People aren't glad to see me d o i n g t h i s .
N oogiraante ko baangabi y
Baraangaya .
N oogir a a n t e
k o b a a ngaya?
424
B ASIC CO U R SE
UNIT 2 6
Exercise 5. V a riation of both object prefixes in a single word. <Wat;er is what I w ant. <
amaazi
/
>Let me g o s ome fo r
a n d a s k f or you. i
A maazi A maazi
ni y o ns h a a k a . ni y
0
we
isaansi
/
as haa k a .
a sh a a ka .
0
I s a a ns i l saans i
ni y ni y o
tweebwe
ni z o
ni z o
Amavuta n iyo bashaaka. Hiinga nje kuyabasabira. A mavuta I r a ang i ni y o ns h a a k a . Hiinga nje kuyagusabira.
we inyama
igipfuundikizo
Iraangi n ir y I nyama ni z
0
a shaa k a .
ni c
0
H ii ng a n j e k uzi m u s a b i r a .
Hi i n g a n j e k uki m u s a b i r a .
Igipfuundikizo
ashaaka.
tweebwe
/ /
Igipfuundikizo
nico
dushaaka.
i bi c e r i
Ibiceri ni.vyo
d ushaa k a .
UNIT 26 bo
amaazi
Amaazi
n i y o b a sh a a k a .
jeewe
A maazi
ni y o ns h a a k a .
Exercise 6. The construction of Sentence 17. >What<s the matter that you<re not happy?< kuneezeerwa
k wi i h u u t a
/ /
u t a n e e z e r ew e n
amak i ?
K u tiihuuse n . amaki? 0 i K K
0
k wii r u k a k wii c a r a
/
u tiirutse n u t iicaye n
a m aki? a m aki?
i
K u taryaamye n . amaki?
0
/
K u tagarutse n
0
/
a m a ki '?
/
(neg. o f j - v u g a /)
0
/
u t a vuze
n . am a k i?
i
kuvyuuka
u t a vyuutse kare n
a m aki?
E xerci s e
7.
me t oo. >
jeewe
kgbona wewe g uf a s h a
/
B aaramutabaaye .
B aaramuboo n y e , B aaramubo o n y e .
/
/
B aaramufash i g e .
N aawe bazooguf a s h a .
426
B ASIC C O U R SE
U NIT 2 6
we
Baaramufashije.
kugaya
tweebwe k ur a mu t s a mweebwe k ut a b a a r a
/
Haararnugaye.
Baaramugaye. Baaramuramukije.
B aaramur a mu k i g e .
/
B aaramutabaaye .
nk aguf aeha ?
U keney
i k i n k am u b a z a ?
Unaaz .
1~
i v ~ a a a n ka mu b a z a ?
Uraaz
ah
aaba nk a m waandik i r a ?
Do you k n o w wh er e
h e l i v es ,
a nd I < l l
wr i t e t o h i m.
u r u p a a p uro n k a a ndik i k e e t e .
427
UNIT 26 Exerc i s e
A shaa k
KIRUNDI 9.
iki ?
N daki mwe e r e k a .
I will show it
W here ar e
W here ar e y o u g o i n g , an d w e>11 go t o g e t h e r .
W hat did he ask f o r ? I <11 give it to h im .
Yasavy
i ki ?
N daki mu h a .
Y asavy
i k i nk a m u h a ?
What did he ask for, and I>11 give it to him? W here di d he pass by'?
Y aci i y K h e ? Ndamukuri k i r a.
I >1 1 f o l l ow h i m .
Yaciiyehe nkamukurikira?
W here di d
h e p a s s b y , so I
c an follow him ?
Ashaak
a i ki ?
W hat doe s h e
I >1 1 b r i n g i t
want ?
f or h i m.
Ndaki mu g u r i r a . A shaak
i k i n k a k imugurira ?
W hat does he want, and I > l l buy it for him'? W hat s i ck n e s s h as h e co n t ract e d ?
Agwaay
i ki ?
Ndamuvuura.
/
I >11 c ur e
e
hi m.
A gwaay
i k i nk a m u v u u r a ?
428
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 26
[From this point on, students and instructor should devise their own practice conversations, by recombining vocabulary and grammatical structures that are already familiar. I t is suggested that
g ood first lines for th ese conversations would be 1 , 12 , 17 , 2 6 ,
UNIT 27
KIRUNDI
UNIT 27
BASIC S E NTENCES
government
The government of Burundi head to administer king The h e a d o f t h o se w ho go v e r n the country of Burundi is
Ub u r u u n d i .
umutwe ( 3, 4 )
-gaba (-gavye)
umwaami
2.
(1, 2)
U mutwe w
a b agab a
c
i gihugu
Ubu r uu n d i
t he k i n g .
n umwaami .
-haangaama (-haangaamye ) 3. U b u h ahaangaamye Mwaambutsa wa kane. 4. U m w a ami akurikirwa na baa<ministres>. - shi i n g a ( -s h i i n z e )
t o pu t a s t i ck i n t h e The king is followed by
t o a s c en d
t h e t hr o n e
N o w M wambutsa IV is on tne t hr o n e .
m ini s t e r s .
t o p ut i n shap e l aws
( -teget s e )
to make / e n f o r c e
g over n m e n t economy
(14) (14)
<mi n i st r e > wa n a ab a a n d i
Ther e i s t h e p r i me mi n i s t er , a nd o t h e r s w ho a r e p u t i n
a mbere ,
who
BASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 27
ubugavyi n u b utegetsi
bw ababa mu gi hugu,
a
i ndero , i bi i ndi . umushiingamKteeka legislator ubut uunzi , n
(1, 2)
6.
Hari n a b ashiingamateeka. a - i i t e g e r e z a (-iitegereje ) iteeka The r e are also legislators. t o wa t c h , law s u p er v is e
(5, 6)
a
A bo r e er o b i i t eg e r e z amateek
ak o r e e s h wa
9.
A b a s h iingamateeka
b at o o r w a n a i gi hugu .
-gabanya
(-gabanige)
11.
A m a > p r o v i n c e s < a t e g e k wa
n a ba a l g o u v e r n e u r s <.
The p r o v i
n c e s a r e g o v er n e d by
g overno r s .
KIRUNDI
z i t e g e kwa n a ba>administrateurs <. 1 3. ( Za ) < A r r o n d i s s e ment s < zigabanijwemwo zaa<communes<. intaahe 14.
adminis trators.
T he ar r o n d i s s e ment s
are
(9, 10)
abadasi g a a na
(1, 2)
umugaambwe 1 5. M u B u r u u ndi h a r
(3, 4)
i migaambwe minin . i ibiri: ari b o < Fron t A b a d a s i gaana U P R ONA n a C o mmun . <
u buteg e t s i iminwe
16.
(14)
power
h and , hands
(4)
432
BASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 27
umugaambwe.
18. Mu mategeko ntashobora
no ku g i r According to the law , he
c annot a
umu ga a m b we k
0
f or
o n e p a r t y ov er
y eer e k a n a k uru t
ak u u n z e
u wu u n d i . elec t i on
i t o or a ( 5 , 6 )
-heruuka
( -heruut s e
)
t o wi n seat o ne who g o v e r n s I n t h e l a s t el ec t i on s , t h e party called UPRONA was t he on e t h a t w o n ,
- t s i i n d a ( -t s i i n z e ) i nt e b e
uwutwaara
19. Mw iitoora riheruuka umugaambwe wiitwa UPRONA niwo watsiinze. kubwa 20. Kubwi itegeko ryaashiinzwe
a ccor d i n g
to
n a b ashiingamateeka
iriindi toora rizoohora
every
f i v e ye ars
i t a a n ih e z e . u
433
UNIT 27 I ntwaar o y
2.
KIRUNDI Ubur u u n d i .
4.
a b a a n d i b a a shiinzwe gutegek
ibikorwa mu gihugu:
u bugavyi n
a a
u b u t e g e tsi b w ab a b a
i b iindi.
6. 7.
H a r i n a b a shiingamKteeka. a
/ /
8. 9.
10. Igihugu kigabanigwe mu maiprovinces.> 11. Ama>provinces I ategekwa nabaaigouverneurs>. 12. Ama<provinces> agabanigwe muri za>arrondissements>, zitegekwa na ba>administrateurs.>
13.
14.
baa I commune > . 1 5. M u B u r u u ndi ha r ariy o 1 6. 1 7. i m i g a a m bwe mini n i b i r i : C o mmun . > A badas i g a a n a
U m w a am i n t a shobora kugi r
u m u gaambwe.
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 27
a kuunze k u r u t
uwu u n d i .
it a a n ita a n ih ez e . u u
1.
Me t hod of l u r alizin u n a ssimilated French nouns. Compare the singular and plural forms of these nouns, none
of which has been completely assimilated into the pronunciation system of the language. u mu<gouverneu r < umu <administrateur< u mu>bourgmest r e < umu>mini s t r e < b aa<gouverne u r < ba<administrateur< b aa<bourgmest r e > baa<ministre<
In the singular of the above Class 1 nouns, the regular prefix /umu-/ is used. The plural /baa-/ has no initial vowel, and the vowel that it has is long. i>Commune< zaa>communes> ama<communes3 i >pr o v i n c e < zaa>prov i n c e s < a ma>provi n c e s 3 > arrond i s s ement >
(10)
(6)
(10)
(9)
(10)
(6)
435
UNIT 27
KIRUNDI
Those which in French begin with a consonant have initial / i - / are in Class 9. Th e last example, which begins with a vowel in
F rench, has no pr efix of any k ind in the s ingular .
and
T h e plurals
2.
Pa s s i v e st ems .
H e uses many b o o k s .
I bitabo bikoreeshwa n i v y iinshi.
T he books
t h a t a r e u s e d a r e many.
In these two pairs of s en tences, the difference between a ctive and pa ssive verb st ems is marked by the p r e s ence or ab s en c e of the extension /-w-/, which is found af ter the o ther ex tensions
(if any), right before the final vowel. T his represents the most
c ommon way of fo rming passives, but there are a nu m ber of e x c e p tions.
B ASIC C O U R S E
UNIT
27
A cti v e
Passiv e
-ha
w ith perfect stems : - haay e
/
<give>
but
-haabwa
< be gi v e n <
-haawe
-ca - ci i y e
/
> pass by ,
- c i i bw a - ci i w e
/
- ry a
<eat <
-ri i
bw a
- ri i ye
- r i i we
c onfor m t o
The con s t r u c t i o n
/
< e v er y
y ear s <
a
( e. g .
II
S t c . 2 0).
it a an i i t a anu.
Il
/
T he length of an i n t erval is expressed by reduplication of th e a ppropriate numeral, as in the ab ove examples . first vowel of the se cond half has high tone . initial vowel is pr esent with both halves N o t e that the N o t e a l s o t ha t an
of the reduplication,
437
UNIT 27
KIRUNDI
and that the last vowel of the first half is assimilated to the
quality of the init;ial vowel of the second half; the two
is p r o n ounced:
or:
[ i t a t i i t at ; u ] [ i t a t i t at ' u ]
4.
A u se of n a wh i c h does not corres ond toEn lish >have>, I with < o r < a n d > . Har abashiingamKteeka.
/
Hari n a b ashiingamKteeka. a
/ /
y eerekana k
l lw11undi .
akuu n z e k u r u t ; a
don>t k no w how t o
Siinzi no kugisoma.
In t ;he
n ouns.
438
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 27
5.
Tw o alternate wa s of usin C l a ss 18. Compare Sentences 12, 13 of the basic dialogue: Ama>provinces> agabanigwe muri za<arrondissements.>
The provinces are divided into a r rondissements.
Za<arrondissements< zigabanigwemwo zaa>communes<. Za<arrondissements> zigabanigwe muri zaa<communes <. The arrondissements are divided into communes.
The interchangeability of /muri/ and /-mwo/ which appears i n t h e a b o v e p a i r s of s ent e n c e s i s n ot p er m i s s i b l e i n m o s t s i t ua t i on s w h e r e /muri/ is used:
/
e e e
amafaraanga mw iibaanki.
/
H e has money i n t he b a n k .
amafaraangamwo ibaanki. b a a n k i.
/
A kora mur i
He work s bank.
in a
But
E xercise l .
UNIT 2 (
KIRUNDI
T uzoogurir
i p a am p a
i Bu j u u m b u r a .
I paampa rizoogurirwKhe ?
Y ohaani yariin z
ibiro.
I ntozi zaandiiy e g o .
e
N ari i w e
i i n t oz . ego .
i
I was bitten by a n t s
y est e r d a y .
E xerc i s e
s t an d <There
2.
/ na/
~There ar e
< There are white ants and army ants in the Co n g o . >
H ari h
um u s w a i K o o n g o . a
i i n tozi.
H ariho n H arih
0
u m u swa n
iin t o z
i K o ongo.
44o
BASIC COURSE
UNIT 2 7
Harimwo n i m vubu. a
H arimw
0
i n g o ona n
imv u b u .
[ Make up s i m i l a r
s e t s of s en t e n c e s u s i n g :
/intare/
and / i n g we /;
/ u r u n y e g er i / and / u muswa/ ;
/ i n z u u zi / a n d / i m i s o z i / , / i m y o onga/ . ]
He r e t u r n s weeks. i
ev ery t w o
a b i r . aabiri.
He returns [regularly)
e ver y t wo we e k s .
[ The s t u d e n t
sh o u l d c on st r u c t
s e n t en c e s s i mi l a r
t o t hes e ,
in
which he tells how of ten he d oes certain things, or how o f t en c ertain events take pla c e .
44l
UNIT 27
KIRUNDI
Exer c i s e
4.
S en t en c e s u s i n g / - h e r u u k a
1
/
H e was ill during th e l ast days of la s t m onth . We travelled around d uring the last we e k o f last mon th .
gu h e z e.
/
u u kwe e z i
gu h e ze . i
A mafaraan g
/
ar ad u h e r e r a k u m u u s .
u k wee z i .
u her u u k
D uher u u k a
k ub a b o n a .
ago.
Duher u u k a Aheru u k a gushika. g u ki r a .
/
W e arrived recently .
H e re c o v e r e d / She h a d
a b ab y r e ce n t l y .
/
Ejo nzoov
/
i B u j u u m b ura ubw
i imper u u k a .
B ASIC C O U R S E
UNIT 28
( -zi i n d u t s e 1A
t;his morning. (<Today d awned ba d l y . < ) I t h i n k i t >s g oi n g t ; o r ai n . to last all day b ad weat h er : c l ou d y but n o t r ai ny It may not rain, but it will b e c l o u d y a l l day .
2A
(11)
3B
4A 5B 6A
H ow do yo u k n o w (it ) .
I look at; the clouds.
7B
(very)
8A
Noone r ee r o h a g w a i m v u r a
n ke k u k
0
i b i cu
So it will rain little ( rai n ) since the clouds are not heavy.
b i t a r e my e .
u muyaga (3, 4 )
wind
~IT 9 13
KIRUNDI
uvyiirukana ntibiroonk
It will drive them away so that they don>t have time t o ge t h e a v y e n o u g h t o r ai n ( rai n ) .
umwaanya wo k u r e ma
n go bigwemw
0
- bwi i r a
10A
( -bwii y e )
Ico n i c o k i b i kubwiira
gusa? agashuuhe
(12)
h eat c h a r a c t e r i z e d b y
humidity
i kir e er e
(7, 8)
1 13
Oy a , ntiwuumva k a t a a
0
t her e
i s n > t [ much] h u m i d i t y ?
g ashuuhe k a r i k ire er e .
2.
mu
harya
12C H ar y a i k i n i ik i mu Kir u u n d i ?
by the
way
i kir a a t o 13D
i
(7, 8)
it? S inuu-
shoe
Iv y o s. ibiraato?
1 4C
Nsu b i r i r a m wo . mvi i s e .
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT28
3
1 5E
mugeenzi Nb e g a h a r y a m u K i r u u n d i
>mugeenzi< birataan dukaa ny e n
courteous a p pellation
i n K i r u nd i ?
< umugeenzi > ? 1 6F Caa n e n y e n e . - ubaha 1 7F Mu g e e n z i n < sir > ubwii r a caane. 18E Nt i w o ombarir i n gene a mpava mbaz i n zira ni a n azimi r a ? - raan g i r a 19F Uh ez e ugi r e u t i : a
i n z ira iroor
Y es i n d e e d f ( - u b a s h e) uk uv u g a to respect Nu eenzi ~ m e a n s ( <is Zo < sir < o r > madam< when yo u are a d d r e s s i n g s o meone whom y ou r e s p ec t v e r y m u c h .
say<)
c a a n k e <madame> u w o w u u bashe
( -raangiy e }
to
show
n daangir i 2 0E
No on e n t a a ku u n d i m ubiv u g a ?
uburyo
21F
(14 }
Ther e it.
way
a r e m a n y w a y s t o s ay
KIRUNDI teacher How many t e a c h er s a r e o n y our f a c u l t y ? {<By how m any t e a c h er s a r e y o u t aught ? < )
There are about fifty t ea c h e r s .
23H
i t aanu.
u mwiir a b u r e
(1, 2)
a bl a c k p e r s o n a whi t e p e r s o n
Are they black or wh i te'?
{ 11, 10 )
m ix t u r e They I r e m i x e d .
Ab e e n s h i n i baa n d e ? u bwii n s h i
(14)
2 7H
Bam e z e n k
abaa n g a n a
mu bwiinshi .
1A 2A
Ngira ng i m vur
0
i r a gwa.
Nda a b
i b i cu .
/
N oone b i r y a b ic u
si ivy
i imvur a ?
446
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 2 8
7B 8A 9B
E ego , mugabo n t ibiremye caane. Noo n e r eero hagwa imvura nke kuk i b icu bitaremye.
0
Oya ,
nt i w uumv u y u muyaga? a
/
Ni w o vyiirukana n t ibiroonk e
/ /
i mvura.
at a a g a s h u uhe kari mu k i r e er e .
Har y a i k i
nii k i m u K i r u u n d i ?
Iv y o
ibi r a a to?
1 6F 1 7F
Caa n e n y e n e ! M u g e enz i
/
ugir
Noo ne
n ta a k u u n d i mu b ivuga ?
23H
2 4G
Har
Ni abii r a b u r e ca ank e n
2 5H 2 6G
N. ur uv a a n g e .
i
Abe e n s h i
ni
baan d e ?
447
UNIT 28 27H
1.
t ha t ] ? In the last of these sentences, it might be possible to say that the noun antecedent of / bi- /
like
i n / bi i n d i / i s s o m e t h i n g
> /ib i i
nt u / understood. >
I n t h e f i rs t two s en tences , no
such >understood antecedent< can be found for / -ku-/ i n / k u u n d i /. Compare also the sentence'. Ntaa buryo b u undi b uundi buryo m u b ivuga?
( C l . 1 ' 7)
T he phr a s e s / bury o
/.
Exer c i s e
l .
[ Th e s t u d en t
sh ou l d com p l e t e t h e se p ar t i a l l y
l i k e t hi s ? >
<He sai d
Abi vu z e
i t s o m e o t h e r w a y .>
uk u u n d i .
448
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 28
Y abivuz e g u t y a ? Y abivuz e g u t y a ?
Y abivuz e u k u u n d i . Y abivuz e u k u u n d i .
E xerci s e
2. gutya? uk u u n d i .
/
N iwe y a g i z e Y agi z
Niwe
/
yagi z
uk uundi .
449
UNIT 28
KIRUNDI
E xerci s e
3. T ubivuga g u t y o gusa.
B ASIC C O U R S E
UNIT 28
2.
T he u s e of
The stem /-ti/ is a verb stem, which takes the usual subject prefixes, though non-personal subject prefixes with / - t i /
a re rare . T h i s s t e m i s no t in f lected in any o t her way , how ev er .
He says / s a i d ,
h ungr y . t
tItm
A zoovuga a t i
nda s h o o n g e .
A zoogir a
a t i n da s h o o n g e .
He t o l d me , tItm
h ungry . <
Exercise 4. The following three sentences illustrate the c ontr a s t b etween us e o f /-ti/ followed by an indicative verb, and /ko/
f ollowed by a r e l a tive verb . The student should assemble a
number of other sets of three sentences related to one another in this way, and then use them for practice.
A ti :
A vuze k o a sh o o n g e .
UNIT ~8
KIRUNDI
3.
A bstract nouns of Cl . 14 .
Many adjectives, and many nouns which are not in Class 14, have counterparts in Class 14. T he. Class 14 noun is almost invariably abstract.
iinshi nini to
/
umusore
ubusore
b achel o r h o o d , y oung a d u l t h o o d
(male)
umuuntu
u muvyeey i u mwii r a a b u r e umuriinzi
/
person
p a r en t negr o
ab u r e n zi
guard
king c hi l d oldest child
umwaami
umwaana i mf u r a
/
4g2
B ASIC C O U R SE
UNIT 28
d aatabug a
bos s , ov er s e e r
ubuga
s lav e r y
E xerc i s e 5 . [ The student should assemble further pairs of w o r d s , one member of each pair being an abstract noun of Class 14.j
E xerc i s e
kuru
6.
o ld(person) ,
elder farmer
to know
an
power,
authori t y
umurimyi
-menya -isa
agri c u l t u r e
ubumenyi
good man
d i r e c t ion in w h i ch a dul t manhood
umugabo
amareenger o
west
s omeone or s o m e t hin g d i s a p p e a r e d
to b e c ome e a s y u bwoor o h e
/
s of t n e s s
453
UNIT 28
Ne at;ive infinitives .
KIRUNDI
S entence Q c o n t a i n s :
I rashobor a Compare al so: k u t a gw a . I t may not ra in .
A rashobor a k u t a a z a .
Aras h o b o r a k u d a s h i k a uy u
W hat are the ru les for pr edicting the t;one of the negative in -
predicting whether the negative prefix will have the form /-ta-/
o r /-da-/ ?
Exercise 7 . [ T h e s t u d ent should assemble a number of a d d i tional s entences, useful in his own daily li f e , which contain negative
i n f i n i t i v es .
4g4
B ASIC C O U R S E
Ur4?V Z8
ni
Sentence 18 contains a new use of / n i / : Ntiwoombarira ingene mpava mbaza inzira n i nazimira. Please tell me how I ask [my ] way in case I get l ost . cf . a l so : N(zoo) g i r a a nt e
ni nazimira?
[ - z oo - i f b ey o n d today ]
[anyti me]
W hat do
but not :
+ Noogira ant e
n i n a zimira?
<55
UNIT a8
KIRUNDI
Use of the construction with / ni/ plus a relative verb seems to be confined to instances where the action referred to is future. C omparable sentences where the action is not future have a participial verb ( e. g . E xerci s e 8.
/ n z i m i y e/ ) a n d d o n o t h a v e / ni / .
[The student should assemble additional sentences of this kind, and as certain for each sentence the appropriate
BASIC COURSE
UNIT 28
457
UNIT 29
KIRUNDI UNIT 29
Unit 29 consists of a number of short dialogues on a variety of topics. T hey contain little that is new, either in vocabulary or i n g r a mmar .
Tones are not marked at a ll, and in dication of vowel l en g th is inconsistent . T h e E n g l ish translations are rough, and ev en
this way, the dialogue may serve as the model for new sentences. Finally, one or two lines from each dialogue should be used as the starter for a series of free conversations.
G ood morni n g
John)
n > a maki ?
- ra a z a
( for )
[ t o f i ni sh ]
Ni v y i z a , g en d a u k o r e .
Fi ne ,
g o an d wo r k .
U zibariza ik i ?
B ASIC CO U R SE
UNIT pg
Har>umuntu yant;umiye.
M bona ar > i s a h a
N lag a s a g a
y < i c enda.
ndagi ye .
E gome g e n d a
n < amahor o l
3
Mwaramutse. B wakeye. N> a ma k i ? G ood morni n g . G ood morni n g . How a r e y o u ?
(>cook>)?
Shall I give you the menu (<the paper where it is w ri t t e n d o w n < )? That would be kind of you.
I l i k e t h es e .
N guhe ur u p a p ur o
vyandit s eko?
Z ir a n d i t s e H agarar a
k u r up a p u r o . n d ar ugusubi z e .
It<s (written ) on t h e m e n u .
Wait; and I<11 bring it back to
UNIT 29
KIRUNDI
Here t h e y a r e . Ta k e wh a t t ev e r y ou w a n t . Th i s o n e i s v er y nice.
R ead.
I t i s written.
5.
D ufise abana ba ta tu . T ura b a k o r e r a i v y o d u sh o b o r a We h ave three children.
W e do t h e
can f o r
b e s t , { Iwhatev e r < ) we
t h em.
vyose.
T urabambika t u k a n abagaburira . We clothe them an d w e f e e d t h em .
{ moreover )
U mugoroba wos e t u r a b u h a g i r a .
46o
BASIC COURSE
UNIT 29
6.
B wakey e . Good mo r n i n g .
G ood morni n g . M y name i s ( <I'<m call e d > ) Joseph, [and] I come from K it e g a . And I<m Henri. I come from
N gozi .
Nasize
h a v u gwa ameza.
O o, woba u n t a b a y e J
7
-ramukanya ( r amukan i j e
na
t o g r e e t on e a n o t h e r I < d l i k e y ou t o me e t Hen r i .
46l
UNIT 29 Amahoro n e z a
Amahoro
n e z a g a An t ; o n i a we .
utunyoobwa (13)
N kuro n d e r e r e u t u n y o b w a ?
Thanks . h ur r y .
Ex cu s e m e.
I Im i n a
8.
Ngomba ku bla i N g o z i .
N tiwombarira inzira nkurikira ? Fata ibarabara rikuru rirora i Ki gal i . I s t h at t h e on e t h a t t a k e s me
I want to go to Ngozi. C o uld you tell me t;he way to go? (. .the way that I follow?>
to Kigali.
N iryo rinshikana i Ng o z i ?
t o Ngo z i ?
Oya. I gi s aga r a uger ak o N o. T h e p l a c e t hat you w i l l g et t o wh e n y o u h a v e p a s s e d I kibira is Bukeye Mi ssion .
-sohoka - si g a z a
( -soho t s e ) ( -s h i g a j e )
to get out of to leave a part of s omet h i n g How far will I st ill have t;o go?
Nzoba
n s h i g a j e u r u g en d o r u -
ngana i k i
? 462
BASIC CO U R SE
UNIT 29
-baandaanya (-baandaanige)
R unini . Uban d a n y e u g e r e m u Uf at e i bar a b a r a
t o go
on
K ayanza . r y<i
i
b u r y o l er o , r i kug e z a
A long way. You go on until y ou ge t t o K a y a n z a . Th en you take the road to the right, which takes you to Ngozi.
Ngozi .
H ow is
t h e r oa d ?
is good.
9.
N u Burund i menshi? E e, n on e i bi sa g a r a v y o s e n a zamisiyoni ntibifantanijwe n <amabarabar a ? Y ose none a meze n k > ay a y < i
Bu) umbur a? Yes, aren>t all the cent ers of
a m a b ar a b ar a n i
A re r o a d s a r e n u m e r ou s i n B urundi ?
(of) a t
k aabur i i m b o
B u gumbura?
macadam
(9)
063
UNIT 29 10.
n t a b wo
KIHUNDI
f or m. ]
N tabwo uturuka muri Am erika ? A ren't you from Am er i ca ? Y es, indeed, I<m an Am e r i can . When di d y ou co m e h er e ?
N ape mu kwez i
M u kuza waje mu k i ?
H ow di d y o u c o m e ? ( >In c o mming . . . < ) I c ame by p l a n e . How long will you stay here?
M u kuza ,
n aj e muu n dege.
d o n > t k n ow .
I nj i r a 1 N daguhaye bwakeye .
B wakey e n e z a . N oshob or a Dir e k i k ub o nana n a
464
BASIC C O U R SE
UNIT
29
Wamubaza iki?
- saba ( - s a v y e )
Namusaba < bourse > yo
kwiga muri Am erika
(-uzuJe)
m u k a r an i a g u h e k wuzuza.
n < a g a s a ga . ama h o r o .
T hank y ou .
Good l u c k .
Go o d b y e .
12.
ku c i g i r a i no none ?
I>ve heard that you speak it well. Did you begin the study of it here?
few, little No, I knew a li t tle when I
keeya Q ya, n a p e n z i gi k e y a .
came.
Urumva i y o ab a r u n d i b a v u g a ? D o you understand it when th e Baru nd i p e op l e s p e a k ?
N<umwigeme.
Y avut s e r y ar i ?
She<s a
W hen wa s She wa s
gi r l .
sh e bor n ? bor n i n
t47.
465
UNIT 29 i tari k i
KIRUNDI
(9, 10)
I t>s ( o n ) May 1 9 .
W here
does she l i v e ?
bacu.
She lives with our parents. employment, work, )ob Does sh e No, sh e h a v e a j ob ? doesn' t . does she d o ?
(3, 4)
A rafise umurimo ?
T hen what
Araciga amashuli.
[i n]
Yigi s hwa
- t a ang a
( - t aa n z e)
to pay
W ho>s the tuition paid by ?
Nti b a t u n z e
ca n e .
466
BASIC CO U R SE
U NIT
29
Do the y [ yes, j
D o the y b o t h w o r k ? ( Yes, )
W here d o
T hey work in an o f f i c e .
T hey ge t
B arayar e r e s h a
a b an a b a b o .
dren. B arabagur i r a i nd y a b a f u n g u r a ,
They buy them the food th ey
eat, the clothes they wear, impuzu bambara, ibitabu biga n > i v y o b a s o ma. umuryaango - t e er a
t h e b o o k s t h ey s t u d y an d
t hose t h e y r e a d .
(3, 4)
( - t ee y e)
A riko ntiturashirwa .
467
UNIT 29 14. M be ur i g a ?
KIRUNDI
Ar e yo u
a s t u d e n t ? ( <Do you
study? ~)
E gome, maze imyaka ine mur i k ol e j i . Wiga m u r i k o l ej i i yi he? What school do you s t udy at;? I study in the Bujumbura s e c o n d ary s c h o o l . Yes, Itve had four years of s econ d ar y s ch oo l .
There a r e s e v e n t e e n o f us i n m y cl a s s .
y anj e .
A bo mwi g a n a b a v a h eh e ? W here do the memb ers of th e s tudent body come fr om ?
Batu r u k a
n k a h o s e m u B u ru n d i .
i gih ar u r o
(7, 8)
We st u d y
ot her
cou r s e s .
468
B ASIC CO U R SE
U NIT 2 9
15.
-t eg e r e z wa
/
( -teger ej we
t o b e r e q u i r e d , ob liged
W hat l a n g u ag e a r e y o u s u p p o s e d
t o s p e a k i n s ch o o l ?
Frenc h
i s r e qu i r e d .
D o t h e s t u d e nts like Fr en ch ?
A benshi
n <abagikunda.
M ost o f
l ike
t h e m ( are o n e s w h o)
i t;. un d i c l a s s es d o
How many K i r
y ou hav e a
week?
l6. i gi t a b u
(7, 8)
by ou r
g iven
p a r e n t s ; ot he r s ar e
b y t h e s ch o ol . to finish
-tooza (-toogege)
U zotoza amashuli rya r i ?
469
UNIT 29
Nshigaje imyaka ibiri muri
KIRUNDI
I still have two ye ars in
s econdary s c h o o l . Kole j i
Utog e j e
.
K ol e gi u zo ) a h e ?
uni -
I >11 try to go to a u n i v e r si ty .
- anka ( - a n s e )
M ugabo har i ab a n d i b a y a n k a . B ut t h e r e
a r e ot h e r s w h o
d on~t like it .
N one wewe ukunda i n z o g a y <I k i r u n d i ? Jewe nywa inzoga y>Ikirundi n <iy < I k i z u n g u . Mugabo inzoga z>Ikizungu
z ira z i m b a . Z itwa ngo ik i ?
Do yo u
j ike
Kir u nd i
b e er '?
B ut E u r o p ean b e e r i s ex p e n s i v e .
~Primus< ni yo nyinshi.
I kor e r w a
hehe i yo
4yo
BASIC COURSE
UNIT 29
i cupa ( 5, 6 )
I cupa r i g u r w a a m a i'aran g a
ibir e enga
(8) (c f
/ - r e e nga/)
higher
(to g o
b e y o n d)
or more.
(7, 8)
p ri c e ,
c o s t , cha r g e
Price s h e r e a r e n o t so hi gh a s in Ameri c a .
(17)
You ar e
t he t r u t h
r i ght .
18.
Ikirundi ni kimwe mu Bu rundi bwose? Is Kirundi the same throughout B urun d i ?
-gaaniira (-gaaniriiye )
to converse part , s ec t i on
i mpaande (9 ,
10)
S tudy K i r u n d i [andj you will conv erse o n w h a t e v e r s u b j e c t you like in all parts of
B urun d i .
z >Ubur u n d i .
471
UNIT 29
KIRUNDI
Is Kirundi har d to J earn?
..)
to be zealous, diligent
-it ako
Nzoger a g e z a Ushat s e
( - i t aa y e k o )
k uc i t ak o .
n zo k w i g i s h a .
T hank yo u v e r y m u c h .
B ut I have a th ick sku l l . I <11 try to make you un d e r s tand .
N dagukenguru k i y e , Uzonkenguru k i r a
m ugenzi , h a n y u ma.
Thank y ou ,
si r J
19.
A ha ni ho ngishika i Bujumbura . N donder a u w omfas h a . I <ve just arrived in Bujumbu r a . I<m looking for someone wh o m ight help me . W hat kind of help do you w a n t ?
Urond er a
u gu f a s h a k u g i r a g u t e ?
Ukeney e
i ki
none ?
I need a lot of th in g s .
BASIC COURSE
U NIT
2 cg
How might I help you, then? Please show me the way to the h ote l s .
20.
(i.e .
j us t any h ot e l
I h a v e n> t b e e n h e r e a d a y y e t .
21. Hari amahoteli azimba There are some hot els that ar e expensive, and others tha t
n>ayandi atazimba.
a re n o t .
UNIT 29
KIRUNDI
Mu yandi mahoteli ararenga . E rega n>ino ibintu birazimba . Ariko ibintu ntibizimba nko m uri Amerika .
ikiriingo ikiriingo
(7. 8)
ti me , moment
B igurwa 10 0
I t c o s t s 1 0 0 F o r 1 50 F .
22.
Yes, I W here do
hav e ( i t ) . y o u w a n t t o go ?
r el a t i v es
i ncut i
Ku b a g e n z i Mbe umeny an a N <abat a r i
(9, 10)
n o k u n cu t i . n a b en s h i ?
D o you k n o w many
[people J?
bak e .
474.
BASIC CO U R SE
U NIT 2 c }
23.
Abavyeyi
ba we baf'use abana
bangahe?
B afise abahungu batandatu , They h a v e s i x b oy s an d t wo
g ir l s . n <abakobwa ba b i r i .
E mwe muri benshi J
i sn>t
many.
a b a v y ey i b a r e n z a a b a n a
UNIT 30
KIRUNDI UNIT 30
L ike Unit 29, Unit 30 makes heavy demands on the student. I t consists of a series of brief paragraphs on historical and political matters. E ach paragraph appears as a series of numbered sentences. The sentences are followed by a series of questions and answers. Unit 30 has two purposes. T he most obvious is the introductionn of new vocabulary. Th e s e c o n d, and more impo rtant, is
y a
k e e r a vy < i Bu r u n d i .
1. Tumenya ivya keera vy>i Burundi kuva mu mwaaka wa 1850. Umwaami waa mbere w>Uburuundi yari Ntare. 3. Bavuga ko yahaangamye ku ngoma imyaaka myiinshi. 4. Amazina y<Abaami b'i Buruundi n>aayas N t are, Mutaga, Mweezi na Mwaambutsa. 5. N tare avyaara Mweezi, Mweezi akavyaara Mutaaga, Mutaga
n awe a k a v y a a r a M w a a mbu t s a .
6.
Ab a r u u n d i b a r a k u u nd a a b aami b a a b o .
B u r u u ndi barubaha Umwaami rwoose .
7. M u 8.
I c o a v u z e b o ose b a r agikurikiza .
Utub az o
k u vy a ak e e r a vy <i B u r u u n d i . Mbe turaazi ivyaa keera vy>i Buruundi'? Hg ome , ariko i vya keera caane ntavyo tuuzi . M be twaari tuuzi ivyaa keera vy ~iico gihugu imb ere ya 1 8 5 0 ? O ya, na ababizi babizi nka imigani .
BASIC COURSE
UNIT 30
w <18$0.
W iize ivyaa keera vy >igihugu caawe heehe ? m w ~ishur i . 2 . U m w a am i waa m b e ere w <Uburuundi yari Mwaambutsa ? Oya n t a v y o nzi n e ez a . N a v yiize
Uyo mwaami yamaze imyaaka ingaahe ku ngoma? Y a haangamye ku ngoma imyaaka myiinshi. 3. N a a n gwa y a r a r a a mvye k u n g o ma ? E g o me (or) Caane. Ntare yamaze imyaaka 60 atwaara Uburuundi? Oya daata. Noone wiyumviira ko Ntare yatwaaye akangana iki? Kuumbure yatwaaye nk<imyaaka 50. Umwaami yamusubiiriye ku ngoma nii nde? N <Umuhuungu
wiwe mweezi yamusubiiriye . 4. U r a a z i ku m u twe am a zina y'abaami bo mu Bu ruun di ? menshi Amazin a c an e . y a abo ar ar ee nga a ne? Oy a n ~a y o ny e n e . U m w a a m i wa a m b e r e Si
N a a n gw a M u taaga yavyaawe na Mw e e zi ?
Caane.
477
UNIT 30
Mbe uwavyaye Ntare waa mbeere uramuuzi? Oya n < ivyo bavuga mu migani ntibisobanutse neza.
Mweezi w e ewe a v y a a rwa n a a n de ? Av y a r w a n a Nt a r e . N i m w e ene Mutaaga. Abensh i
igihugu.
A baami baatsiindiye ikindi gihugu atari Uburuun d i ?
Oya da. Noone abatwaara mu Buruundi ni baande muri iki gihe? Umwaami Mwaambutsa IV ni we ari ku ngoma, mugabo hatwaara kandi hategeka Leeta y>Uburuundi
B. Ab a zu u n g u b as h i k a m u B ur u n d i .
1. Mu mwaaka w>i 1881 ni ho abapaatri beera baashika mu Rumoonge. 2. Rumoonge n<igisagara kiri ku nkoombe y <ikiyaga ciitwa T aangani k a .
3. A b o b a p a a tri bamaze im i isi mik eey i B uruu n d i . m u g i hugu c <i
478
BASIC CO U R SE
UNIT 30
10. Mu mwaaka w>i 1859 ni ho Richard Burton, na John Speke b aashik a kur i Ta n g a a n i k a .
11. Bahamaaze amayiinga makeeyi gusa. 12. Bavuuye mu Buruundi baciiye bageenda mu biindi bihugu vyo muri Afrika. 13. Haheze imyaaka cumi n>iitatu ni ho Livingston na Stanley batuura mu Buruundi.
Baashitse mu Buruundi (bashikiye mu Rumoonge ) muri 1881. 2. Igisagara ca Rumoonge uraazi aho gihere reye?
Caane. N oone woombwiira aho ico g i s a gara ki r i ?
UNIT 30
KIRUNDI
3. Xbeeye abapaatri baashitse mu Buruundi muri 1881 baararaambiyeho? O yaa ntibahamaze igihe kinini.
B ahaabaaye imiinsi ingaahe noone ? B aahaamaze imiinsi mikeeyi caane .
neza.
M beeye baabiita abaantu non e ? A baruundi bamwe baag' ra ngo abo bazuungu n < ibikooko , abaandi baabiita abaansi . 7. Ba a b i i ci y e h e eh e ? B aabatsiinze mu rusaago rwaabo . M beeye baari bagandikiye kure y <ikiyaga Tanganika ?
O yaa har i
k u nk o mbe y a c o . 480
BASIC CO U R SE
UNIT 30
8.
B aabaateeye amacumu babarasa n >imyaampi . 9. U b w o i m b ere y <aabo Bapaatri nt >abaandi beera baari b w a t uure mu Buruundi ? U raaz i A b o o n g e l eza babiri bari baara sh itseho .
am a z i n a y a a b o n o o n e ? ar i R . Bu r t o n n a J . Sp ek e .
Nkeka k o
10. Aboongeleza Richard Burton na John Speke baashitse muri Afrika ryaari? B a ashitse muri Afrika mu mwaaka wi1859. Abo Boongeleza baarashitse mu Buruundi? E gome, b a r a g ez e k u 1 1. B a a r a h a t e v y e k i y a g a T angani k a .
O yaaye n g i r a n g o
B aar a h e j e ) e b a g e e n d a h e e h e ? B aagiiye kugeenduura ibiindi bihugu vy >Afrika . lg. Hariho uwuundi muzuungu w <umwoongeleza yooba yarabakurikiye m uri Afrika ? Egome.
481
UN1T 30
C.
4. Abaruundi n~Abadaagi bamaze imyaaka barwaana, b arahava b a r u mvi.i k a n a . 5. Umwaami n>abaganwa n<abagabo baremera kubana nmabo banyamahaanga. 6. Bamaze kwumvikana n|Abaruundi, Abadaagi baciye bagereera i Bugumbura. 7. Mu mwanka w Ii 1899 Abadaagi bashiinze ikibaanza
c >Abasirikari i Hugumbura . B ujumbura ni co gisagara gikuru c >Uburuundi .
9.
1 0. Haahamaze nk >imyaaka miroongo ibiri gu sa . 1 1. Batwaye ico gihugu gushika indwaano iteere . 1 2. Intwaro basaanzeho ni yo bagumiJeho . 13. Baretse guhindura intwaro n >imigenzo y <Abaruundi kuko
BASIC COURSE
UNIT 30
18. Abaantu batari bake bo muri ivyo bihugu baraaba A bazuungu n k > i b i k o o k o . 19. Muri ico gihe Uburuundi n<Urwaanda vyaari bitwise kimwe umwaami waaco ikindi umwaami waaco.
A badaagi m u
Buruundi .
1. Abadaagi aho baashika mu Buruundi no mu Rwaanda u rahaazi ? Ego caane. Abo Bazuungu baaturuuye mu Buruundi ryaari? Baahaashitse mu mpera z>ikiingana ca cumi n<icenda.
2. A h o a b a d a agi bashikiye abaruundi baarabakuunze ?
Oya, hari uwukunda uw>atazi ikimuzanye. Noone baageendewe bate mu mibaano yaabo? Abaruundi 3. b a a b a a nge k u r w a anya a b o b a n y amahaanga.
483
UNIT $0
E go, ariko babanje kugera mu mi t w e . B aarwaanye imyaaka myiinshi caan e ? O ya, nta ntwaro bari baf'ise zo kubandanya indwano .
5.
Abeemeye
k u b a a n a n < a b o b a n y a m a h a a ng a n i
b a an d e ?
b eenshi
caane?
1899.
484
BASIC CO U R SE
UNIT g p
Muri ico gihe haari abasirikaari beenshi b>abaruundi noone? Oyaa nta n<abari bariho. 8. Igisagara gikuru c>Uburuundi ni ikiihe? Egisagara gikuru c<Uburuundi ni (Usumbura ) Bu)umbur a .
N beeye i Bu)umbura ni ku k iy aga Taanganika ? Ni k u nk o mbe y a c o.
9. Noonega Abadaagi baaratevye mu Buruundi? Oyaa. 10. Baahaamaze nk>imyaaka ingaahe? Ari myiinshi ni miroongo ibiri gusa. 11. Aho indwaano ya mbere ytisi yoose yateera Abanyamahaanga b aatwaara U b u r u u nd i b a a r i ba a n d e ?
Baari abadaagi kuko aribo baatwaaye Uburuundi gushika ku ndwaano ya mbeere y<isi yoose. N<ukuvuga ko baavuuye mu Buruundi aho baatsiindiwe
1 cer o ' ?
N<uko.
1 2. Mbeeye baariigeze bahindura intwaaro basaanzeho ? Oya.
N oone baagengege g u t e ?
B aakurikige intwaaro yaari isanzwe mu Bu ruun d i t uretse tumwe tumwe baahiinduye .
085
UNIT 30
KIRUNDI
13. Ni. kuki bat;aahiinduye imigeenzo n<iintwaro muri ico gihugu ? Baaretse kubihiindura kuko baasaanze bimeze neeza. Nta n>umwanya ukwiye bahamaze.
N oone baarahejeje barashiima rwose imigeenzo y ~Abaruundi ? E go c a a n e .
14. Indwaano yo kw'iisi yoose yateeye mu mwaaka uwuuhe? Indwaano yateeye mu bihugu vyoose muri 1914 gushika m uri 1 9 1 8 , Noone mu Buruundi no mu Rwaanda naho indwaano yarahashitse? Oyaaf 15, A b a r u u nd i n < a b a ny a r waanda.
Oyaa bar i
A bazuung u
k u r u s hi .
b a a r i h o b a a sh i k a b a a n g a a h e ?
Abaantu bo mu Buruundi no mu Rwaanda baaraaba abo B azuungu n k < i b i k o o k o . N oone Abar uund i n < A b anyar waanda b a a r a ab a b a a g i r a n g o
486
BASIC CO U R SE
UNIT 3 0
18. Mbeeye muri ico gihe Uburuundi n>Urwaanda vyaari bifise kimwe umwaami waaco ikiindi umwaami waaco? Ego.
Noone ivyo bihugu uko ari bibiri vyaariigeze bigira u mwaami umwe abigaba vyoose ? A baami baamye ari babiri umwe mu Bu ru undi uwuun d i
mu Rwaanda.
D.
g ataandat u
bwaaronke intaahe ytukwikuukiira. Ibihugu vyti Bulaya vyaatsiinze iyo Ndwaano yo muri 1914-18 vyaaciiye bigaabaangana ibihugu vyo muri Afrika.
5. 6. 7, U b u r u u ndi le ero n <Urwaanda vyaaciiye bitwaarwa n tUbu b i l i g i . U b u b i l igi muri ico gihe ni bwo bw aatwaara Koongo . N o o n e l e ero Ababiligi baatwaaye Uburuundi n tUrwaanda
k uva 1 9 1 9 . 8. Duharuye imyaaka baategetse ivyo bihugu dusaanga itareenga miroongo ino n<umwe.
9. K o o n g o n < igihugu kibaangikanye n >Uburuundi n tUrwaanda .
487
UNIT 30
KIRUNDI
1 1. A b a r u u nd i
A beera babeereye beenshi muri Africa yo ha g a t i . 1 2, Abirabure baaciiye bareka kwiita abazuungu ibikooko .
D.
A b a b i l igi mu Bu ruundi no mu Rw a an d a .
1. Abadaagi baavuuye mu Buruundi ryari? Baavuuyeho mu mwaaka igihuumbi amajana iceenda na cumi na gataandatu. Baabi.rukanye indwaano imaze guhera noone? Oyaaye, indwano ntiyarangiye muri 1918.
2. M b e e y e ni i nde azi umwaaka Inaama ya V e r sailles
3.
Mbeeye iyo Naama haari ico yakoze kiraaba Uburuundi n>ibiindi bihugu ? Caane.
488
B ASIC CO U R SE
U NIT 3 p
Iyo Naama yagize iki noone? lnaama ya Versailles yagabaanganije ibihugu bitaari
b waaroonke intaahe y >ukwikuukiira . 4. N o o n e i b i hugu vyaagabaanganije ibihugu ntwaarwa urabizi ? Egome. Ibihugu vyaatsiindiye indwaano ya 19 1 4 -18 vyaagi ze bite i Versailles ?
Vyagabaanganye ibiindi bihugu vyaari bigitwaarwa n>abanyamahaanga muri ico gihe. 5. U buruundi Egome. Vyaaci.iye bitwaarwa n>ikiihe gihugu noone? Ububiligi ni bwo bwaashikiriJwe Uburuundi bugerekako Urwaanda.
6. M b e e y e a b a b i ligi hari ikiindi gihugu baatwaara mur i A i'rika muri ico gihe ? Ime. X kiindi gihugu baagaba caari ikihe noon e ? M uri ico gihe ababiligi ni bo ba agaba Kongo Mb i l i g i . 7. H a r i h o u uz i aho Ubub iligi bwataanguriye gutwaara ivyo b ihugu Egome. v y a a h or a bi gab wa n < Abadaagi?
n ~ U r waanda n a v y o b a a r a b i g a b a a nganye n o o n e ?
489
UNIT 30
KIRUNDI
B aabit wwye k u v a
r y a a r i noo n e ?
nkuru muri 1918 gushika muri 1962 aho nya bihugu vyi k u u k i i r a . Noone iyo myaaka baahamaze ni mike? Oyaa. 9. Mbeeye igihugu ca Kongo giherereye heehe? Kiri mu bureengero bw>Uburuundi ni Urwaanda hakurya y~ikiyaga ciitwa Tanganika. Ababiligi baaratevye muri Kongo mbee? Rwoose. 10. Kongo caatwaarwa n<Ababiligi?
Egome. N oone Ububiligi bwaashikirijwe Kongo mu g ihe k i imw e n >Ubur u u n d i ? O yaa, aho ababiligi baashikiira Uburuundi baar i b amaze imyaaka myiinshi baatwaara Kongo mb i li g i . 1 1. Abaruundi n >Abazuungu baataanguye kumenyeerana ryaa r i ? B aat a a n g u y e k u m e n y e e r a n a a h o ab a z u u n g u b a b e e r e y e
490
BASIC COURSE
U NIT 3 0
Oyaa.
E. Intwaaro mu Buruundi ku ngoma y'Ababiligi. 1. Mu biraaba intwaaro Ababiligi baakurikije imigeenzo y <i k i r u u n d i
2.
b a a h a a s aanze .
mu ntwaaro y<igihugu yari umwaami. 3. Muunsi ytumwaami haari abaganwa. Abaganwa nabo baakwirikirwa n>abatwaare.
5. A b a t w a are le ero baafashwa n <abalongoozi aribo biita
abahamagazi .
6. U k o n i k o i n t w a aro y ari im eze mu Buruundi no mu R w a a n d a .
7.
091
UNIT 30
KIRUNDI
manana.
11. Abaganwa bakuukira amateritwaari . 1 2. Amateritwaari yoose mu Buruundi yashika iceenda gu s a : B ururi, Bubaanza, Bujumbura, Gitega, Muhiinga ,
Muramvya, Ngoozi, Rutana, Ruyigi. 13. Umukuru wa teritwaari yari Musitanteeri yeera. 10. Musitanteeri ni we yagaba abaganwa boose bakukira iteritwaari atwaara. 15. Musitanteeri yaba muri Teritwaari. 1 6. A b aganwa nabo b a ab a mu mat o o ngo y a b o . 17. Zina muganwa weese yategeka abatwaare baatwaara mu
g ihugu ci i we .
18. Amategeko yashiingwa n<Umwaami na Leeta yaraanguuzwa n <abaganwa n<abat waar e babo.
1 9. Leeta n tumwaami baashiinga amategeko y tigihugu , i gihugu kikayashikirizwa n < abakuru baandi . 2 0. Abatwaare batwaara ibice bito bito vy >igihugu . 21. Akazi kabo kaari ak <ugushikiriza abantu amajaambo yavuzwe na Leeta n >ugukoresha imilimo Leeta y at e g e t s e .
092
BASIC COURSE
UNIT 3O
abaantu ivyatagetswe.
2 3, Uburuundi b u g i zwe n <ibihiimba bikuru bikuru i c e en d a :
B ulagane, Bututsi, Buyogoma, Buyen zi, Bweeru , I mbo, Mugaamba, Kilimiro . I ntwaaro mu Buruundi ku ngoma y >Ababiligi .
1, Mbeeye Ababiligi baarahinduye imigeenzo basaanze mu Buruundi mu vy>intwaaro? Oya. Noone baageenjeje bate mu gut;egeka ico gihugu? Baakurikije imigeenzo baahasaanze. 2. Mbeeye umukuru mu ntwaaro yari inde muri ico gihe?
Umwaami ni we yari mukuru mu b i r a aba int;waaro y>ico
Egome.
493
UNIT 30 Abatwaare b a a k or a
Abatwaare b a a r i
5.
A b a l o n g o ozi baakora iki boobo ? Abalongoozi aribo bahamagazi baategeka mu k i b a an za c >Abat w a a r e . N oone leero baari intumwa z <abatwaare ?
Egome. 6. Intwaaro yo mu Rwaanda nayo yari incise abatwaare n>abaganwa noone ? Ime. Ivyo bihugu leero vyaari bifise intwaaro zimwe? Mu biraaba abaami, abaganwa n~abatwaare imigeenzo y <ivy o b i h u g u y a r a s a . 7. N o one ubu intwaaro y<abaganwa n~abatwaare iracaariho muri ivyo bihugu? Oya da.
I yo ntwaaro yaciiwe ryari noone ? Haheze imyaaka nk <itatu iyo ntwaaro iciiwe mu B uruu nd i no m u Rwaanda.
8.
gusa.
BASIC CO U R SE
U NIT 3 0
B aari
n k a b a n gaahe? ku ma nana.
B aaraashi k a
11. Mbeeye abaganwa bakuukira Amateritwaari noone? Egome. Amateritwaari yagabwa n>abaganwa bangaahe? Iteritwaari imwe yagabwa n~abaganwa batatu gushika k uri b a t a andatu.
i ce e n d a .
Egome.
M usitanteeri yari Umubiligi caanke Umuruun d i ? M usitanteeri yari Umuzuungu .
49g
UNIT 30
KIHUNDI
14. Ni inde yagaba abaganwa boose baakuukiira iteritwaari? Musitanteeri ni we yagaba abaganwa boose baakuukiira
i teritwaari yi w e . B aari ivyegeera vyiwe leero ? Egome. 1 5. Mbeeye hariho uzi aho Mu sitanteeri yaba ? Ime.
Y aba heehe n o o n e ? Musitanteeri yaba muri teritwaari. 1 6. A b aganwa boobo b ab a h e e h e ? A baganwa baaba mu mat o ongo y a a b o . Amatoongo yaabo yari mu shei'eri yaabo nyene?
Egome.
1 7. Umuganwa y a t e g ek a
a b a t w a ar e a b a a h e ?
Oyaa. 18. Amategeko y<umwaami na Leeta yaranguuzwa na baande? Y araanguuzwa n <abaganwa n <abat waar e .
L eeta ni yo yi t egekera noone ? E kaaye .
496
BASIC CO U R SE
U NIT
30
19. Ni baande baashiinga amategeko? Umwaami na Leeta ni bo baashiinga amategeko yti k i h u gu. Noone si abaganwa n>abatwaare baayaashikiriza abaantu? Caane.
2 0. Abatwaare baategeka ibice bingaana ik i B aategeka ibice bito bito vy <igihugu .
n <abakuru b a
Leeta.
Caane.
2 3. Uburuundi bugizwe n >ibihiimba bikuru bikuru bingaah e ? B ugizwe n<ibihiimba iceenda . Urab i i z i n o on e ?
KIRUNDI
GLOSSARY
[Words are alphabetized by the first letter of the root, regardless of presence or absence of prefixes. In order to make
t he listing easier to fo llow, the words have been sp a ced so th a t the first letters of the ro ots form a s t r aight vertical column
o n th e
page.]
-A-
a abo i w-aac u
3D 6D
t hei r
a t [ my ]
h o m e ( I a t o u rs > )
umu-nya-afirika umw-aaka
(1,2) 6D
A fr i c a n year
(person
( 3,4)
- aki i r a ( -aki i r i y e ) 26D -aambara ic - a ambarwa u mu-nya-ameer i k a umw-aami umw-aampi ic - aamwa - aandi k a
(-aambaye) 15D
( 7,8)
( 1,2 ) 27D
1 SV
1D
(person)
( 1,2 )
( 3,4) (7,8)
30 1 4 SV
( -aandi t s e ) 2D
(-aanduye ) 18D
1D
(a di s ease)
( 1,2 ) ( 1,2 )
5D
30 13 D 1SV 28 D
enemy
period of tim e Arab but teacher
( 1,2 )
23D
except
498
BASIC COURSE
-aambika (-aambitse ) 29
i vy-aat s i aawe
t o cl ot h e grass
( 8)
3D
21D
your
(sg.)
ba
19D
-ba ( - b a aye )
haba - babar i r a u mu-baaj i
i b u - b a a mf u
I
7BD
t o be , t h er e
t o r es i d e is
( 1,2 )
1 2D
7BD
-baana (-baanye )
7 BD
to live toget;her,
live wit;h or near
-baandaanya
t o go
o n , c ont i n u e
( -baandaanij e ) 29
uru- b a angaangwe (11, 10 )
- baa n g i k a n a
/
1 SV
b icy c l e
t o be parallel , n ei g h b o r i n g t o bank
(-baangikanye ) 30
i - b a a nk i umu-baano
( 9,6 o r
10) 1D
( 3) 3 0 i k i - b a a n z a (7,8) 30
- bar i r a - bar i z a a ka-baa t i -baaza
14D 29
t o t el l to ask
2$D 3D 23 D 18 D
c los et ,
c u p board
t o wor k w o o d , t o c ar v e
ubu-bi
( 14)
30
- bi b a
( -bi v ye ) ( -bi ze )
- bir a
i k i - b i r a ( 7, 8)
24D
499
KIRUNDI b ir i
u wa- k a - b i r
l
7BD
i 2SV 1SV 1SV
(person)
g r e e n , r aw
(8,8)
1 4 SV
umu-Bo ( 1,2 )
boobo
1S V
p art
t;hey
o f Bu r u n d i
im-boga -bona
( 9,10 )
14D
1D
( -boonye )
-bonana (-bonanye )
16D
( -boze) ( 1,2 )
1 4 SV 2S V
houseboy
now to the left;
b u - b a a mf u
b ukeeye -bura
i
14 S V
( -buze)
24D
1 2D
b u - r y o o r : i bu r y o
23 D
( g,6)
24D
17D 28D
1D
( -buJi j e ) ( -bwii y e )
2 2D
b waakeey e
(a morning greeting
t o t el l
- bwi i r a
u -bw o
p erhaps ;
a q u e s ti o n w o r d
u sed i n a s k i n g f o r verificat;ion
nta- bw o
29
( a neg a t i v e
w o r d)
- ca ( - c i i y e ) 12D $00
t o t ur n , o u t
BASIC CO U R SE
t o d o r i g h t aw a y v ery , much
5D 9D 21D
- ii - c a r a ( -i i c a ye ) 15S V 8S V
t o be
s eat ed
5 franc
nine
pi ece
(7,8) 15SV
2 2D
coin d ry s e a s o n
a ga-cu ( 1 2 , 1 3 ) i gi - c u ( 7,8 )
8SV i - c um i
22D 22 D
i-cumu ( 5,6)
30
spear orange
b ot t l e
to work metal r el a t i v e
-D-
( ,10)
17D
29
da
(emphatic particle
i n- d a g a r a iki - daagi
( 9,10 )
1 4 SV 7SV
( small )
m erch a n t
f i sh
( 7 ) 29
( 1,2 ) 7SV ( 1)
German (language)
umu-daandaza daata
m y fa t h e r overseer
who?
13D 25D 1 4 SV
501
a i r p l an e e duca t i on
lemon
KIRUNDZ
i - d i r i sh a (5,6) umu-duga
2 5 SV
4D 30
18D
window
automobile to climb, go up f ight', b a t t ;l e
( 3,4)
2 SV
-duuga ( -duuze)
in- dwaano
i n- dwaar a
/
(9,10 )
or :
s ic k n e s s
i n- gwaar a in-dya
( 9,10 )
18 D
-E-
food
i c - e e g e er a e ego ego or :
e ka
(7,8) 30
hj o 2D
lieutenant, understudy
1D
2 2D
7B D
- eera ( - e e z e )
umw-eera erega
23D
(1,2)
26 D 12D
a lso ; a n e x p r e s s i o n o f s urp r i s e
to show
-ereka ( -er e t s e )
ak-eeza ( 12) 2 4 D ( cf . ni i za ) ukw-eezi
(15,6 )
6D
i - f a r a a n g a 13D o r : i f ar a a n g a i g i - f a r a a n s a ( 7) - f at a ( - f as h e)
m oney, f r a n c s
(5,6)
French
6D
5D
12D
(language)
get
-fasha ( -fashi ge )
- fat any a 29 ( -f a t a n i j e )
t ;o h e l p
t o take,
502
BASIC COURSE
i fi - fi t a
( 9, 1 0 ) ( -f i s c )
/
14S V 5D
( lar ge ) f i s h
to have [religiousj brother
u mu-f r e e r e
25 D
igi - f u u n go
( 7,8)
( 3,4 )
29
19 D 9D 28D 2 4 SV 27 D 30
b ut t o n
(-fuunguye) 15SV
to eat;
cover of a k e t t le
firstborn
b ad w e a t h e r : cl ou dy b u t ;
n ot r a i n y hyena
- gaba ( - g avye )
-gabaanganya
to administer t o di v i d e
t o di v i de
up
( -gabaanganige )
- gabany a 27D
(-gabanige) -gabir a
umu-gabo
( -gabiye ) 7S V
19D
14 D
to give as a gift
( 1,2 )
(marri ed ) man
to feed polit;ical parties f ac t o r y , w o r k shop
- gabur i r a
( -gaandit s e
) )
( 3,4)
30
29
- gaani i r a ga-nt;uu
( -gaani r i i y e )
11D
umu-ganwa (1,2)
<cheff e r i
e<
503
KIRUNDI
b icyc l e
l SV
a retur n i n g
( 12)
26D 2D
-garuka ( -garut se )
h a- g a t i 24 D
to return
(intransitive )
i n t h e mi d d l e o f
ga-t o oy a ubu-gavyi
18D
a li t t l e
( 14)
27D 15 S V 2D
government
to be dissatisfied
- gaya ( - g a ye )
-geenda
( -gi i y e )
)
13D
( 11,10 )
30 {-geenduuye )
14D ( -geenj e j e ) 28D 9SV 2D
t o c a us e t o g o courteous, appellation
fri end
(3,4)
30
1D
c ust o m
- gera ( - g e z e - gera ( - g e z e
-gerageza i n- g e r e g e r e - ger e r a
) )
14D 21D
( -ger a g e j e ) ( 9,10 )
24S U
{ -gereye) 1 4 D 24D
- geza ( - g e j e j e )
irX-gi
egg
to do
i ki - g o u ru- g o
a n e n c l o s e d ba c k y a r d
far m
B ASIC C O U R S E
in-goma ( 9,10)
- goomba in - g o ona umu-gore 19D
30
(-goomvye) ( 9,10 ) 2 4 SV
c rocod i l e
woman, wi f e
to give difficulty
maize
i ki - g oor i
umu-gorooba
s unset;,
t o i r on
evening
14 D 1 4 SV
( 9,10 )
6D 12D
{ to do ) h o w?
{ 7,8)
6S V
29
22D
p ri c e
t o f al l c hal k
- gwa ( - g u u y e ) i n - gw a
s ic k n e s s l eopar d
-H-
( 9,10 )
3D
2 4 SV
a-ha
her e
- ha ( - h a aye ) 13 D ( h~ p a f t e r m )
- hagar a r a hagati umu-hamagazi umu-hana
t o gi v e
t o wai t in the middle of lowest rank in t r a d i tional administration the area around a d w e l l ing
(-hagaze} 29
( 9}
24D
30
( 1,2 ) 26 D
( 3,4 )
505
KIRUNDI
- hanaant uk a
24D
)
11D
s ide , part t o a s c en d t h e t hr o n e after that
o ut s i d e
27D
11D
{-haangaamye)
haanze ibi - h ar a ge hari 22 D
( 8)
3D
18D
beans
t h er e is, t h er e ar e
( 7,8)
28D 24D 17D
29
d own, b e l o w t ,o si t do w n a s a co n s e q u e n c e
-hava (-havuuye )
he --he i gi - h e
r
21D
to do
w hi c h ?
6D 3D
where? (encli,tic )
( 7,8)
13D
6D
4D
time
h eehe heejur u
where? above
-hema { -hemye)
-hera ama-her a or:
r
17D 9D
{ -heze)
4D
ama-hydra (6)
- her a h e z a
7BD
23D
a m aher a
( -her a h e j e u mu-her e r e z i
)
9S V 18D
youngest child, last; born to finish p art , hal f
( 1,2 ) - heza ( - h e j e g e )
igi-hiimba ( 7,8)
30
g06
BASIC COURSE
( -h i i n d u k i y e 30 ( -h i i n d u y e ) ( or :
h ii n g a
h i i nge ) 18D
i mu-hydra 2 3 D mu-hydra 1 SV
- hi i s h i r a ( -h i i s h i y e ) 14SV
home to ri pen
to be finished
22 D 13 D
( -hi se )
26D 19D
( s e e / - s h a/)
c oncer n i n g l et>s go me
18D
d irt ; i n e s s
18D
18D 18D
- hora ( - h o z e ) -hora
-hoora cf . ama-horo
b u-h o r o
/
( -hoze)
igi - h ugu
( 7,8)
23D
7SV
count r y , s on, b o y
r egi o n
a Hut;u p e r s o n
to become light; in weight
umu-hwi
banana
507
KIHUNDI
-iicara
cf.
( i i c a ye )
/
21 D
30
- ii c i r a ( -i i ci y e ) -iiciisha 30 (-iiciishije ) - ig a
/
t o ki l l
( - i ze )
5D
to learn
gir l t ea c h e r
7S V 5D
( -ihuuse) 2 6D
( - i i h w e e j e ) 30
/
-i i h w e e za
t o e x a mi n e yes
h ow many ? how?
i -me ( o r : / m e/ )
i i n g a ah e i ngen e i ng o - inj i r a iinshi -i i p f u u z a u mw-ii r a b u r e
/
26D
6D 14D
15D
cornel
/
(-in/ iye)
3D
24D
( for )
( -i i p f u u g i j e ( 1,2 )
)
28 D 28D
22D a bl a c k p e r s o n
to last all day to run
- i i r i r wa ( - i i r i we )
-iir u ka
( - i i r ut s e )
7S V
(-i t a a yeko
27 D
- i i t e g er e z a
(-iitegereje ) -iza
i za
/
5D
1D
good
508
BASIC CO U R SE
- ja ( - g i i y e )
i-jana
4D
13 D
13D 24D
to go hundred
to go together with to be b r ou g h t
( 5,6 )
- j a an a n a . . .
( -j aanye n a . . . )
- gaanwa ( - J a a n y we )
je j e-h o 26 D
c oncer n i n g
me
j eewe
1D
i - j i i sh o ( 5,6)
i-joro
1 4 SV 14 S V
- kaba ( - k a v ye )
( 9)
7S V
29
6) 13D 22D 1 5 SV 6S V
( 1,2 )
15D
( 9,10 or
truck and
t o be c ol d
-kanya ( -kanye)
ama-kara
( 6)
19D
( 5 or 9 , 6 )
( -karavye )
few
( -keetse )
t o suppose, t o be su sp e c t i n n ee d
-keeka -kena
(-keneye )
509
KIRUNDI
to
t h a n k s om e o n e
23D
2 4D 1 4 SV
3D
or: ikiromeetero
- kina ( - k i n y e )
i - k i i n g a ( g,6)
21D
1 SV
26 D
- kir a
( -ki ze )
/-ki za/
ko 1 4 SV
umu-koobwa ( 1,2 ) i n-koof e er o k oko igi - k o oko cf. in-koko igi - k o oko
d augh t e r , g i r l hat
( 9,10 )
19 D
trul y
( 7,8)
( 9,10 ) ( 7p8)
30
1 4 SV 24D
animal, insect
c hi c k e n wild animal to knock bank , s h or e
a g a - k o o k o (12,13)
- komaang a
1 4SV
)
to be in good he a l th t o cont i nu e one pot
(9,10 ) 30 ( -komeye) 9 D
11D
( 9,10 ) ( 1,2 )
19D 1S V
Congoles e
(person)
BASIC COURSE
18D
to use
(-koreeshege)
m e eza (8) 25SV t abl e war e
to eat with condiments a cco r d i n g why? t o
k oza ( - k o j e g e )
k ubwa
k uk i
19D
27D
1 8D
- kuuk i r a k uko
( -kuukiy e ) 30
14 S v 30
/
kuumbure -kuunda
/
(-kuunze)
22 D
4D
- ku u n d i r a
/
(-kuundiye
/
-kuura (-kuuye
-kuur a k ur e k uru ama-kuru mu-kuru - kwi i r a 13D 8S V
)'
18D 18D
(-kuuye)
( 6) ( 1)
25D 7BD
news e lder , se n io r
( -kwii y e (9,10 )
15D
-L-
t o sui t
l eet a
30
g over n m en t
iki-lomeetero ( 7,8)
13D
kilometer
or: ikiromeetero
m adaamu
/
16D
Madame
maama ( 1,2 )
j :-maan a 2 5D
7S V
my mot;her
S upreme B e i n g
ubu-manuko
[ to
t he ] so u t h
KIRUNDI
7S V 2D
( 9,10 )
( a quest i o n wor d
( a qu e s t i o n
b ef o r e i n f ac t
w o r d)
30
18D 2D
26D
yes
1 think, one might say t ;o k n o w
(-menye)
- menyeer a 12D
to be accustomed to
(-menyereye
)
to get acquainted with each
o th e r
18D
(-mesuuye ) 2SV 2 5 SV
1 5SV
a-meeza
umu-Mos o
( 6,6 )
1SV
t abl e
m ugabo
umu-ny a - m u g a amba mu-gee nz i i mu-h ar a
13D ( 1,2 )
2 8D 23D 2SV
1SV
uwa-muung u
m u(ri )
mwe
1D
5D
29 512
mwe
/
o ne,
same
e e-mwe
(expression of ast;onishment)
BASIC CO U R SE
mweebwe
Mweezi. 30 -N-
y ou (p l
na
3D 6D
and b adl y
naabi i- n aama
n amak i
(9,10 )
2D
30 23D
treaty
> How are y o u ? < p ineappl e or; is it true? eight other 2D good-by seven four Thursday
( 9,10 )
30 8SV
3D
n di i k e b a anuy e i - n dw i ne u wa-ka-n e
/
8SV 8SV 2S V 26 D
- neezerw a ngaahe
to be
pl eased
(-neezerewe
8D
)
how many?
-ngana ( - n ganye )
n go i - ng o 19D 15D
6D
t o be t ha t
eq ua l
t o
cornel
5 franc p i e c e i s, a r e l ar g e
i k i i - n g o r o o n g o r o (7,8) 1 5SV
ni lD
nin i
8SV
30
c entur y
l ike, as
here n ow, t h e n
now m inu t e
noone
n ooneh o
( expl e t i v e )
513
K j:RUNDI
i-nooti n t;aa
(5,6)
16D
1 5 SV
( a neg a t i v e
w o r d)
i k i i - nt u ( 7,8 ) umuu-ntu ga nt u u
1S V 3D
t hi n g
( 1,2 )
11D
person
f or m of ad dr e ss u s e d w he n
aka-nwa ( 12,13 )
i mi - n we
21 D
mouth hands
( 4)
27D ( 1,2) 30
2 4 SV 29 7S V
s t r an g e r
2 5 SV
( 11,14)
7BD
( 1,2 )
(pl .
i-nyoni
i- n yuma ( 9,10 )
h aa- n z e 2 2D
behind ,
t o dr i nk o ut;si d e
a f t er
t ,o use i n w a s h i n g
)
24D 6) 15D
s mal l k ind , mud s t ; re a m so r t
( 12,13) ( 8)
22D
514
BASIC COURSE
umw-oonga
( 3 ~ 4 ) 23D
8S V
6D
v al l e y to add
- onger ez a
i c-oongerez a
r
( -ongerej e )
English ( language )
- oroha ( - o r o s he
-oroh er wa 9D { -or ohewe ) oose o ya 7BD 1D
/
5SV
t o b e c ome ea s y
to be in good hea l th all
no
- oza ( - o g e j e )
umu-paka
18D
-P-
to wash
{ 3,4 ) i -paampa (5 )
24 D 23 D
b o undary
( 9,10)
( 11,10)
29
6SV 26D
( 9,10)
30
22D 26D 26D 24D
i m-peeshi ( 9 )
o f dr y s ea s o n
- pfa ( - p f u u y e)
19D
(for)
ke
( -i i p f u u g i g e )
i-pikipiki ( 9,6 ) - pi i m a im-poongo umu-poorXsi i-poosi t ;a im-puuzu
motor b i
KIRUNDI
-raaba
( -raavye )
16 D
( -ramutse )
29
to show t o be e x h a u s t e d , f i n i sh e d
i k i - r a a t o ( 7,8) U bu-ray a
28D 29
to leave unfinished o vern i g h t to stop doing something peace, tranquility to 'become heavy
higher , mo r e
17 D
25D 29
12D
(-remeereye ) 5SV
( 8)
- r eengaan a u bu-r e e ng er o
to pass
(-reengaanye) ( 14)
8SV
11D 25 D 28 D
I to t h e j to rear
tal l
west
-rer a
( -reze )
r ee r e
i k i - r e e r e ( 7,8 )
u mu-r e z i
c hi l d < s
nurse
waabaana
- ri 1D
( 1,2 )
2S V
to be tdefectxve st e mj except
trut h
ata -r i
u ku - r i
/
23D
29
ibi-riibwa ( 8)
17D
516
s omet h i n g
t o eat
B ASIC C O U R SE
2SV
( -ri m i i s h i j e ) u mu-ri mo
i - r i i ng a r a ( 5)
5 SV 29
L ing a l a ti me ,
bed
moment
( 14,6 )
2 5 SV 6) 26D
i-riitiro (9,10 or
or: iriitiro
l it er mil l et
u bu-r o
( 14)
18D
(-roondeye ) 2D
- roonder a
t o look
f or
8D
(4)
30
( 1,2 ) (-umuhamagazi
( - r oy e )
)
7BD
to direct oneself toward t o wai t fi sh er man
( -roonse )
11D
( 1,2 )
7S V
-ruhuuka
( -r u h u u t s e ) 21D 22D
-fi - r u ka
umu-Ruundi -rut a
(-i i r u t se )
( 1,2 ) ( -ruse )
1D 7BD
517
a Rundi
t o pass ,
(person)
su r p a s s
KIRUNDI
-rwaana ( -rwaanye)
ik i - n y a - r w a a n da
30
( 7)
5 SV
1D 17D
21D
umu-nya-Rwaanda ( 1,2 )
r ya 2 1D
a Rwanda (person
t ha t o v er t her e
- ry a ha-ry a
/
( - r i i ye) 28D
/
to eat
b y th e way
t o l i e d o wn
( 3,4 )
2 5 SV
door ( the o p e n i n g )
family, kinship, group 30
to fight, cope wi th when?
( 3,4)
9D
bur y o
29
( -rwaani j e )
12 D
to the right
to r e s embl e
a l on e
- saba ( - s a v y e )
19D
1S V
( 7,8 )
c ity ,
t ow n
( 11,10) 3 0 i - saha ( 9 , 6 ) 6D
i- s a h aani
a temporary dwelling
hour d ish , pl at e
( 9,6)
23D (5 or
18D
9 , 6 ) 2 5 SV
12D
ama-saka
( 6)
s or g h u m b ox , ch e s t
( -saanze )
( 3,4 )
17 D
1 5 SV
i -saasit a i-seenge
ivory
(>tooth of elephant> )
r ya i n z o v u (5) 25SV
518
B ASIC C O U R S E
i-serer i
( 9,10 )
14D 14S V
5D
c eler y
ubu-seruko ( 19) 1 1 D
- sha ( - h i i y e )
-shaaka i- s h aamba uru- s h a ana s haasha ubu-shaza c f. u ru- s h i ( -shaa t s e )
f to t h e ] e a s t
t o ge t r i pe
( 5,6 ) ( 11)
16D
24 D 22D
season (May)
n ew, f r e sh
( 14)
18D 30
(i ) - s h eef er i
(9 , 6 )
i - n t aa r a (9,10)
( 11,6)
30
( 1 ,2 ) 7BD
11D 17D
( -sh i t s e )
- shi k a h a a s i - shi i m a
t o si t
dow n
to be sat;isfied s hir t s hir t (in diminutive class, but here not; referring literally to size ) to put a stick in the g round , t o p ut i n s hap e
legislator t o end , bec ome ex haus t ed
i-shimiizi ( 9, 6) 1 5 D a ga-shi m i i z i
- sh i i n g a
( -s h i i n z e )
27D
( -shi ze ) ( 12)
16 D 26D
in supply a ga-sh i r u k a b u t e
- shi r u k a
f ee , t i p
to be active, diligent
ubu t e
29
{-shi r u t ;se
- shi r w a -shoboka -shobor a
)
29 2D
519
to be satisfied t o be t o be p o ss i b l e abl e
( -shi.zwe)
KIRUNDI
e mployer , d ri v e r cabbage
to
boss
( 1,2 )
2SV
18D
i- shu
( -shuushe )
b e c ome h o t
(5 or 9 , 6 )
( -shuuhij e ) 1BD
d own, b e l o w
i si ( 5 6 )
umuu-si
30 6D
29 29
1 4 SV
e ar t h ,
wor l d
( 3,4)
day ( 2 4
h o u r p e ri od )
- siga ( - s i z e )
- si g a z a - si g u u r a
t o l e a v e b eh i n d
(-si g a j e )
(-si guuye )
to cause to stay, to
leave a part of s o m e thing t;o e x p l a i n s ol d i e r m is s i o n
30 11 D
s o (1 , 2 ) 9S V ( pl . b a a s o)
- so b a a n u k a
y our f a t ; h e r
t o be explained, explicable , t o b e s o r t e d o ut g ran d f a t h e r
30 ( -sobaanut s e
)
29
(1,2) 7 SV ( -sohowe) 1 SV
2S V 17D
( -soho t s e )
30
( 5,6 )
( -shoon j e )
( 1,2 )
8D
520
a dol e s c e n t ; ,
BASIC CO U R SE
to be sweet, good-tasting
( 3,4)
4D
19D
m ount a i n
to repeat
t o pour hoe i nt o
(9,6) 2 SV
i-sukaari
( 9) 1 4 D i - s u k u ( 5) 1 8 D
-suumba ( -suumvye) umu-swa ( 3)
igi-swaahiri
/
6D
to surpass
whit e an t s
2 4 SV
Swahil i
(language
-tabaara
(-tabaaye} 12D
to help
book n ot e b o o k
(7,8)
m odern- s t y l e b o o k [used by some s p e ak er s i n distinction to /igitabo/, formerly >an altar< ] n oon, d a y t i m e
judgment, oath cloth, material t o step ov e r , pas s
( 3,4 ) ( 9,10 )
1 1D
22 D 27D
igi-taambara ( 7,8)
- t a a mbuk a
15D
( - t a ambut s e t aandat u
/
)
six
8S V
2 SV
u wa-g a - t a a n d a t u
S atu r d a y
i - t a a n d u k aa n i r o -t a anga - t a angur a
/ /
(5,6) 5D
25D 2D
d i f f e r en c e
( - t a a n ze )
t o give ,
to begi n s pi d e r
pa y
( -t a a n guye )
KIRUNDI
t aanu uwa-ga- t a a n u
6D 2S V
five P rid a y
i-tara
i n-t a a r a i n-t a r e
(5,6)
( 9,10 ) ( 9,10 )
2 5 SV
30 2 4 SV 29 11 D
2 2D
l amp, c a n d l e
coun t r y , r e g i on lion
i -tar i ki
(9,10 )
( 12) 6D 2SV
date
(of month )
of ea r l y r a i n s
h osp i t a l s easo n t hr e e
Wednesday
to do ho w ?
12D
t o stay seat
l on g
-tega ( - t e z e )
-t e g eka - t e g e er a
to receive to make /
( physi c a l l y
e n f o r c e l aw s
(-tegeereye ) 4D
( -t e g e r e j w e ) 29
( 14)
27D
( -t e e t s e ) 2SV
( 5,6)
27D
t o cause t o go abou t
( - t e ember e j e -teera - t e e r wa
- ti
)
24D 24D
t o cause, to be t o r e a ch c au s e d
( -teeye ) ( - t e e we )
1 4SV
i gX- t i
( 7,8 )
5D
21 D
tree
i g i - t i gi r i
to
( 7,8)
30
number
small
( of
t h i ng s )
522
BASIC CO U R SE
u ru - t o o f a n y i
i g i - t o ok e
p otat o p lan t a i n
c ultivated fields ,
i-t oongo
( 5,6)
( - t o o y e) ( 5,6 )
30
16D
14S V
r eal e s t a t e
- toor a
i-toora u ru- t o r e t oot o ga-t o oy a
to choose
elec t i on
27 D
e ggplan t f r e sh , g r e en, u n ri pe
a li t t l e
-tooza ( -toogeje )
i n-t o z i
29 27D
t o fi ni sh a rmy a n t s
to wi n
( 10)
2 4 SV 23D
- t s i i n d a ( -t s i i n z e )
-tuma (-tumye )
igi - t u ma
30 (-tuungaanige)
igi - t u u n gur u
a n i mal
( -tuuye ) ( 1,2 )
5D
30 3D 1SV
( -t ur u t s e ) 21D 1S V 27D
a Tut s i
shadow
(person)
igi-tuutu ( 7) n -t u u z e
S o-and- s o a Twa p e r s o n , p y g my
umu-Twa ( 1,2 )
umu-twaar a in-t waaro
twe
{ 1,2 ) { 9,10 )
o ne who g o v e r n s
g over n m en t
27D
we
523
KIRUNDI
27D
22 D
head
( 15,6 )
15D
ear
like that
-ubaha
to respect,
t o bui l d b ui l d e r
( 1,2)
7S V
( 11}
1 4 SV
23D
door ( the o b j e c t
i n z u u g i (10)
I think; one might sa y
u meenga -uumuuka
/ /
t o ge t
dry one
( 7,8)
t o h e ar , herdsman
understand
umw-uungere
- ung u r u z a
( 1,2 )
2 6D
7S V
t o give a lif t
(unguruj e
umu-unyu
)
salt 29
to fill out
( 3)
14D
-uzuza (-uzuje
- va ( - v u u y e ) uru- v a a nge
}
13D
t o go
f r om e
( 11,10)
28D
mix t u r
- v i i r a ( -v i i r i y e ) 29
umu-voomyi
v ub a
( 1,2 )
1D
2SV
24S V
wate r
ca r r i e r
im-vubu
( 9,10 )
BASIC COURSE
- vuga (-vuze)
umu-vuukanyi
iki - v uko i m-vur a
4D 7BD
1S V
t o s p e ak ,
s ibl i ng
say
( 1,2)
22D
( 7,8 ) ( 9)
24 D
port
rai n
i - v u u r i r o ( 5,6 ) v ya
1SV
h osp i t a l
) the
area ar ound< )
- vyaar a
u mu-v y a a r a u mu-v y e e y i
/
-vyuuka
(-vyuutsa ) 15SV
we
13D 30
1D
you
weese
wewe weewe
/
each ( Cl. 3 ) y ou (s g . )
h e, she
iki - y aga
lake
wind but spoon to bathe oneself
18 D
-ii - y oza
( 7,8 ) 14 D (-i i y o g e j e ) 1 5 SV
- zana ( - z a n y e ) in - z e eduka
- zi 2D
16D
t ;o b r i n g a cc i d e n t
( 9,10) 3 0 2D
(see / - menya/ )
work water
aka-zi amaa-zi
( 12,13)
( 6)
18D
525
KIRUNDI
18D
5SV
(-zi i mbuutse
- zimur ur a i-zina 11D
)
l lD to get lost ( of r evers e o f
name t o go early in th e morni n g ; t o d awn
( -z i m i y e )
p e r s o n s)
~ to l os e >
(-zimuruye) (5,6 ) 1D
- zi i n d u k a 28D ( -zi i n d u t s e ) i n-z i r a
( 9,10 ) ( 9,10 ) ( 5)
12 D 21 D 21D 1S V 20 D
in-zoga ( 9)
in-zoka
18D
in-zu
(9,10)
i-zuuba
umu-zuungu ( 1,2 ) i n- z u u z i
European
(person)
( 9,10 )
526
* U. 9 G O VERNMENT P R I NTING OF F IC E 1 9 6 50 - 7 5 2 - 2 16(145)